Official Software
Get notified when we add a new MGF Manual

We cover 60 MG vehicles, were you looking for one of these?

1964-1978 MGB Electrical Wiring Diagrams PDF
MG - Midget - Workshop Manual - 1961 - 1980
MG - TF - Workshop Manual - 2002 - 2002
MG - MGB - Workshop Manual - 1977 - 1977
MG - MGB - Parts Catalogue - 2016 - 2016 (German)
MG - ZS - Workshop Manual - 2002 - 2005
MGB TOURER AND GT Special Tuning PDF
MG - MGB - Workshop Manual - 1968 - 1971
MG - ZS - Owners Manual - 2017 - 2017
MG - MGF - Sales Brochure - 1995 - 2000
MG - Midget - Workshop Manual - 1967 - 1973
MG - GS - Miscellaneous Documents - 2017 - 2017
MG - Midget - Parts Catalogue - 1977 - 1981
MG - MGA - Workshop Manual - 1955 - 1955
MG - MGB GT - Parts Catalogue - 1968 - 1971
MG - MGF - Workshop Manual - 2006 - 2006
MG - ZS - Sales Brochure - 2018 - 2018
MG - MGA Twin Cam - Workshop Manual - 1958 - 1960
MGB COMPETITION PREPARATION MANUAL PDF
MG - ZS - Miscellaneous Documents - 2017 - 2017
MG - MGA - Parts Catalogue - 1955 - 1962
MG - TD - Miscellaneous Documents -2016 - 2016
MG - MGB GT - Sales Brochure - 1968 - 1971
MG - TD - Sales Brochure - 1950 - 1952
MG - MGB - Workshop Manual - 1949 - 1949
MG - MGA - Workshop Manual - 1965 - 1965
MG - MGB - Sales Brochure - 1977 - 1977
MG - MGA Coupe - Parts Catalogue - 1955 - 1959
MG - MGB - Miscellaneous Documents - 1977 - 1977
MG - MGB - Sales Brochure - 1963 - 1963
MG - TF - Workshop Manual - 2002 - 2002 (2)
MG - ZT-T - Sales Brochure - 2001 - 2002
MG - TF - Sales Brochure - 2004 - 2004
MG - ZT-T - Sales Brochure - 2001 - 2005
MG - GS - Sales Brochure - 2017 - 2017
MG - MGA - Sales Brochure - 1974 - 1974
MG - Dynamo -Miscellaneous Documents - 1952 - 1952
MG - ZS - Sales Brochure - 2017 - 2017 (2)
MG - Midget - Workshop Manual - 1967 - 1967
MG - ZS - Sales Brochure - 2017 - 2018
MG - TF - Sales Brochure - 2009 - 2009
MG - TF - Sales Brochure - 2008 - 2008 (2)
MG - ZS - Sales Brochure - 1924 - 1924
MG - ZS - Sales Brochure - 2001 - 2005
MG - Dynamo - Workshop Manual - 2015 - 2015
MG - MGA - Parts Catalogue - 2002 - 2002
MG - ZT-T - Sales Brochure - 2001 - 2001
MG - ZS - Sales Brochure - 2003 - 2003
MG - TF - Sales Brochure - 1924 - 2009
MG - ZT-T - Sales Brochure - 2004 - 2004
MG - ZS - Sales Brochure - 2001 - 2003
MG - TF - Sales Brochure - 2008 - 2008
MG - ZS - Sales Brochure - 2001 - 2002
MG - ZS - Sales Brochure - 1924 - 1924 (2)
MG - Maestro - Sales Brochure - 2008 - 2008
Mercedes - AMGC43 - Brochure - 2019 - 2019
Mercedes - AMGCLS53Coupe - Brochure - 2019 - 2019
Mercedes - AMGC63 S - Brochure - 2015 - 2015
Mercedes - AMGC43Coupe - Brochure - 2017 - 2017
Mercedes - AMGC63Coupe - Brochure - 2017 - 2017
Summary of Content
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe C-Class Operator's Manual 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 1 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Symbols Registered trademarks: RBabySmart™ is a registered trademark of the Siemens Automotive Corp. RBluetooth® is a registered trademark of the Bluetooth SIG Inc. RESP® is a registered trademark of Daimler AG. RHomeLink® is a registered trademark of Prince, a Johnson Controls Company. RLogic 7® is a registered trademark of Harman International Industries, Incorporated. RMicrosoft® a registered trademark of the Microsoft Corporation in the USA and in other countries. RSIRIUS and related brands are registered trademarks of SIRIUS XM Radio Inc. RWindows Media® is a registered trademark of the Microsoft Corporation in the USA and in other countries. In this Operator's Manual you will find the following symbols: G Warning Warning notices draw your attention to hazards that endanger your health or life, or the health or life of others. ! Warning notices draw your attention to hazards that could cause damage to your vehicle. i Practical tips or other information that could be helpful to you. X X Y page This symbol indicates instructions that you must follow. A number of these symbols appearing in succession indicates instructions with several steps. This symbol tells you where to look for further information on a topic. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 2 Version: 3.0.3.6 YY This symbol marks a warning or procedure which is continued on the next page. Display Text in the multifunction display/ COMAND display. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 1 Version: 3.0.3.6 Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz Before you drive off, please familiarize yourself with your vehicle and read this manual, especially the safety and warning notices. This will help you to obtain the maximum pleasure from your vehicle and to avoid endangering yourself and others. The equipment or product designation of your vehicle may vary depending on: Rmodel Rorder Rcountry specification Ravailability Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its vehicles to the state of the art. Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right to introduce changes in the following areas: Rdesign Requipment Rtechnical features You cannot therefore base any claims on the data, illustrations or descriptions contained in this manual. The following are integral parts of the vehicle: ROperator's Manual Instructions1 RService Booklet RSupplements relating to vehicle equipment Keep these documents in the vehicle at all times. When you sell the vehicle, always pass the documents on to the new owner. The technical documentation team at Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant motoring. Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc. A Daimler Company RBrief 1 Canada only. 2045848981 É2045848981XËÍ BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 2 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 3 Version: 3.0.3.6 Contents Index ....................................................... 4 At a glance ........................................... 23 Introduction ......................................... 18 Safety ................................................... 33 Opening and closing ........................... 69 Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .... 91 Lights and windshield wipers .......... 105 Climate control ................................. 119 Driving and parking .......................... 129 On-board computer and displays .... 165 Loading, stowing and features ........ 215 Maintenance and care ...................... 237 Breakdown assistance ..................... 251 Tires and wheels ............................... 269 Technical data ................................... 301 3 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 4 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 4 Index 1, 2, 3 ... 115 V socket ...................................... 225 12 V socket ........................................ 224 4ETS see ETS/4ETS 4MATIC (permanent four-wheel drive) .................................................. 159 A ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) Display message ............................ 189 Function/notes ................................ 62 Warning lamp ................................. 206 Accident (notes) ................................ 253 Active light function (display message) ............................................ 194 Active service system see Service interval display ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 66 Additional speedometer ................... 179 Air bags Display message ............................ 187 Front air bag (driver, front passenger) ....................................... 37 Important safety notes .................... 36 Knee bag .......................................... 38 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp (only Canada) ........... 46 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp (only USA) ................ 41 Pelvis air bag ................................... 40 Safety guidelines ............................. 35 Side impact air bag .......................... 39 Window curtain air bag .................... 40 Air-conditioning system see Climate control Air dehumidification Activating/deactivating with cooling ........................................... 122 Air distribution Setting ........................................... 123 Airflow Setting ........................................... 124 Air nozzles see Air vents .................................. 126 Air pressure see Tire pressure Air-recirculation mode Activating/deactivating ................. 125 Air vents ............................................. 126 Glove box ....................................... 127 Important safety information ......... 126 Rear ............................................... 127 Setting the center air vents ........... 126 Setting the side air vents ............... 126 Alarm system see ATA AMG menu (on-board computer) ..... 171 Anti-lock Braking System see ABS Anti-Theft Alarm system see ATA Anti-theft system ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 67 Ashtray ............................................... 223 Assistance menu (on-board computer) .......................................... 178 ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) Activating/deactivating ................... 67 Function ........................................... 67 Switching off the alarm .................... 67 Audio menu (on-board computer) .... 175 AUTO lights see Light sensor Automatic car wash .......................... 244 Automatic transmission Display message ............................ 200 Driving tips .................................... 139 Emergency running mode .............. 144 Kickdown ....................................... 140 Malfunction .................................... 144 Program selector button ................ 140 Pulling away ................................... 134 Releasing the parking lock manually ........................................ 144 Selector lever ................................ 138 Starting .......................................... 133 B Backrest (display message) ............. 201 Bag hook ............................................ 219 BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 62 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 5 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Index Battery Charging ........................................ 261 Checking (SmartKey) ....................... 74 Display message ............................ 196 Important safety guidelines (SmartKey) ....................................... 74 Jump-starting ................................. 262 Replacing (SmartKey) ...................... 74 Safety notes .................................. 259 Belt see Seat belts Brake fluid Notes ............................................. 309 Brake fluid level ................................ 242 Brake lamp (display message) ......... 192 Brakes ABS .................................................. 62 BAS .................................................. 62 Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 309 Display message ............................ 190 High-performance brake system .... 153 Important safety notes .................. 151 Maintenance .................................. 152 Parking brake ................................ 149 Warning lamp ................................. 203 Breakdown see Accident (notes) see Flat tire Bulbs Backup lamp .................................. 115 Brake lamp .................................... 115 High-beam headlamps ................... 113 Low-beam headlamps .................... 113 Overview ........................................ 112 Parking lamps ................................ 114 Rear fog lamp ................................ 115 Replacing ....................................... 114 Side marker lamp .......................... 115 Standing lamps (front) ................... 114 Tail lamp ........................................ 115 Turn signal lamp ............................ 115 Turn signals (front) ......................... 114 C CAC (Customer Assistance Center) ......... 21 California Important notice for retail customers and lessees .................... 19 Calling up a malfunction see Display messages Capacities see Technical data Care Carpets .......................................... 249 Car wash ........................................ 244 Display ........................................... 247 Gear or selector lever .................... 248 Headlamps ..................................... 246 Matte finish ................................... 245 Notes ............................................. 243 Paint .............................................. 245 Plastic trim .................................... 247 Power washer ................................ 244 Rear view camera .......................... 247 Roof lining ...................................... 249 Seat belt ........................................ 249 Seat covers .................................... 248 Sensors ......................................... 247 Steering wheel ............................... 248 Tail pipes ....................................... 247 Trim strips ..................................... 248 Washing by hand ........................... 244 Wheels ........................................... 245 Windows ........................................ 246 Wiper blades .................................. 246 Wooden trim .................................. 248 Cargo tie down rings ......................... 219 CD player/CD changer (on-board computer) .......................................... 175 Center console ..................................... 29 Central locking Automatic locking (on-board computer) ...................................... 181 SmartKey ......................................... 70 Changing bulbs Headlamps ..................................... 111 Changing gears .................................. 139 Changing the programming SmartKey ......................................... 73 5 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 6 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 6 Index Child-proof locks Rear doors ....................................... 60 Children In the vehicle ................................... 55 Restraint systems ............................ 56 Child seat Automatic recognition ..................... 46 Automatic recognition/air bag deactivation, self-test ...................... 48 Display message ............................ 185 LATCH-type (ISOFIX ) child seat anchors ............................................ 58 Special seat belt retractor ............... 58 Top Tether ....................................... 59 Troubleshooting ............................... 49 Cigarette lighter ................................ 224 Classification system for occupants (OCS) Faults ............................................... 45 Operation ......................................... 41 System self-test ............................... 44 Climate control Activating/deactivating ................. 122 Activating/deactivating airrecirculation mode ......................... 125 Controlling automatically ............... 123 Cooling with air dehumidification . . 122 Defrosting the windshield .............. 124 Demisting the windows .................. 125 Dual-zone automatic climate control ........................................... 121 Important safety information ......... 120 Indicator lamp ................................ 123 Maximum cooling .......................... 124 Problems with "cooling with air dehumidification" ........................... 123 Problems with the rear window heating .......................................... 125 Refrigerant ..................................... 309 Setting the air distribution ............. 123 Setting the airflow ......................... 124 Setting the air vents ...................... 126 Setting the temperature ................ 123 Switching the MONO function on/ off .................................................. 124 Switching the rear window heating on/off ............................... 125 Clock (on-board computer) ............... 179 Cockpit ................................................. 25 Combination switch .......................... 108 Compass ............................................ 235 Consumption statistics (on-board computer) .......................................... 170 Convenience closing feature .............. 84 Convenience opening feature ............ 84 Coolant (engine) Checking the level ......................... 240 Display message ............................ 194 Notes ............................................. 310 Temperature (on-board computer) . 171 Temperature gauge ........................ 166 Warning lamp ................................. 210 Cooling see Climate control Cornering light (display message) ... 191 Crash-responsive emergency lighting ............................................... 111 Cruise control Cruise control lever ....................... 156 Display message ............................ 197 Function/notes ............................. 156 Cup holder ......................................... 220 Center console .............................. 221 Rear compartment ......................... 221 Current fuel consumption (onboard computer) ............................... 170 Customer Assistance Center (CAC) ............................................... 21 Customer Relations Department ....... 21 D Dashboard see Cockpit Date (on-board computer) ................ Daytime running lamps Display message ............................ Switching on/off (on-board computer) ...................................... Delayed switch-off Exterior lighting (on-board computer) ...................................... Interior lighting (on-board computer) ...................................... Digital speedometer ......................... Display (cleaning instructions) ........ 179 194 180 180 180 171 247 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 7 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Index Display messages Brakes ........................................... 189 Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 183 Clearing (on-board computer) ........ 183 Driving systems ............................. 197 Engine ............................................ 194 KEYLESS-GO .................................. 202 Lamps ............................................ 191 Safety systems .............................. 184 Service interval display .................. 242 SmartKey ....................................... 201 Tires ............................................... 197 Vehicle ........................................... 200 Distance recorder ............................. 170 Door Automatic locking ............................ 78 Automatic locking (on-board computer) ...................................... 181 Display message ............................ 201 Emergency locking ........................... 79 Emergency unlocking ....................... 79 Opening (from inside) ...................... 78 Door control panel Overview .......................................... 31 Doors Important safety notes .................... 77 Drinking and driving ......................... 151 Drinks holder see Cup holder Drive program Automatic ...................................... 141 Manual ........................................... 142 SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 171 Drive program display ...................... 139 Driving abroad ................................... 155 Driving on flooded roads .................. 154 Driving safety system EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution) ..................................... 66 ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) .......................................... 63 ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ........................................... 63 Important safety information ........... 61 Driving safety systems ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 62 ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 66 BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 62 Overview .......................................... 61 Driving systems Cruise control ................................ 156 Dynamic handling package with sports mode .................................. 158 PARKTRONIC ................................. 159 Rear view camera .......................... 162 Driving tips ........................................ 139 Braking .......................................... 153 Downhill gradients ......................... 152 Driving on flooded roads ................ 154 Wet road surface ........................... 152 Winter ............................................ 155 DVD audio (on-board computer) ...... 175 Dynamic handling package with sports mode ....................................... 158 E EASY-ENTRY feature ............................ 99 Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 181 EASY-EXIT feature ............................... 99 Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 181 Crash-responsive ............................. 99 EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution) Display message ............................ 190 Function/notes ................................ 66 Electrical fuses see Fuses Electronic Brake force see EBD Electronic Stability Program see ESP® Electronic Traction System see ETS/4ETS Emergency call see mbrace Emergency release Fuel filler flap ................................. 146 Trunk ............................................... 82 Vehicle ............................................. 79 Emergency running mode Automatic transmission ................. 144 7 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 8 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 8 Index Emergency spare wheel Storage location ............................ 254 Emergency starting ........................... 266 Emergency tensioning device Function ........................................... 54 Safety guidelines ............................. 35 Emissions purification Service and warranty information .... 18 Engine Irregular running ............................ 136 Starting problems .......................... 136 Starting the engine with the key .... 133 Starting with KEYLESS-GO ............. 133 Switching off .................................. 149 Warning lamp Check Engine .......... 210 Engine electronics Malfunction .................................... 136 Engine number .................................. 304 Engine oil Adding ........................................... 240 Checking the oil level ..................... 239 Display message ............................ 196 Lubricant additives ........................ 309 Notes about oil grades ................... 308 Temperature (on-board computer) . 171 Viscosity ........................................ 309 ESC (Electronic Stability Control) see ESP® ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) Activating/deactivating (AMG vehicles) .......................................... 65 Activating/deactivating (except AMG vehicles) .................................. 64 Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 178 AMG menu (on-board computer) . . . 171 Display message ............................ 184 ETS/4ETS ........................................ 63 Important safety information ........... 63 Warning lamp ................................. 207 ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ................................................ 63 Exhaust check ................................... 151 Exhaust tail pipe (cleaning instructions) ...................................... 247 Exterior lighting see Lights Exterior mirrors Adjusting ....................................... 100 Dipping (automatic) ....................... 101 Folding in/out (automatically) ....... 101 Folding in/out (electrically) ........... 100 Folding in when locking (on-board computer) ...................................... 182 Out of position ............................... 101 Setting ........................................... 100 Storing settings (memory function) ........................................ 102 Storing the parking position .......... 101 Exterior view ........................................ 24 F First-aid kit ......................................... Flat tire Changing a wheel/mounting the spare wheel ................................... MOExtended run-flat system ......... Preparing the vehicle ..................... Raising the vehicle ......................... Floormat ............................................. Front fog lamp (display message) . . . Fuel Additives ........................................ Notes ............................................. Premium-grade unleaded gasoline . Refueling ........................................ Specifications ................................ Troubleshooting ............................. Fuel consumption Current (on-board computer) ......... Notes ............................................. Fuel filler cap (display message) ..... Fuel filler flap Emergency release ........................ Opening/closing ............................ Fuel level Calling up the range (on-board computer) ...................................... Fuses Dashboard fuse box ....................... Fuse allocation chart ..................... 253 255 259 254 256 236 193 308 306 306 145 307 148 170 150 197 146 146 170 267 267 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 9 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Index Fuse box in the engine compartment ................................. 267 Fuse box in the trunk ..................... 268 Notes ............................................. 266 G Garage door opener Clearing the memory ..................... Notes ............................................. Opening/closing the garage door .. Programming the remote control ... Gear indicator (on-board computer) .......................................... Gear lever ........................................... Gear or selector lever (cleaning guidelines) ......................................... Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts ......... Genuine wood trim and trim strips (cleaning instructions) ...................... Glove box ........................................... 235 232 234 232 171 137 248 302 248 216 H Headlamp cleaning system .............. 109 Adding washer fluid ....................... 241 Notes ............................................. 310 Headlamp mode (daytime driving) see Daytime running lamps Headlamps Cleaning ......................................... 246 Misting up ...................................... 110 Head restraints Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 96 Adjusting (manually) ........................ 95 Adjusting (rear) ................................ 96 Installing/removing (rear) ................ 96 see NECK-PRO head restraints (except AMG vehicles) Heating see Climate control High beam flasher ............................. 109 Hill start assist .................................. 135 Hood Closing ........................................... 239 Display message ............................ 200 Opening ......................................... 238 Hydroplaning ..................................... 154 I Immobilizer .......................................... 66 Instrument cluster Overview .......................................... 26 Submenu (on-board computer) ...... 178 Warning and indicator lamps ........... 27 Instrument cluster lighting ................ 26 Instrument lighting see Instrument cluster lighting Interior lighting Automatic control .......................... 111 Delayed switch-off (on-board computer) ...................................... 180 Emergency lighting ........................ 111 Manual control ............................... 111 Reading lamp ................................. 110 J Jack Storage location ............................ 253 Using ............................................. 256 Jump-starting ..................................... 262 K KEYLESS-GO Button ............................................ 132 Convenience closing feature ............ 85 Display message ............................ 202 Locking ............................................ 71 Starting the engine ........................ 133 Unlocking ......................................... 71 Key positions KEYLESS-GO .................................. 132 SmartKey ....................................... 131 Kickdown ................................... 140, 143 Knee bag .............................................. 38 L LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat anchors ................................................ 58 License plate lamp (display message) ............................................ 193 9 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 10 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 10 Version: 3.0.3.6 Index Lights Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off (on-board computer) ...................... 180 Active light function ....................... 109 Automatic headlamp mode ............ 107 Cornering light function ................. 110 Daytime running lamps .................. 107 Driving abroad ............................... 106 Fog lamps ...................................... 108 Hazard warning lamps ................... 109 High-beam headlamps ................... 108 Light switch ................................... 106 Low-beam headlamps .................... 107 Rear fog lamp ................................ 108 Switching the daytime driving lights on/off (on-board computer) . 180 Switching the exterior lighting delayed switch-off on/off (onboard computer) ............................ 180 Switching the surround lighting on/off (on-board computer) .......... 180 Light sensor (display message) ....... 194 Loading guidelines ............................ 216 Locking Automatic ........................................ 78 Emergency locking ........................... 79 From inside the vehicle (central locking button) ................................. 78 Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ............................... 181 Low-beam headlamp (display message) ............................................ 191 Luggage net ....................................... 217 Lumbar support ................................... 97 M M+S tires ............................................ 154 Main-beam headlamps (display message) ............................................ 192 Malfunction message see Display messages Malfunctions relevant to safety Reporting ......................................... 21 Manual drive program ...................... 142 Manual transmission Gear lever ...................................... 137 Pulling away ................................... 134 Shift recommendation ................... 138 Starting .......................................... 133 Matte finish (cleaning instructions) ...................................... 245 mbrace Call priority .................................... 230 Display message ............................ 185 Downloading destinations (COMAND) ..................................... 230 Emergency call .............................. 227 Important safety notes .................. 226 Locating a stolen vehicle ............... 231 MB info call button ........................ 229 Remote vehicle locking .................. 231 Roadside Assistance button .......... 229 Self-test ......................................... 227 System .......................................... 227 Vehicle remote unlocking .............. 231 Mechanical key Function/notes ................................ 73 Memory card (on-board computer) . 175 Memory function ............................... 102 Menu (on-board computer) AMG ............................................... 171 Assistance ..................................... 178 Audio ............................................. 175 DVD ............................................... 176 Navigation ..................................... 174 Overview of menus ........................ 169 Service ........................................... 178 Settings ......................................... 178 Telephone ...................................... 176 Trip ................................................ 170 Message memory .............................. 183 Messages see Display messages Mirrors Sun visor ........................................ 222 see Exterior mirrors or Rear-view mirror MOExtended run-flat system ........... 259 MP3 Operating (on-board computer) ..... 175 see separate operating instructions Multifunction display ........................ 168 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 11 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Index Multifunction steering wheel Operating the on-board computer . 167 Overview .......................................... 28 N Navigation On-board computer ....................... 174 see separate operating instructions NECK-PRO head restraints (except AMG vehicles) Operation ......................................... 49 Resetting triggered .......................... 50 Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle ................................................ 130 O Occupant Classification System (OCS) Faults ............................................... 45 Operation ......................................... 41 System self-test ............................... 44 Occupant safety Children in the vehicle ..................... 55 System overview .............................. 34 Octane number (fuel) ........................ 307 Odometer ........................................... 170 Off-road 4MATIC .......................................... 159 Oil see Engine oil On-board computer AMG menu ..................................... 171 Assistance menu ........................... 178 Audio menu ................................... 175 Convenience submenu .................. 181 Display messages .......................... 183 Factory settings ............................. 182 Important safety notes .................. 166 Instrument cluster submenu .......... 178 Lighting submenu .......................... 180 Message memory .......................... 183 Navigation menu ............................ 174 Operating video DVD ..................... 176 Operation ....................................... 167 Overview of menus ........................ 169 Service menu ................................. 178 Settings menu ............................... 178 Standard display submenu ............ 170 Telephone menu ............................ 176 Time/Date submenu ..................... 179 Trip menu ...................................... 170 Vehicle submenu ........................... 181 Opening and closing the side trim panels ................................................. 114 Operating system see On-board computer Outside temperature Display ........................................... 167 Overhead control panel Overview .......................................... 30 Override feature Rear side windows ........................... 60 P Paint code number ............................ 303 Paintwork (cleaning instructions) . . . 245 Panic alarm .......................................... 61 Panorama roof with power tilt/ sliding panel Opening/closing .............................. 89 Resetting ......................................... 90 Parking ............................................... 148 Parking aid PARKTRONIC ................................. 159 Rear view camera .......................... 162 Parking brake .................................... 149 Parking lamp (display message) ...... 193 Parking lock Releasing manually (automatic transmission) ................................. 144 Parking position Exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side ............................... 101 PARKTRONIC Activating/deactivating ................. 161 Function/notes ............................. 159 Malfunction .................................... 162 Problem ......................................... 162 Range of the sensors ..................... 159 Warning display ............................. 160 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp (only Canada) ............................. 46 11 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 12 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 12 Index PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp (only USA) ................................... 41 Pedals ................................................. 151 Permanent display (on-board computer) .......................................... 179 Permanent four-wheel drive see 4MATIC Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) . 247 Power washers .................................. 244 Power windows see Side windows Product information ............................ 18 Program selector button .................. 140 Pulling away Automatic transmission ................. 134 Manual transmission ...................... 134 R RACETIMER (on-board computer) .... 172 Radio Changing stations (on-board computer) ...................................... 175 see separate operating instructions Range (on-board computer) ............. 170 Rear compartment Setting the airflow ......................... 124 Setting the air vents ...................... 127 Rear fog lamp (display message) ..... 193 Rear seat backrest Display message ............................ 201 Folding forwards/back .................. 218 Rear seat backrest (display message) ............................................ 201 Rear view camera Function/notes ............................. 162 Rear view camera (cleaning instructions) ...................................... 247 Rear-view mirror Anti-glare (manual) .......................... 99 Dipping (automatic) ....................... 101 Rear window blind ............................ 222 Rear window heating Malfunction .................................... 125 Switching on/off ........................... 125 Refueling ............................................ 145 Remote control Programming (garage door opener) .......................................... 232 Reporting Malfunctions relevant to safety ........ 21 Reserve fuel Display message ............................ 197 Warning lamp ................................. 210 Restraint systems see SRS Reverse gear Engaging (manual transmission) .... 137 Reversing lamp (display message) . . 193 Roadside Assistance (breakdown) .... 19 Roller blind see Roller sunblind Roller sunblind Opening/closing .............................. 89 Panorama roof with power tilt/ sliding panel ..................................... 89 Rear side windows ......................... 222 Rear window .................................. 222 Roof carrier ........................................ 220 Roof lining and carpets (cleaning guidelines) ......................................... 249 Route see Route guidance (on-board computer) Route guidance (on-board computer) .......................................... 174 S Safety Children in the vehicle ..................... 55 Child restraint systems .................... 56 Occupant Classification System (OCS) ............................................... 41 Overview of occupant safety systems ........................................... 34 Safety systems see Driving safety systems Seat backrest Adaptive ........................................... 97 Seat belts Adjusting the height ......................... 53 Belt force limiters ............................ 54 Cleaning ......................................... 249 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 13 Version: 3.0.3.6 Index Correct usage .................................. 51 Emergency Tensioning Devices ........ 54 Fastening ......................................... 52 Important safety guidelines ............. 50 Releasing ......................................... 53 Safety guidelines ............................. 35 Special seat belt retractor ............... 58 Warning lamp ................................. 204 Warning lamp (function) ................... 54 Seat heating Indicator lamp (Malfunction) ............ 98 Seats Adaptive seat backrests (AMG vehicles) .......................................... 97 Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 94 Adjusting (manually and electrically) ...................................... 94 Adjusting the head restraint ............ 95 Adjusting the lumbar support .......... 97 Cleaning the cover ......................... 248 Correct driver's seat position ........... 92 Important safety notes .................... 93 Storing settings (memory function) ........................................ 102 Switching seat heating on/off ......... 97 Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 247 Service indicator see Service interval display Service interval display .................... 242 Displaying a service message (onboard computer) ............................ 243 Service menu (on-board computer) . 178 Service products Brake fluid ..................................... 309 Capacities ...................................... 305 Coolant (engine) ............................ 310 Engine oil ....................................... 308 Fuel ................................................ 306 Important safety notes .................. 304 Notes ............................................. 304 Refrigerant (air-conditioning system) .......................................... 309 Washer fluid ................................... 310 Settings Factory (on-board computer) ......... 182 On-board computer ....................... 178 SETUP (on-board computer) ............. 171 Shift ranges ....................................... 141 Shift recommendation ...................... 138 Side impact air bag ............................. 39 Side marker lamp (display message) ............................................ 193 Side windows Convenience closing feature ............ 84 Convenience opening feature .......... 84 Important safety information ........... 83 Opening/closing .............................. 84 Resetting ......................................... 85 Troubleshooting ............................... 86 Sliding sunroof Important safety information ........... 86 Troubleshooting ............................... 90 see Panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel see Tilt/sliding sunroof SmartKey Changing the battery ....................... 74 Changing the programming ............. 73 Checking the battery ................. 70, 74 Convenience closing feature ............ 84 Convenience opening feature .......... 84 Display message ............................ 201 Important safety notes .................... 70 Malfunction ...................................... 76 Starting the engine ........................ 133 Snow chains ...................................... 154 Socket ................................................ 224 Dashboard ..................................... 224 Rear compartment ......................... 225 SOS see mbrace Spare wheel Notes/data .................................... 298 Storage location ............................ 254 see Emergency spare wheel Speedometer Activating/deactivating additional speedometer (onboard computer) ............................ 179 Additional speedometer (onboard computer) ............................ 171 Segments ...................................... 167 Setting the unit (on-board computer) ...................................... 178 13 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 14 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 14 Index SPORT handling mode Activating/deactivating (AMG vehicles) .......................................... 64 Warning lamp ................................. 208 SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) Display message ............................ 185 Introduction ..................................... 34 Warning lamp ................................. 209 Warning lamp (function) ................... 34 Standard display (on-board computer) .......................................... 170 Starting the engine Important safety notes .................. 133 Station see Radio Steering (display message) .............. 201 Steering wheel Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 98 Adjusting (manually) ........................ 98 Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 167 Cleaning ......................................... 248 Important safety notes .................... 98 Memory function (storing settings) ........................................... 98 Storing settings (memory function) ........................................ 102 Steering wheel paddle shifters ........ 141 Stowage compartments Armrest (under) ............................. 217 Glove box ....................................... 216 Stowage space Cup holders ................................... 220 Important safety information ......... 216 Stowage well Trunk floor (under) ......................... 219 Submenu (on-board computer) Convenience .................................. 181 Factory setting ............................... 182 Instrument cluster ......................... 178 Lights ............................................. 180 Standard display ............................ 170 Time/Date ..................................... 179 Vehicle ........................................... 181 Summer opening see Convenience opening feature Sun visor ............................................ 221 Supplemental Restraint System see SRS Surround lighting (on-board computer) .......................................... 180 Switching off the alarm (ATA) ............ 67 T Tachometer ........................................ 167 Tailgate Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ........ 200 Tail lamps (Display message) ........... 192 Tank content Fuel gauge ....................................... 26 Technical data ................................... 302 C 250 ............................................. 311 C 250 4MATIC ............................... 311 C 300 ............................................. 311 C 300 4MATIC ............................... 312 C 350 .................................... 312, 313 C 350 4MATIC ............................... 312 Tires/wheels ................................. 293 TELEAID Call priority .................................... 230 Display message ............................ 185 Downloading destinations (COMAND) ..................................... 230 Emergency call .............................. 227 Important safety notes .................. 226 Locating a stolen vehicle ............... 231 MB info call button ........................ 229 Remote vehicle locking .................. 231 Roadside Assistance button .......... 229 Self-test ......................................... 227 System .......................................... 227 Vehicle remote unlocking .............. 231 Telephone Accepting a call ............................. 176 Display message ............................ 201 Menu (on-board computer) ............ 176 Number from the phone book ........ 177 Redialing ........................................ 177 Rejecting/ending a call ................. 177 Telephone compartment .................. 217 Temperature Coolant .......................................... 166 Coolant (on-board computer) ......... 171 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 15 Version: 3.0.3.6 Index Engine oil (on-board computer) ...... 171 Outside temperature ...................... 167 Setting ........................................... 123 Theft deterrent locking system Immobilizer ...................................... 66 Through-loading feature ................... 218 Tilt/sliding sunroof Opening/closing .............................. 88 Resetting ......................................... 88 Time (on-board computer) ................ 179 Timer (on-board computer) .............. 172 Tire pressure Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 277 Checking manually ........................ 275 Display message ............................ 197 Maximum ....................................... 280 Notes ............................................. 273 Pressure loss warning .................... 275 Recommended ............................... 272 Tire pressure monitoring system Function/notes ............................. 277 Restarting ...................................... 279 Warning lamp ................................. 212 Tires Aspect ratio (definition) ................. 292 Average weight of the vehicle occupants (definition) .................... 290 Bar (definition) ............................... 290 Characteristics .............................. 290 Checking ........................................ 271 Cleaning ......................................... 272 Definition of terms ......................... 290 Direction of rotation ...................... 284 Distribution of the vehicle occupants (definition) .................... 293 DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN) ............................................... 289 DOT (Department of Transportation) (definition) ............ 290 Flat tire .......................................... 254 GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) (definition) ..................................... 291 Guidelines to be observed ............. 271 GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) (definition) ..................................... 291 GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) (definition) ......................... 291 Increased vehicle weight due to optional equipment (definition) ...... Kilopascal (kPa) (definition) ........... Labeling (overview) ........................ Load bearing index (definition) ...... Load index ..................................... Load index (definition) ................... Maximum loaded vehicle weight (definition) ..................................... Maximum load on a tire (definition) ..................................... Maximum permissible tire pressure (definition) ....................... Maximum tire load ......................... Maximum tire load (definition) ....... Optional equipment weight (definition) ..................................... PSI (pounds per square inch) (definition) ..................................... Replacing ....................................... Service life ..................................... Sidewall (definition) ....................... Speed index (definition) ................. Storing ........................................... Structure and characteristics (definition) ..................................... Temperature .................................. TIN (Tire Identification Number) (definition) ..................................... Tire bead (definition) ...................... Tire pressure (definition) ................ Tire pressures (recommended) ...... Tire size (data) ............................... Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity, speed index .................... Tire tread ....................................... Tire tread (definition) ..................... Total load limit (definition) ............. Traction ......................................... Traction (definition) ....................... Tread wear ..................................... Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards ...................................... Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards (definition) .................... Unladen weight (definition) ............ Wear indicator (definition) ............. Wheel rim (definition) .................... 291 291 286 292 289 291 291 292 292 284 291 292 292 286 271 292 291 272 290 285 292 292 292 290 293 287 271 292 293 285 292 285 284 290 291 292 291 15 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 16 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 16 Index Tires and wheels (important safety information) ....................................... 270 Top Tether ............................................ 59 Towing Important safety guidelines ........... 264 Installing the towing eye ................ 264 Removing the towing eye ............... 265 Tow-starting Emergency engine starting ............ 266 Installing the towing eye ................ 266 Removing the towing eye ............... 266 Transfer case ..................................... 144 Transmission position display ......... 138 Transmission positions .................... 139 Trip computer (on-board computer) .......................................... 170 Trip odometer Calling up ....................................... 170 Resetting (on-board computer) ...... 171 Trunk Automatic opening ........................... 81 Emergency release .......................... 82 Important safety guidelines ............. 80 Locking separately ........................... 82 Trunk lid Display message ............................ 200 Turn signal (display message) ......... 191 Turn signals ....................................... 108 Type plate see Vehicle identification plate U Unlocking Emergency unlocking ....................... 79 From inside the vehicle (central unlocking button) ............................. 78 V Vanity mirror Sun visor ........................................ 222 Vehicle Data acquisition ............................... 22 Emergency unlocking ....................... 79 Equipment ....................................... 18 Exterior view .................................... 24 Individual settings (on-board computer) ...................................... 178 Loading .......................................... 280 Lowering ........................................ 258 Maintenance .................................... 19 Parking up ..................................... 150 Raising ........................................... 256 Reporting problems ......................... 21 Towing away .................................. 264 Tow-starting ................................... 264 Transporting .................................. 266 Vehicle data see Technical data Vehicle identification number see VIN Vehicle identification plate .............. 303 Vehicle tool kit .................................. 253 Video (DVD) ........................................ 176 Video DVD (on-board computer) ...... 176 VIN ...................................................... 303 W Warning and indicator lamps ABS ................................................ 206 Brakes ........................................... 203 Check Engine ................................. 210 Coolant .......................................... 210 ESP® .............................................. 207 ESP® OFF ....................................... 208 Fuel tank ........................................ 210 Overview .......................................... 27 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp (only Canada) ........... 46 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp (only USA) ................ 41 Reserve fuel ................................... 210 Seat belt ........................................ 204 SPORT handling mode ................... 208 SRS ................................................ 209 Tire pressure monitor .................... 212 Warranty ............................................ 302 Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 258 Wheel chock ...................................... 255 Wheels Changing/replacing ....................... 286 Changing a wheel .......................... 255 Checking ........................................ 271 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 17 Version: 3.0.3.6 Index Cleaning ......................................... 245 Guidelines to be observed ............. 271 Mounting a wheel .......................... 258 Removing a wheel .......................... 257 Tightening torque ........................... 258 Wheel size/tire size ....................... 293 Window curtain air bag Display message ............................ 186 Operation ......................................... 40 Windows see Side windows Windows (cleaning instructions) ..... 246 Windshield Defrosting ...................................... 124 Windshield washer fluid (display message) ............................................ 201 Windshield washer system Adding washer fluid ....................... 241 Notes ............................................. 310 Windshield wipers Important safety notes .................. 115 Replacing the wiper blades .... 116, 117 Switching on/off ........................... 116 Troubleshooting ............................. 117 Winter operation ............................... 155 Winter tires M+S tires ....................................... 154 Wiper blades Cleaning ......................................... 246 17 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 18 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 18 Version: 3.0.3.6 Introduction Product information We recommend using genuine MercedesBenz parts as well as conversion parts and accessories explicitly approved by us for your vehicle model. We have tested these parts to determine their reliability, safety and special suitability for Mercedes-Benz vehicles. Despite ongoing market research, Mercedes-Benz is unable to assess other parts. We cannot therefore be held responsible for them, even if in individual cases an official approval or authorization by governmental or other agencies should exist. The use of non-approved parts could affect your vehicle's operating safety. MercedesBenz therefore recommends that you use genuine Mercedes-Benz parts, conversion parts and accessories that have been approved for the type of vehicle. Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts, approved conversion parts and accessories are available from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. In addition, you will receive advice about permissible technical modifications, and the parts will be professionally installed. Operator's Manual Notes on the Operator's Manual This Operator's Manual contains a great deal of helpful information. We urge you to read it carefully and familiarize yourself with the vehicle before driving. For your own safety and longer service life of the vehicle, we urge you to follow the instructions and warnings contained in this Operator's Manual. Ignoring them could result in damage to the vehicle or personal injury to you or others. Vehicle damage caused by failure to follow instructions is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Vehicle equipment This manual describes all the standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Operator's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be equipped with all functions described. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. The equipment in your vehicle may therefore differ from that shown in the descriptions and illustrations. All the systems found in your vehicle are listed in the original purchase agreement of your vehicle. Should you have any questions concerning equipment and operation, please consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The Operating Instructions and the Maintenance Booklet are important documents and should be kept in the vehicle. Service and vehicle operation Service and literature The Service and Warranty Information booklet contains detailed information about the warranties covering your vehicle. Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will replace and repair any factory-fitted parts based on the terms and conditions of the following warranties: RNew Vehicle Limited Warranty System Warranty REmission Performance Warranty RCalifornia, Connecticut, Maine, Massachusetts, New York, Pennsylvania, Rhode Island and Vermont RState Warranty Enforcement Laws (Lemon Laws) REmission BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 19 Version: 3.0.3.6 Introduction Information for customers in California Under California law you may be entitled to a replacement of your vehicle or a refund of the purchase price or lease price, if after a reasonable number of repair attempts Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC and/or its authorized repair or service facilities fail to fix one or more substantial defects or malfunctions in the vehicle that are covered by its express warranty. During the period of 18 months from original delivery of the vehicle or the accumulation of 18 000 miles (approximately 29 000 km) on the odometer of the vehicle, whichever occurs first, a reasonable number of repair attempts is presumed for a retail buyer or lessee if one or more of the following occurs: (1) the same substantial defect or malfunction results in a condition that is likely to cause death or serious bodily injury if the vehicle is driven, that defect or malfunction has been subject to repair two or more times, and you have directly notified Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC in writing of the need for its repair. (2) the same substantial defect or malfunction of a less serious nature than category (1) has been subject to repair four or more times and you have directly notified Mercedes-Benz in writing of the need for its repair. (3) the vehicle is out of service by reason of repair of the same or different substantial defects or malfunctions for a cumulative total of more than 30 calendar days. Please send your written notice to: Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC Customer Assistance Center One Mercedes Drive Montvale, NJ 07645-0350 Maintenance The Service and Warranty Information Booklet describes all necessary maintenance work that should be performed at regular intervals. Always have the Service and Warranty Information Booklet with you when you bring the vehicle to an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The service advisor will record each service in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet for you. Breakdown assistance The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program provides factory-trained technical help in the event of a breakdown. Calls to the toll-free Roadside Assistance number will be answered by Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Representatives 24 hours a day, 365 days a year. 1-800-FOR-MERCedes(1-800-367-6372) (USA) 1-800-387-0100 (Canada) For additional information refer to the Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program brochure (in the USA) or the Roadside Assistance section of the Service and Warranty Information Booklet (in Canada) You will find both in your vehicle literature portfolio. Change of address or ownership In the event of a change of address, be sure to send in the "Change of Address Notice" found in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet, or simply call the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center (in the USA) at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) or Customer Service (in Canada) at 1-800-387-0100. This will assist us in contacting you in a timely manner should the need arise. 19 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 20 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 20 Version: 3.0.3.6 Introduction If you sell your Mercedes, please leave all literature with the vehicle to make it available to the next operator. If you bought this vehicle used, be sure to send in the "Notice of Purchase of Used Car" found in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet, or call the MercedesBenz Customer Assistance Center (in the USA) at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) or Customer Service (in Canada) at 1-800-387-0100. Vehicle operation outside the USA and Canada If you plan to operate your vehicle in foreign countries, please be aware that: RService facilities or replacement parts may not be readily available. gasoline for vehicles with catalytic converters may not be available. The use of leaded fuels can damage the catalytic converter. RGasoline may have a considerably lower octane rating. Improper fuel can cause engine damage. Certain Mercedes-Benz models are available for delivery in Europe under our European Delivery Program. For details, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or write to one of the following addresses: RUnleaded Operating safety Safety notes G Warning Work improperly carried out on electronic components and associated software could cause them to cease functioning. Because the vehicle's electronic components are interconnected, any modifications made may produce an undesired effect on other systems. Electronic malfunctions could seriously impair the operating safety of your vehicle. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for repairs or modifications to electronic components. Other improper work or modifications on the vehicle could also have a negative impact on the operating safety of the vehicle. Some safety systems only function when the engine is running. You should therefore never turn off the engine while driving. G Warning Heavy blows against the vehicle underbody or tires/wheels may cause serious damage and impair the operating safety of your vehicle. Such blows can be caused, for example, by running over an obstacle, road debris or a pothole. If you feel a sudden significant vibration or ride disturbance, or you suspect that damage to your vehicle has occurred: In the USA Rturn Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC European Delivery Department One Mercedes Drive Montvale, NJ 07645-0350 Rslow In Canada Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc. European Delivery Department 98 Vanderhoof Avenue Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9 on your hazard warning flashers. down carefully. Rdrive with caution to an area which is a safe distance from the road. Inspect the vehicle underbody and tires/ wheels for possible damage. If the vehicle appears unsafe, have it towed to the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or other qualified maintenance or repair facility for further inspection or repairs. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 21 Version: 3.0.3.6 Introduction Proper use of the vehicle In Canada To ensure proper use of the vehicle, you must familiarize yourself with the following information and rules: Customer Relations Department Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc. 98 Vanderhoof Avenue Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9 Rsafety notes in this Operator's Manual data in this Operator's Manual Rtraffic rules and regulations Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to motor vehicles Rtechnical G Warning! Various warning labels are attached to your vehicle. These warning labels are intended to make you and others aware of various risks. Do not remove any of these warning labels unless explicitly instructed to do so by information on the label itself. Removing warning labels may cause you and others to be unaware of certain risks which may result in an accident and/or personal injury. Problems with your vehicle If you should experience a problem with your vehicle, particularly one that you believe may affect its safe operation, we urge you to contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately to have the problem diagnosed and rectified. If the problem is not resolved to your satisfaction, please discuss the problem with the Mercedes-Benz Center again or, if necessary, contact us at one of the following addresses. In the USA Customer Assistance Center Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC One Mercedes Drive Montvale, NJ 07645-0350 Reporting malfunctions relevant to safety For the USA only: The following text is reproduced as required of all manufacturers according to Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of 1966. Reporting safety defects If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC. If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC. To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to: http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA Headquarters, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE, West Building, Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain additional information about vehicle safety from: http://www.safercar.gov. Z 21 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Introduction 22 Limited Warranty ! Follow the instructions in this manual about the proper operation of your vehicle as well as about possible vehicle damage. Damage to your vehicle that arises from culpable contraventions against these instructions are not covered either by Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty or by the New or Used-Vehicle Warranty of Daimler AG. Data stored in the vehicle Information regarding electronic recording devices (Including California Code Supplement § 9951) Please note that your vehicle is equipped with devices that can record vehicle systems data. If your vehicle is equipped with mbrace2 data is transmitted in the event of an accident. This information serves, for example, to test vehicle systems after an accident and to continually improve vehicle safety. Daimler AG can access this data and submit it: Rfor safety research or vehicle diagnosis purposes Rwith the consent of the vehicle owner or lessee Rin response to an official request by law enforcement or other government agency Rfor use in arbitration of disputes that involve Daimler AG, its subsidiaries or its sales and service organizations Ras otherwise required or permitted by law Please observe the mbrace2 order agreement regarding further details on data that this system records and transmits. 2 The system is called TELEAID in Canada. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 22 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 23 Version: 3.0.3.6 23 Exterior view ....................................... Cockpit ................................................. Instrument cluster .............................. Multifunction steering wheel ............. Center console .................................... Overhead control panel ...................... Door control panel .............................. 24 25 26 28 29 30 31 At a glance BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 24 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 24 Version: 3.0.3.6 Exterior view At a glance Exterior view Function Trunk lid Vehicle tool kit ; Page Function Page C Exterior mirrors 100 253 D Windshield wipers 115 Rear window heating 125 E = Lights 111 ? Fuel filler flap 145 Opening the hood Engine oil Coolant 238 239 240 A Defrosting the windshield Cleaning the windows 124 246 F Towing away 264 G Tires and wheels Flat tire 270 254 : B Sliding sunroof 86 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 25 Version: 3.0.3.6 Cockpit 25 At a glance Cockpit Function Page Steering wheel paddle shifters 141 ; Cruise control lever 156 = Instrument cluster 26 ? Horn A PARKTRONIC warning display (Canada only) 159 B Overhead control panel 30 C Operates the automatic climate control system Ignition lock Start/Stop button : D Function E F Page Adjusts the steering wheel manually 98 Adjusts the steering wheel electrically 98 G Combination switch 108 H Parking brake 148 I On-board diagnostics socket J Opens the hood 238 120 K Releases the parking brake 148 131 132 L Light switch 106 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 26 Version: 3.0.3.6 Instrument cluster 26 Instrument cluster At a glance Overview Function 3 Page : Fuel gauge ; Coolant temperature gauge 166 = Speedometer 167 ? Segments 167 A Multifunction display 168 B Tachometer 167 temperature3 C Outside D Outside temperature Additional speedometer3 Vehicles with automatic transmission. Function Gear indicator and drive program display3 139 F Clock 179 G Brightness control knob for the instrument cluster lighting: turn clockwise or anti-clockwise E 167 167 179 Page BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 27 Version: 3.0.3.6 Instrument cluster 27 At a glance Warning and indicator lamps Function Page Function Page : High beam 108 F ABS 206 ; ESP® OFF 207 G Seat belt 204 = Low beam 107 H Fog lamp 108 ? Turn signal 108 I Rear fog lamp 108 A ESP® 207 J Coolant 210 B Turn signal 108 K Brakes (USA only) 203 C SPORT handling mode in AMG vehicles L Brakes (Canada only) 203 208 M Check Engine 210 D Tire pressure monitor 212 N Reserve fuel 210 E SRS 209 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 28 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 28 Version: 3.0.3.6 Multifunction steering wheel At a glance Multifunction steering wheel Function : Multifunction display ; COMAND/audio system; see the separate operating instructions = ? ~6 Makes/accepts or rejects/ ends a call WX Adjusts the volume or operates the RACETIMER in AMG vehicles 8 Mute ? Activates voice control; see the separate operating instructions Page 168 176 172 Function A % Back or deactivates voice control B =; Selects a menu 9: Selects the submenu or scrolls through lists a Confirms selections and hides display messages Page 169 169 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 29 Version: 3.0.3.6 Center console 29 At a glance Center console Function : Hazard warning lamps ; ATA indicator lamp = Indicator lamp 45 (USA only) Indicator lamp 45 (Canada only) ? Page 109 158 E Stowage compartment Ashtray Cigarette lighter 216 223 224 F Gear lever Selector lever 137 138 G Cup holder 220 H Stowage compartment 216 I Audio/COMAND controller J Selects the drive program 41 46 COMAND/audio system; see separate operating instructions Seat heating 97 B PARKTRONIC (Canada only) 159 Rear window roller sunblind 222 Page Dynamic handling package with sports mode D 67 A C Function 140 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 30 Version: 3.0.3.6 Overhead control panel 30 At a glance Overhead control panel Function : ; = ? A B 4 u To switch the rear interior lighting on/off Page 111 | To switch the automatic interior lighting control on/off 111 p To switch the righthand reading lamp on/off 110 3 To open/close the tilt/sliding sunroof 3 To open/close the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel with roller sunblinds Function Page C Rear-view mirror D Integrated electronic compass 235 Buttons for the garage door opener 232 E 99 F Microphone for mbrace (emergency call system) telephone and Voice Control System4 G F Roadside Assistance button (mbrace system) 229 p To switch the lefthand reading lamp on/off 110 c To switch the front interior lighting on/off 111 88 89 H ï Button for MB info call (mbrace system) 229 I G SOS button (mbrace system) 227 The Voice Control System is only available in connection with COMAND. Observe the additional operating instructions. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 31 Version: 3.0.3.6 Door control panel 31 At a glance Door control panel Function Page : Opens the door 78 ; %& Locks/unlocks the vehicle 78 = Adjusts the seat electrically 94 ? r45= Stores settings for the seat, exterior mirrors and steering wheel 102 7Zª\ Adjusts and folds the exterior mirrors in/out electrically 100 W Opens/closes the side windows 84 n Activates/ deactivates the override feature for the side windows in the rear compartment 60 o Unlocks the trunk lid 81 A B C D BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 32 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 32 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 33 Version: 3.0.3.6 33 Vehicle equipment .............................. Occupant safety .................................. Children in the vehicle ........................ Panic alarm .......................................... Driving safety systems ....................... Anti-theft systems .............................. 34 34 55 61 61 66 Safety BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 34 Occupant safety Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard Safety 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 34 Version: 3.0.3.6 and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. Occupant safety Overview of occupant safety In this section you will learn the most important facts about the restraint system components of the vehicle. The restraint systems are: RSeat belts RChild restraint systems RLATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat anchors Additional protection is provided by: RSRS (Supplemental Restraint System) head restraints RAir bag system components with: - PASSENGER air bag OFF indicator lamp - USA only: front passenger seat with Occupant Classification System (OCS) - Canada only: front passenger seat with BabySmart™ air bag deactivation system The different air bag systems work independently of each other. The protective functions of the systems work in conjunction with each other. Not all air bags are deployed in an accident. RNECK-PRO G Warning Modifications to or work improperly conducted on restraint system components or their wiring, as well as tampering with interconnected electronic systems, can lead to the restraint systems no longer functioning as intended. Air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices (ETDs), for example, could deploy inadvertently or fail to deploy in accidents although the deceleration threshold for air bag deployment is exceeded. Therefore, never modify the restraint systems. Do not tamper with electronic components or their software. i See "Children in the vehicle" (Y page 55) for more information on infants and children traveling with you in the vehicle and restraints for infants and children. SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) Introduction SRS reduces the risk of occupants coming into contact with the vehicle's interior in the event of an accident. It can also reduce the effect of the forces to which occupants are subjected during an accident. SRS consists of: Rthe 6 SRS warning lamp bags Rair bag control unit (with crash sensors) Rbelt tensioners Rbelt force limiters Rair SRS warning lamps SRS functions are checked regularly when you switch on the ignition and when the engine is running. Therefore, malfunctions can be detected in good time. The 6 SRS warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the ignition is switched on. It goes out no later than a few seconds after the engine is started. The SRS components are in operational readiness when the 6 SRS warning lamp is not lit while the engine is running. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 35 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety G Warning The SRS self-check has detected a malfunction if the 6 SRS warning lamp: Rdoes not come on at all to go out approximately 4 seconds after the engine was started Rcomes on after the engine was started or while driving For your safety, Mercedes-Benz strongly recommends that you have the system checked as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Otherwise the SRS may not be activated when it is needed in an accident, which could result in serious or fatal injury. The SRS might also deploy unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could also result in injury. In addition, improper work on the SRS creates a risk of rendering the SRS inoperative or causing unintended air bag deployment. Work on the SRS must therefore only be performed by qualified technicians. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. If it is necessary to modify an air bag system to accommodate a person with disabilities, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for details. USA only: Call our Customer Assistance Center at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) for details. Rfails Safety guidelines for seat belts, Emergency Tensioning Devices (ETDs) and air bags G Warning RDamaged seat belts or seat belts that have been subjected to stress in an accident must be replaced. Their anchoring points must also be checked. Only use seat belts installed or supplied by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. RAir bags and pyrotechnic Emergency Tensioning Devices (ETDs) contain perchlorate material, which may require special handling and regard for the environment. Check your national disposal guidelines. California residents, see www.dtsc.ca.gov/HazardousWaste/ Perchlorate/index.cfm. RAir bags and ETDs are designed to function on a one-time-only basis. An air bag or ETD that has deployed must be replaced. RDo not pass seat belts over sharp edges. They could tear. RDo not make any modification that could change the effectiveness of the seat belts. RDo not bleach or dye seat belts as this may severely weaken them. In a crash they may not be able to provide adequate protection. RNo modifications of any kind may be made to any components or wiring of the SRS. RDo not change or remove any component or part of the SRS. RDo not install additional trim material, seat covers, badges, etc. over the steering wheel hub, front-passenger front air bag cover, outer sides of the seat backrests, door trim panels, or door frame trims. RDo not install additional electrical/ electronic equipment on or near SRS components and wiring. RKeep area between air bags and occupants free of objects (e.g. packages, purses, umbrellas, etc.). RDo not hang items such as coat hangers from the coat hooks or handles over the door. These items may be thrown around in the vehicle and cause head and other injuries when the window curtain air bag is deployed. RAir bag system components will be hot after an air bag has inflated. Do not touch them. RNever place your feet on the instrument panel, dashboard, or on the seat. Always keep both feet on the floor in front of the seat. RImproper repair work on the SRS creates a risk of rendering the SRS inoperative or causing unintended air bag deployment. Work on the SRS must therefore only be Z 35 Safety BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Safety 36 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 36 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety performed by qualified technicians. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. RFor your protection and the protection of others, when scrapping the air bag unit or ETD, our safety instructions must be followed. These instructions are available from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. RGiven the considerable deployment speed, required inflation volume, and the material of the air bags, there is the possibility of abrasions or other, potentially more serious injuries resulting from air bag deployment. If you sell your vehicle, Mercedes-Benz strongly recommends that you inform the subsequent owner that the vehicle is equipped with SRS. Also refer them to the applicable section in the Operator's Manual. Air bags Important safety notes G Warning Air bags are designed to reduce the incidence of injuries and fatalities in certain situations: Rfrontal impacts (driver's and frontpassenger front air bags and driver's knee bag) Rside impacts (side impact air bags, window curtain air bags and pelvis air bags) However, no system available today can completely eliminate injuries and fatalities. When the air bags are deployed, a small amount of powder is released. The powder generally does not constitute a health hazard and does not indicate that there is a fire in the vehicle. In order to prevent potential breathing difficulties, you should leave the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. If you have any breathing difficulty but cannot get out of the vehicle after the air bag inflates, then get fresh air by opening a window or door. G Warning To reduce the risk of injuries during front air bag inflation, the driver and front-passenger must always be seated correctly and have their seat belts fastened accordingly. For maximum protection in the event of a collision, you must always be in the normal seat position with your back against the backrest. Fasten your seat belt and make sure that it is correctly positioned on your body. Since the air bag inflates with considerable speed and force, a proper seating position and correct positioning of the hands on the steering wheel will help to keep you at a safe distance from the air bag. Occupants who are not wearing their seat belt, are not seated properly or are too close to the air bag can be seriously injured or killed by an air bag as it inflates with great force instantaneously: RSit with the seat belt properly fastened in a position that is as upright as possible with your back against the seat backrest. RMove the driver's seat as far back as possible, still permitting proper operation of vehicle controls. The distance from the center of the driver's chest to the center of the air bag cover on the steering wheel must be at least 10 inches(25 cm) or more. You should be able to accomplish this by adjusting the seat and steering wheel. If you have any difficulties, please contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. RDo not lean your head or chest close to the steering wheel or dashboard. ROnly hold the steering wheel by the rim. Placing hands and arms inside the rim can increase the risk and potential severity of hand/arm injury when the driver front air bag inflates. RAdjust the front-passenger seat as far back as possible from the dashboard when the seat is occupied. ROccupants, especially children, should never place their bodies or lean their heads in the area of the door where the side 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 37 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety impact air bag inflates. This could result in serious injuries or death should the side impact air bag be deployed. Always sit as upright as possible, wear the seat belt properly and use an appropriately sized child restraint, infant restraint or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. RCanada only: children under 12 years may only sit in the front-passenger seat if they are seated in a child restraint system which is compatible with BabySmart™ and approved by Mercedes-Benz. If the child restraint system is installed properly, the front-passenger front air bag is deactivated in conjunction with the BabySmart™ system installed in the vehicle. Otherwise, the child could be struck by the air bag when it inflates in a crash. This could lead to serious or fatal injuries. Failure to follow these instructions can result in severe injuries to you or other occupants. If you sell your vehicle, it is important that you make the buyer aware of this safety information. Be sure to give the buyer this Operator's Manual. G Warning Accident research shows that the safest place for children in an automobile is in a rear seat. A side impact air bag related injury may occur if occupants, especially children, are not properly seated or restrained when next to a side impact air bag which needs to deploy rapidly in a side impact in order to do its job. To help avoid the possibility of injury, please follow these guidelines: (1) (2) The air bags are only deployed if the airbag control unit detects the need for deployment. Only in the event of such a situation will they provide their supplemental protection. The driver and passenger should always wear their seat belts. Otherwise, it is not possible for the air bags to provide their supplemental protection. In the event of other types of impacts and impacts below air bag deployment thresholds, air bags will not deploy. The driver and passengers will then be protected to the extent possible by a properly fastened seat belt. A properly fastened seat belt is also needed to provide the best possible protection in a rollover. Air bags offer supplemental protection but are not a substitute for seat belts. All vehicle occupants must fasten their seat belts regardless of whether your vehicle is equipped with airbags or not. It is important for your safety and that of your passenger to have deployed air bags replaced and to have any malfunctioning air bags repaired. This will help to make sure the air bags continue to perform their protective function for the vehicle occupants in the event of a crash. Front air bags G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 36). The front air bags increase protection for the driver's and front-passenger's head and chest. Always sit as upright as possible and use the seat belts properly. Make sure that children 12 years old and under use an appropriately sized child restraint, infant restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. Always wear seat belts properly. Z 37 Safety BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Occupant safety are inflated with the maximum amount of propellant gas available. In impact situations with deceleration or acceleration values lower than the vehicle deceleration or acceleration values preset in the system, the front air bags are not deployed. You will then be protected by the seat belt. Safety 38 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 38 Version: 3.0.3.6 ! Vehicles with BabySmart™ (Canada only): Driver's air bag : deploys in front of the steering wheel; front-passenger air bag ; deploys in front of and above the glove box. They are deployed: Rin the event of certain frontal impacts the system determines that air bag deployment can offer additional protection to that provided by the seat belt Rif the seat belt is fastened Rindependently of other air bags in the vehicle If the vehicle overturns, the front air bags are generally not deployed unless the system detects high vehicle deceleration in a longitudinal direction. Your vehicle has adaptive, two-stage front air bags. In the event of a collision, the air bag control unit evaluates the vehicle deceleration. When the first deployment threshold is reached, the front air bag is filled with enough propellant gas to reduce the risk of injuries. The front air bag is fully deployed if a second deployment threshold is exceeded within a few milliseconds. Vehicles with OCS (USA only): frontpassenger front air bag deployment is also influenced by the passenger's weight category as identified by the Occupant Classification System (OCS) (Y page 41). Vehicles with OCS (USA only): the lighter the passenger side occupant, the higher the vehicle deceleration rate required for second stage inflation of the front-passenger front air bag. In the second stage, the front air bags Rif do not place any objects which weigh more than 20 lb (9 kg) on the front-passenger seat. This could cause the system to identify the seat as being occupied. In the event of an accident, the restraint systems on the front-passenger side are triggered. Have restraint systems that have been triggered replaced. The front-passenger air bag will only deploy if: Rthe system, based on the OCS weight sensor readings, detects that the frontpassenger seat is occupied (USA only). Rthe 45 indicator lamp in the center console is not lit, USA: (Y page 41), Canada: (Y page 46). Rthe impact exceeds a preset deployment threshold. Driver's knee bag G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 36). BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 39 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety Rknee injuries injuries Rlower leg injuries Driver's knee bag : inflates beneath the steering column. If the system determines that deployment of driver's knee bag : can offer additional protection to that provided by the seat belt in the event of a frontal impact, the system will deploy it together with the driver's front air bag. Driver's knee bag : operates best in conjunction with a properly positioned and fastened seat belt. Rthigh When deployed, the side impact air bags offer additional protection for the thorax of the vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle on which the impact occurs. However, they do not protect the: Safety Driver's knee bag : increases protection for the driver against the risk of: Rhead Rneck Rarms Side impact air bags G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 36). G Warning! The pressure sensors for side impact air bag control are located in the doors. Do not modify any components of the doors or door trim panels including, for example, the addition of door speakers. Improper repair work on the doors or the modification or addition of components to the doors create a risk of rendering the side impact air bags inoperative or causing unintended air bag deployment. Work on the doors must therefore only be performed by qualified technicians. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. G Warning Only use seat covers which have been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle model. Using seat covers or other seat coverings can cause a malfunction of the side impact air bags and/or the pelvis air bags. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for availability. 39 Side impact air bags : deploy next to the outer seat cushion. Side impact air bags : are deployed: Ron the side on which an impact occurs the start of an accident with a high rate of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact Rindependently of seat belt use Rindependently of the front air bags Rindependently of the Emergency Tensioning Devices Side air bags : will not deploy in side impacts with deceleration rates which do not exceed the system's preset deployment thresholds for vehicle deceleration or acceleration. You will then be protected by the seat belt. Vehicles with OCS (USA only): if the OCS detects that the front-passenger seat is not occupied and the front-passenger seat belt is not fastened (the belt tongue is not engaged in the seat belt buckle), the side impact air bag on the front-passenger side will not deploy. The side impact air bag on the frontpassenger side will deploy if the frontpassenger seat belt is fastened, regardless of Rat Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 40 Occupant safety whether the front-passenger seat is occupied or not. ! Vehicles with BabySmart™ (Canada only): Safety 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 40 Version: 3.0.3.6 do not place any objects which weigh more than 20 lb (9 kg) on the front-passenger seat. This could cause the system to identify the seat as being occupied. In the event of an accident, the restraint systems on the front-passenger side are triggered. Have restraint systems that have been triggered replaced. Pelvis air bags G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 36). Pelvis air bags are not available on AMG vehicles. G Warning Only use seat covers which have been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle model. Using seat covers or other seat coverings can cause a malfunction of the side impact air bags and/or the pelvis air bags. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for availability. Pelvis air bag deployment enhances the level of protection of the vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle on which the impact occurs. Pelvis air bags : deploy next to and below the outer seat cushions. They are deployed: Ron the side on which an impact occurs the start of an accident with a high rate of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact Rindependently of seat belt use Rindependently of the front air bags Rindependently of the Emergency Tensioning Devices Pelvis air bags : will not deploy in side impacts with deceleration rates which do not exceed the system’s preset deployment thresholds for vehicle deceleration or acceleration. You will then be protected by the seat belt. Vehicles with OCS (USA only): if the OCS detects that the front-passenger seat is not occupied and the front-passenger seat belt is not fastened (the belt tongue is not engaged in the seat belt buckle), the pelvis air bag on the front-passenger side will not deploy. The pelvis air bag on the front-passenger side will deploy if the front-passenger seat belt is fastened, regardless of whether the frontpassenger seat is occupied or not. Rat Window curtain air bags G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 36). The window curtain air bags enhance the level of protection for the head (but not chest or arms) of the vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle on which the impact occurs. The window curtain air bags are integrated into the side of the roof frame and deploy in the area extending from the front door (Apillar) to the rear door (C-pillar). BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 41 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety 41 The system does not deactivate: Rthe side impact air bag pelvis air bag Rthe window curtain air bag Rthe Emergency Tensioning Devices To be classified correctly, the front passenger must sit: Rwith the seat belt properly fastened a position that is as upright as possible with the back against the seat backrest Rwith their feet on the floor If the front-passenger's weight is transferred to another object in the vehicle (e.g. by leaning on armrests), OCS may not be able to approximate the occupant's weight category. If the front passenger seat, the seat cover, or the seat cushion are damaged, have the necessary repair work carried out at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use seat accessories that have been approved by Mercedes-Benz. Both the driver and the front passenger should observe the 45 indicator lamp to determine whether or not the front passenger is positioned correctly. Rin Window curtain air bags : are deployed: Ron the side on which an impact occurs the start of an accident with a high rate of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact Rregardless of whether the front-passenger seat is occupied Rindependently of seat belt use Rindependently of the front air bags Window curtain air bags : will not deploy in impacts with deceleration rates which do not exceed the system’s preset deployment thresholds for vehicle deceleration or acceleration. You will then be protected by the seat belt. Rat Occupant classification system (OCS) How the Occupant Classification System works The Occupant Classification System (OCS) is standard equipment in the USA. OCS categorizes the occupant on the frontpassenger seat by means of a weight sensor. The front-passenger front air bag is automatically deactivated for certain weight categories. The respective status can be recognized by the 45 indicator lamp. With the 45 indicator lamp illuminated, the front-passenger front air bag is deactivated. G Warning If the 45 indicator lamp illuminates when an adult or someone larger than a small individual is in the front passenger seat, have the front passenger reposition himself or herself in the seat until the 45 indicator lamp goes out. In the event of a collision, the air bag control unit will not allow front passenger front air bag deployment when the OCS has classified the front passenger seat occupant as weighing as much as or less than a typical 12-month-old child in a standard child restraint or if the front passenger seat is classified as being empty. When the OCS senses that the front passenger seat occupant is classified as being up to or less than the weight of a typical Z Safety Rthe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Safety 42 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 42 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety 12-month-old child in a standard child restraint, the 45 indicator lamp will illuminate when the engine is started and remain illuminated. This indicates that the front passenger front air bag is deactivated. When the OCS senses that the front passenger seat is classified as being empty, the 45 indicator lamp will illuminate when the engine is started and remain illuminated. This indicates that the front passenger front air bag is deactivated. When the OCS senses that the front passenger seat occupant is classified as being heavier than the weight of a typical 12month-old child seated in a standard child restraint or as being a small individual (such as a young teenager or a small adult), the 45 indicator lamp will illuminate for approximately 6 seconds when the engine is started. Depending on occupant weight sensor readings from the seat, it will then remain illuminated or go out. With the 45 indicator lamp illuminated, the front passenger front air bag is deactivated. With the 45 indicator lamp out, the front passenger front air bag is activated. When the OCS senses that the front passenger seat occupant is classified as an adult or someone larger than a small individual, the 45 indicator lamp will illuminate for approximately six seconds when the engine is started and then go out. This indicates that the front passenger front air bag is activated. If the 45 indicator lamp is illuminated, the front passenger front air bag is deactivated and will not be deployed. If the 45 indicator lamp is not illuminated, the front passenger front air bag is activated and will be deployed Rin the event of certain frontal impacts Rif the impact exceeds a predetermined triggering threshold Rindependent of the side impact air bag or pelvis air bag If the front passenger front air bag is deployed, the rate of inflation will be influenced by Rthe rate of vehicle deceleration as assessed by the air bag control unit front passenger's weight category as identified by the OCS Rthe For further information, see the section regarding air bag display messages (Y page 187). G Warning According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained on the rear seats than on the front-passenger seat. Thus, we strongly recommend that children be placed in the rear seats whenever possible. Regardless of seating position, children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriate infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. The infant or child restraint must be properly secured with the vehicle's seat belt, the seat belt and Top Tether strap, or lower anchors and Top Tether strap, fully in accordance with the child seat manufacturer's instructions. Occupants, especially children, should always sit as upright as possible, wear the seat belt properly and use an appropriately sized infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. Children can be killed or seriously injured by an inflating air bag. Note the following important information when circumstances require you to place a child in the frontpassenger seat: RYour vehicle is equipped with air bag technology designed to deactivate the front-passenger front air bag in your vehicle when the system senses the weight of a typical 12-month-old child or less along 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 43 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety with the weight of a standard appropriate child restraint on the front-passenger seat. RA child in a rear-facing child restraint on the front-passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the front-passenger front air bag inflates in a collision which could occur under some circumstances, even with the air bag technology installed in your vehicle. The only means to eliminate this risk completely is never to place a child in a rear-facing child restraint in the frontpassenger seat. We therefore strongly recommend that you always place a child in a rear-facing child restraint on the rear seat. RIf you install a rear-facing child restraint on the front-passenger seat, make sure the 45 indicator lamp is illuminated, indicating that the front-passenger front air bag is deactivated. Should the 45 indicator lamp not illuminate or go out while the restraint is installed, please check installation. Periodically check the 45 indicator lamp while driving to make sure that the 45 indicator lamp is illuminated. If the 45 indicator lamp goes out or remains out, do not transport a child on the front-passenger seat until the system has been repaired. A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the front-passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the front-passenger front air bag inflates. RIf you place a child in a forward-facing child restraint on the front-passenger seat: - move the seat as far back as possible - use the proper child restraint recommended for the age, size and weight of the child - secure child restraint with the vehicle's seat belt according to the child seat manufacturer's instructions RFor children larger than the typical 12month-old child, the front-passenger front air bag may or may not be activated. 43 Deployment of the driver front air bag does not mean that the front-passenger front air bag should also have deployed. OCS may have determined: Rthat the seat was unoccupied or occupied by a weight of up to or less than that of a typical 12-month-old child seated in a standard child restraint Rthat the seat was occupied by a small individual (e.g. a young teenager or a small adult) or a child who weighs more than a typical 12-month-old child in a standard child restraint system These are examples of when OCS deactivates the front-passenger front air bag. The air bag is deactivated despite the impact fulfilling the criteria for deploying the driver's front air bag. If the SmartKey has been removed from the ignition lock or is in position 0, indicator lamp 45: does not light up. G Warning If the red 6 SRS warning lamp in the instrument cluster and the 45 indicator lamp light up simultaneously, the OCS is malfunctioning. The front passenger front air bag will be deactivated in this case. Have the system checked by qualified technicians as soon as possible. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Only have the seat repaired or replaced at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Z Safety BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 44 Occupant safety In order to ensure proper operation of the air bag system and OCS: RSit with the seat belt properly fastened in a Safety 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 44 Version: 3.0.3.6 position that is as upright as possible with your back against the seat backrest. RWhen seated, a passenger should not position him/herself in such a way as to cause the passenger's weight to be lifted from the seat cushion as this may result in the OCS being unable to correctly approximate the passenger's weight category. RRead and observe all warnings in this chapter. System self-test The 45 indicator lamp illuminates when you: the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the ignition lock Ron vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the Start/Stop button once or twice If an adult is seated properly on the passenger seat and the OCS classifies the occupant as an adult, the 45 indicator lamp illuminates and goes out again after approximately 6 seconds. If the seat is not occupied and the OCS classifies the front passenger seat as being unoccupied, the 45 indicator lamp will illuminate and not go out. Rturn G Warning! If the 4 5 indicator lamp does not illuminate, the system is not functioning. You must contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center before seating any child on the front passenger seat. For more information, see "Problems with the Occupant Classification System" (Y page 45). G Warning Never place anything between seat cushion and child seat (e.g. a pillow), since it reduces the effectiveness of the OCS. The underside and rear side child restraint system must be placed entirely on the seat cushion and the backrest of the front-passenger seat backrest. If necessary, adjust the tilt of the passenger seat backrest. An incorrectly mounted child seat could cause injuries to the child in case of an accident, instead of increasing protection for the child. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for installation of child restraint systems. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 45 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety 45 Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions The 45 indicator lamp illuminates and remains illuminated. The person sitting on the front-passenger seat: OCS is malfunctioning. X Have OCS checked as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display (Y page 187). Rweighs as much as a typical adult Rweighs more than a child G Warning If the 45 indicator lamp illuminates and remains illuminated when the weight of a typical adult or someone larger than a small individual has been detected on the passenger seat, do not allow any occupant to use the passenger seat until the system has been repaired. Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions The 45 OCS is malfunctioning. indicator lamp does not X Make sure there is nothing between the seat cushion and the illuminate and/or does child seat. not remain illuminated. X Check the installation of the child restraint system. The front-passenger X Make sure there are no objects applying additional weight onto seat is: the seat. Runoccupied X If the 45 indicator lamp remains out, have OCS checked Roccupied with the as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Do weight of a typical not transport a child on the front-passenger seat until OCS has 12-month-old child in been repaired. a standard child X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction restraint or less display (Y page 187). G Warning If the 45 indicator lamp does not illuminate or remains out with the weight of a typical 12-month-old child in a standard child restraint or less, or is unoccupied, on the front-passenger seat, do not transport a child on the front-passenger seat until the system has been repaired. Z Safety Problems with the occupant classification system BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 46 Occupant safety BabySmart™ air bag deactivation system How the air bag deactivation system functions Safety 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 46 Version: 3.0.3.6 The BabySmart™ system is standard equipment in Canada. G Warning According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained on the rear seats than on the front-passenger seat. For this reason, Mercedes-Benz strongly advises that you always secure children in the rear seats. Regardless of seating position, children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriately sized child restraint system or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. Secure the infant restraint system or child restraint system, using: Rthe vehicle's seat belt seat belt and a Top Tether belt Rthe LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat mount and a Top Tether belt The child restraint system must be installed and secured correctly, observing the manufacturer's installation instructions. Occupants, especially children, should always sit as upright as possible, wear the seat belt properly and use an appropriately sized infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. Children can be killed or seriously injured by an inflating air bag. Observe the following important information if it is necessary to carry a child on the front-passenger seat: Rthe RChildren under 12 years may only sit in the front-passenger seat if they are seated in a child restraint system which is compatible with BabySmart™ and approved by Mercedes-Benz. If the child restraint system is installed properly, the front- passenger front air bag is deactivated in conjunction with the BabySmart™ system. Otherwise, the child could be struck by the air bag when it inflates in a crash. This could lead to serious or fatal injury. RA child in a rear-facing child restraint on the front-passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the front-passenger front air bag inflates in a collision which could occur under some circumstances, even with the air bag technology installed in your vehicle. The only means to eliminate this risk completely is never to place a child in a rear-facing child restraint in the frontpassenger seat. We therefore strongly recommend that you always place a child in a rear-facing child restraint on the rear seat. RIf it is necessary to install a BabySmart™compatible rear-facing child restraint system on the front-passenger seat, make sure the 45 indicator lamp is illuminated. This indicates that the frontpassenger front air bag is deactivated. If the 45 indicator lamp does not light up or goes out when the child restraint system is installed, check the anchorages of the restraint system. Periodically check the 45 indicator lamp while driving to make sure the 45 is illuminated. If the 45 indicator lamp goes out or remains out, do not transport a child on the front-passenger seat until the system has been repaired. A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the front-passenger seat will be seriously BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 47 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety indicator lamp remains out, do not use the BabySmart™ child restraint system to carry a child on the front-passenger seat until the system has been repaired. Safety injured or even killed if the front-passenger front air bag inflates. RIf you have to place a child in a forwardfacing child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat, you must: - move the seat as far back as possible - use the proper child restraint recommended for the age, size and weight of the child - secure child restraint with the vehicle's seat belt according to the child seat manufacturer's instructions G Warning The BabySmart™ air bag disabling system ONLY works with specially adapted child restraint systems. It does not work with child restraint systems that are not compatible with BabySmart™. Never place anything between the seat cushion and the child restraint system (e.g. a cushion), as this reduces the effectiveness of the BabySmart™ air bag deactivation system. The underside of the child restraint system must lie against the seat cushion of the frontpassenger seat. In the event of an accident, an incorrectly installed child restraint system could injure the child instead of offering protection. Observe the manufacturer's instructions when installing special child restraint systems. G Warning When using a BabySmart™-compatible child restraint system on the front-passenger seat, the front-passenger front air bag is only disabled if the 45 indicator lamp is illuminated. Check the 45 indicator lamp repeatedly, every time you use a BabySmart™-compatible child restraint system on the front-passenger seat. Should the 45 indicator lamp not illuminate or go out while the restraint is installed, please check installation. If the 45 47 Special child restraint systems which are compatible with BabySmart™ are necessary for deactivating the front-passenger front air bag. When the special child restraint system which is compatible with BabySmart™ is installed correctly and is recognized by the sensor system in the front-passenger seat, the front-passenger front air bag is deactivated. In this case, 45 indicator lamp : illuminates. If you have any questions regarding the special child restraint systems which are compatible with BabySmart™, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. If the key has been removed from the ignition lock or is in position 0, indicator lamp 45: does not light up. The system does not deactivate: Rthe side impact air bag pelvis air bag Rthe window curtain air bag Rthe Emergency Tensioning Devices Rthe Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 48 Occupant safety System self-test The 45 indicator lamp illuminates when you: the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the ignition lock Ron vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the Start-Stop button once or twice The 45 indicator lamp goes out again after approximately six seconds. If the 45 indicator lamp does not illuminate or is lit continuously, the system is malfunctioning. Before transporting a child on the front-passenger seat, have the BabySmart™ system checked at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. For more information, see "Problems with the air bag deactivation system" section (Y page 49) Safety Rturn G Warning Do not place powered-on laptops, mobile phones, electronic tags such as those used in ski passes or similar electronic devices on the front passenger seat. Signals from such devices may interfere with the BabySmart™ air bag deactivation system. Such signal interference may cause the 45 indicator lamp not to come on during self-test. The 6 SRS indicator lamp and/or the 45 indicator lamp could be continuously lit, indicating that the system is not functioning. The front-passenger front air bag could deploy inadvertently or fail to deploy in an accident. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 48 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 49 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety 49 Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions The 45 indicator lamp illuminates and remains illuminated. A special BabySmart™ compatible child restraint system is installed on the front-passenger seat. The front-passenger front air bag is therefore deactivated. A BabySmart™-compatible child restraint system is not installed on the front-passenger seat. The BabySmart™ system is malfunctioning. X Have the BabySmart™ system checked as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. G Warning If the 45 indicator lamp illuminates and remains illuminated when the weight of a typical adult or someone larger than a small individual has been detected on the passenger seat, do not allow any occupant to use the passenger seat until the system has been repaired. Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions The 45 The BabySmart™ system is malfunctioning. indicator lamp does not X Make sure there is nothing between the seat cushion and the illuminate or does not child seat. remain illuminated with X Check the installation of the child restraint system. a BabySmart™X If the 45 indicator lamp does not illuminate, have the compatible child BabySmart™ system checked as soon as possible at an restraint system authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. properly installed on Do not transport a child on the front-passenger seat until the the front-passenger child seat recognition system has been repaired. seat. NECK-PRO head restraints (except C63 AMG) The NECK-PRO head restraints increase protection for the driver's and frontpassenger's head and neck. In the event of a rear collision of a certain severity, the head restraints on the driver's and the frontpassenger seats are moved forwards and upwards. This provides better head support. G Warning Do not secure any objects (e.g. coat hangers) on the NECK-PRO head restraints. Otherwise, the NECK-PRO head restraints may not function properly, or in the event of a rear-end collision may not be able offer the level of protection they are designed to provide. G Warning Only use seat covers/head restraint covers that have been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz for your model. Using seat covers and head restraint covers other than those recommended may cause a malfunction when NECK-PRO head restraints are triggered or front side impact air bags/ Z Safety Problems with the air bag deactivation system BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 50 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 50 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Safety pelvis air bags may be prevented from deploying. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for availability. If the NECK-PRO head restraints have been triggered in an accident, you must reset the NECK-PRO head restraints on the driver's and front-passenger seat (Y page 50). Otherwise, the additional protection will not be available in the event of another rear-end collision. You can recognize that NECK-PRO head restraints have been triggered by the fact that they have moved forwards and can no longer be adjusted. G Warning! For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints. Adjust the head restraint so that it is as close to the head as possible and the center of the head restraint supports the back of the head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in the event of an accident or similar situation. Resetting triggered NECK-PRO head restraints (except AMG vehicles) G Warning For safety reasons, have the NECK-PRO head restraints checked at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center after a rear-end collision. G Warning When pushing back the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion, make sure your fingers do not become caught between the head restraint cushion and the cover. Failure to observe this could result in injuries. i Resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints requires a lot of strength. If you have difficulty resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints, have this work carried out at a X Press the base of the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion back in the direction of arrow ; as far as it will go. X Push the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion down into the guide in the direction of arrow = as far as it will go. X Firmly fold the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion back in the direction of arrow : until it engages. X Repeat this procedure for the second NECK-PRO head restraint. Seat belts Important safety notes The use of seat belts and infant and child restraint systems is required by law in all 50 states, the District of Columbia, the U.S. territories and all Canadian provinces. Even where this is not the case, all vehicle occupants should have their seat belts fastened when the vehicle is in motion. i See "Children in the vehicle" (Y page 55) for more information on infants and children traveling with you in the vehicle and restraints for infants and children. G Warning! Always fasten your seat belt before driving off. Always make sure all of your passengers are 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 51 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety properly restrained. You and your passengers should always wear seat belts. Failure to wear and properly fasten and position your seat belt greatly increases your risk of injuries and their likely severity in an accident. If you are ever in an accident, your injuries can be considerably more severe without your seat belt properly buckled. Without your seat belt buckled, you are much more likely to hit the interior of the vehicle or be ejected from it. You can be seriously injured or killed. In the same crash, the possibility of injury or death is lessened if you are properly wearing your seat belt. The air bags can only protect as intended if the occupants are properly wearing their seat belts. G Warning Never ride in a moving vehicle with the seat backrest in an excessively reclined position as this can be dangerous. You could slide under the seat belt in a collision. If you slide under it, the seat belt would apply force at the abdomen or neck. That could cause serious or even fatal injuries. The seat backrest and seat belt provide the best restraint when the wearer is in a position that is as upright as possible and the seat belt is properly positioned on the body. G Warning Never let more people ride in the vehicle than there are seat belts available. Make sure everyone riding in the vehicle is correctly restrained with a separate seat belt. Never use a seat belt for more than one person at a time. G Warning Damaged seat belts or seat belts that have been subjected to stress in an accident must be replaced and their anchoring points must also be checked. Only use seat belts which have been approved by Mercedes-Benz. Do not make any modifications to the seat belts. This can lead to unintended activation of the ETDs or to their failure to activate when necessary. Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may severely weaken them. In a crash they may not be able to provide adequate protection. Have all work carried out only by qualified technicians. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Correct use of the seat belt G Warning USE SEAT BELTS PROPERLY RSeat belts can only work when used properly. Never wear seat belts in any other way than as described in this section, as that could result in serious injuries in the event of an accident. REach occupant should wear their seat belt at all times, because seat belts help reduce the likelihood of and potential severity of injuries in accidents, including rollovers. The integrated restraint system includes SRS (driver front air bag, driver's side knee bag, front-passenger front air bag, side impact air bags, pelvis air bags, window curtain air bags for the side windows), Emergency Tensioning Devices, seat belt force limiters, and front seat knee bolsters. The system is designed to enhance the protection offered to properly belted occupants in certain frontal (front air bags, driver's side knee bag, and ETDs) and side (side impact air bags, pelvis air bags, window curtain air bags, and ETDs) impacts which exceed preset deployment thresholds. RNever wear the shoulder belt under your arm, across your neck or off your shoulder. In a frontal crash, your body would move too far forward. That would increase the chance of head and neck injuries. The seat belt would also apply too much force to the ribs or abdomen, which could severely Z 51 Safety BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Safety 52 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 52 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety injure internal organs such as your liver or spleen. Adjust the seat belt so that the shoulder section is located as close as possible to the middle of the shoulder. It should not touch the neck. Never pass the shoulder portion of the seat belt under your arm. RPosition the lap belt as low as possible on your hips and not across the abdomen. If the lap belt is positioned across your abdomen, it could cause serious injuries in a crash. RNever wear seat belts over rigid or breakable objects in or on your clothing, such as eyeglasses, pens, keys etc., as these might cause injuries. RMake sure the seat belt is always fitted snugly. Take special care of this when wearing loose clothing. RNever use a seat belt for more than one person at a time. Do not fasten a seat belt around a person and another person or other objects at the same time. RSeat belts should not be worn twisted. In a crash, you would not have the full width of the seat belt to distribute impact forces. The twisted seat belt against your body could cause injuries. RPregnant women should also always use a lap-shoulder belt. The lap belt portion should be positioned as low as possible on the hips to avoid any possible pressure on the abdomen. RPlace the seat backrest in a position that is as upright as possible. RCheck your seat belt during travel to make sure it is properly positioned. RNever place your feet on the instrument panel, dashboard, or on the seat. Always keep both feet on the floor in front of the seat. RWhen using a seat belt to secure infant restraints, toddler restraints, or children in booster seats, always follow the child seat manufacturer's instructions. G Warning Do not pass seat belts over sharp edges. They could tear. Do not allow the seat belt to get caught in the door or in the seat adjustment mechanism. This could damage the seat belt. Never attempt to make modifications to seat belts. This could impair the effectiveness of the seat belts. Fastening seat belts G Warning According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained on the rear seats than on the front-passenger seat. Thus, we strongly recommend that children be placed in the rear seat whenever possible. Regardless of seating position, children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriately sized child restraint system or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. For additional information, see the "Children in the vehicle" section. A child's risk of serious or fatal injuries is significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and/ or the child is not properly secured in the child restraint. G Warning Canada only: children 12 years old and under may ride on the front seat if a BabySmart™ compatible child restraint system is installed on the front-passenger seat. Use only Mercedes-Benz approved BabySmart™ compatible child restraint systems. A BabySmart™ compatible child restraint system will deactivate the front-passenger front air bag when installed correctly. The front-passenger front air bag will not be deactivated if the child restraint systems that are installed are not BabySmart™ compatible or if BabySmart™ compatible child restraint systems are not installed correctly. If the BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 53 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety Seat belt outlet height adjustment You can adjust the seat belt height on the driver's seat and the front-passenger seat. Safety front-passenger front air bag is deployed in a collision, the child will be struck by the air bag. If this happens, serious or fatal injury will result. 53 X Adjust the seat and move the backrest to an almost vertical position (Y page 92). X Pull the seat belt smoothly through belt sash guide :. X Without twisting it, guide the shoulder section of the seat belt across the middle of your shoulder and the lap section across your hips. X Engage belt tongue ; in buckle =. X If necessary, adjust the seat belt to the appropriate height (Y page 53). X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder section of the seat belt to tighten the belt across your body. All seat belts in the vehicle, except the driver's seat belt, are equipped with a special seat belt retractor to secure child restraint systems properly. For further information on "Special seat belt retractors", see (Y page 58). For more information about releasing the seat belt with release button ?, see "Releasing seat belts" (Y page 53). Adjust the height so that the upper part of the seat belt is routed across the center of your shoulder. X To raise: slide the belt sash guide upwards. The belt sash guide engages in various positions. X To lower: press and hold belt sash guide release :. X Slide the belt sash guide downwards. X Release belt sash guide release : and make sure that the belt sash guide has engaged. Releasing seat belts X Press release button ? (Y page 52) and guide belt tongue ; back towards belt sash guide :. ! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled up. Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue will be trapped in the door or in the seat mechanism. This could damage the door, the door trim panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts can no longer fulfill their protective function and must be replaced. Consult an authorized MercedesBenz Center. Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Safety 54 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 54 Version: 3.0.3.6 Occupant safety Belt warning for driver and front passenger or Regardless of whether the driver's and frontpassenger seat belts have already been fastened, the 7 seat belt warning lamp lights up for six seconds each time the engine is started. It then goes out once the driver and the front passenger have fastened their seat belts. If the driver's seat belt is not fastened after the engine is started, an additional warning tone will sound. The warning tone goes out after approximately six seconds or once the driver's seat belt is fastened. If, after six seconds, the driver or frontpassenger have not fastened their seat belts and the doors are closed: i For more information on the 7 seat Rthe 7 seat belt warning lamp remains illuminated as long as either the driver's or front-passenger seat belt is not fastened. Rif the vehicle speed exceeds 15 mph (25 km/h), the 7 seat belt warning lamp lights up. Additionally, a warning tone will sound with increasing intensity for a maximum of 60 seconds or until the driver's and front-passenger seat belt are fastened. If the driver/front passenger unfasten their seat belt while the vehicle is in motion, the 7 seat belt warning lamp lights up and a warning tone sounds again. The warning tone ceases even if the driver or front passenger have still not fastened their seat belt after 60 seconds. The 7 seat belt warning lamp stops flashing but remains illuminated. After the vehicle comes to a standstill, the warning tone is reactivated and the 7 seat belt warning lamp flashes again if the vehicle speed again exceeds 15 mph (25 km/h) . The 7 seat belt warning lamp only goes out if: Rboth the driver and the front passenger have fastened their seat belts. Rthe vehicle is stationary and a door is open. belt warning lamp, see "Indicator and warning lamps in the instrument cluster, seat belt" (Y page 204). Emergency Tensioning Devices and seat belt force limiters The front seat belts and the outer seat belts in the rear are equipped with ETDs and belt force limiters. ! If the front-passenger seat is not occupied, do not engage the seat belt tongue in the buckle on the frontpassenger seat. Otherwise, the Emergency Tensioning Device could be triggered in the event of an accident. The ETDs tighten the seat belts in an accident, pulling them close against the body. ETDs do not correct incorrect seat positions or incorrectly fastened seat belts. ETDs do not pull vehicle occupants back towards the backrest. Seat belt force limiters, when activated, are employed to help reduce the force exerted by the seat belts on occupants during a crash. The front belt force limiters are synchronized with the front air bags, which take on a part of the deceleration force. Thus, the force exerted on the occupant is distributed over a greater area. The ETDs can only be activated if: Rthe ignition is switched on. restraint systems are operational; see "SRS warning lamp" (Y page 34). Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the buckle on each of the lap-shoulder belts in the front. Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied and the belt tongue is engaged in the buckle on the front-passenger side. Rthe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 55 Version: 3.0.3.6 Children in the vehicle The ETDs on the outside seats in the rear compartment are triggered independently of the lock status of the seat belts. The ETDs are triggered depending on the type and severity of an accident: Rin the event of a head-on or rear-end collision if the vehicle decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a longitudinal direction during the initial stages of the impact Rin the event of a side impact, on the side opposite the impact if the vehicle decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a lateral direction If the Emergency Tensioning Devices (ETDs) are triggered, you will hear a bang, and a small amount of powder may also be released. Only in rare cases will the bang affect your hearing. The powder that is released generally does not constitute a health hazard. The 6 SRS warning lamp lights up. G Warning Pyrotechnic ETDs that were activated must be replaced. For your safety, when disposing of the pyrotechnic ETDs always follow our safety instructions. These are available at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 55 Children in the vehicle Important safety notes G Warning When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. The children could: Rinjure themselves on parts of the vehicle seriously or fatally injured through excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with vehicle equipment that can be operated even if the SmartKey is removed from the ignition lock or removed from the vehicle, such as seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment, or the memory function If children open a door, they could injure other persons or get out of the vehicle and injure themselves or be injured by following traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and the child could be burned on these parts. Rbe G Warning! Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment or trunk unless they are firmly secured in place. Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo increases a child's risk of injury in the event of Rstrong braking maneuvers changes of direction Ran accident Rsudden Z Safety BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Children in the vehicle 56 If an infant or child is traveling in the vehicle: X Safety 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 56 Version: 3.0.3.6 Secure the child using an infant or child restraint system appropriate to the age and weight of the child. X Make sure that the infant or child is properly secured at all times while the vehicle is in motion. Child restraint systems Important safety notes G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 55). We recommend all infants and children be properly restrained using the child restraint systems at all times while the vehicle is in motion. The use of infant or child restraints is required by law in all 50 states, the District of Columbia, the U.S. territories and all Canadian provinces. Infants and small children should always be seated in an infant or child seat restraint system appropriate for the size and weight of the child. They must be properly secured in accordance with the manufacturer's installation instructions for the infant or child seat restraint system. All infant and child seat restraint systems must comply with the US Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards 213 and 225 and Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards 213 and 210.2. A statement by the child restraint manufacturer of compliance with these standards can be found on the instruction label on the restraint system. You will also find the statement in the instruction manual provided with the child restraint system. When using an infant restraint system, child restraint system or booster seat, make sure to carefully read and follow all manufacturer's instructions for installation and use. Please read the warning labels affixed to the interior of the vehicle or to the infant restraint or child restraint system. G Warning Accident statistics show that children secured in the rear seats are safer than children secured in the front-passenger seat. For this reason, we strongly advise that you always secure children in the rear seats. Regardless of the seat position, children under 12 years must be secured correctly in a suitable infant or child restraint system or booster seat suitable for the size and weight of the child. The infant or child restraint system must be correctly secured using the vehicle's seat belt, the seat belt and Top Tether belt or the lower anchorages and the Top Tether belt in complete accordance with the child seat manufacturer's instructions. Occupants, in particular children, must sit as upright as possible, fasten the seat belt correctly and use a suitable infant restraint system, child restraint system or booster seat suitable for the size and weight of the child. Children can be seriously or even fatally injured by an air bag deploying. Observe the following important information if it is absolutely necessary to carry a child on the front-passenger seat: RUSA only: Your vehicle is equipped with air bag technology that is designed to deactivate the front-passenger front air bag, when the system on the frontpassenger seat detects the weight of a typical 12-month old child in a standard child restraint. RUSA only: For children that weigh more than a typical 12-month old child, the frontpassenger front air bag can be activated or deactivated. Always make sure that the 45 indicator lamp is illuminated indicating that the front-passenger front air bag is deactivated. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 57 Version: 3.0.3.6 Children in the vehicle RCanada only: Children 12 years old and under may ride on the front seat if a BabySmart™ compatible child restraint system is installed on the front-passenger seat. Use only Mercedes-Benz approved BabySmart™ compatible child restraint systems. A BabySmart™ compatible child restraint system will deactivate the frontpassenger front air bag when installed correctly. The front-passenger front air bag will not be deactivated if the child restraint systems that are installed are not BabySmart™ compatible or if BabySmart™ compatible child restraint systems are not installed correctly. If the front-passenger front air bag is deployed in a collision, the child could be struck by the air bag. This could lead to serious or fatal injury. RA child in a rear-facing child restraint on the front-passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the front-passenger front air bag inflates in a collision which could occur under some circumstances, even with the air bag technology installed in your vehicle. The only way to completely rule out this risk is by making sure you never place a child in a rearward-facing child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat. For this reason, we strongly advise that you always carry children in a rearward-facing child restraint system on a rear seat. RIf you must install a rear-facing child restraint on the front-passenger seat because circumstances require you to do so, make sure the 45 indicator lamp is illuminated, indicating that the frontpassenger front air bag is deactivated. If the 45 indicator lamp does not light up or goes out when the child restraint system is installed, check the anchorages of the restraint system. Check the 45 indicator lamp regularly while driving to ensure that the 45 indicator lamp is illuminated. If the 45 indicator lamp goes out or remains out, you may only carry a child on the front-passenger seat once the system has been repaired. A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the front-passenger seat will be seriously injured or even killed if the front-passenger front air bag inflates. Rwhen securing a child in a child restraint system on the front-passenger seat, you must: - move the front-passenger seat as far back as possible - use a child restraint system that is suitable for the age, size and weight of the child - observe the manufacturer's installation instructions in order to install and secure the child restraint system correctly. G Warning Infants and small children should never share a seat belt with another occupant. During an accident, they could be crushed between the occupant and seat belt. A child's risk of serious or fatal injuries is significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and/ or the child is not properly secured in the child restraint. Children too big for a toddler restraint must ride in seats using regular seat belts. Position the shoulder belt across the chest and shoulder, not face or neck. A booster seat may be necessary to achieve proper seat belt positioning for children over 41 lb (18 kg) until they reach a height where a lap/shoulder belt fits properly without a booster. When the child restraint is not in use, remove it from the vehicle or secure it with the seat belt to prevent the child restraint from becoming a projectile in the event of an accident. Z 57 Safety BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Children in the vehicle 58 Special seat belt retractor G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 55). Safety 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 58 Version: 3.0.3.6 All seat belts in the vehicle, except the driver's seat belt, are equipped with a special seat belt retractor. When activated, the special seat belt retractor ensures that the seat belt cannot slacken after being fastened. Installing a child restraint system: X Always comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions. X Pull the seat belt smoothly from the inertia reel. X Engage the seat belt tongue in the belt buckle. Activating the special seat belt retractor: X Pull the seat belt out fully and let the inertia reel retract it again. While the seat belt is retracting, you should hear a ratcheting sound. The special seat belt retractor function is enabled. X Push down on the child restraint system to take up any slack. Removing a child restraint system/ deactivating the special seat belt retractor: X Always comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions. X Press the seat belt release button and guide the belt tongue to the belt outlet. The special seat belt retractor function is deactivated. G Warning Never release the seat belt buckle while the vehicle is in motion, since the special seat belt retractor will be deactivated. LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat anchors G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 55). G Warning Children that are too large for a child restraint must travel in seats using normal seat belts. Position shoulder belt across the chest and shoulder, not face or neck. In order to attain the correct seating position for children weighing over 41 lb (18 kg), it may be necessary to use a booster seat until they reach a height where a normal lap/shoulder seat belt lies properly across their bodies without the need for a booster seat. Install the child restraint system according to the manufacturer's instructions. The child restraint system must be installed firmly on both brackets. An incorrectly installed child restraint system can come loose in the event of an accident, causing the child to be severely or fatally injured. Child restraint systems/child restraint retaining brackets that are damaged or have suffered damage due to an impact must be replaced. ISOFIX is a standardized securing system for specially designed child restraint systems on the rear seats. Securing rings for two LATCHtype (ISOFIX) child restraint systems are installed on the left and right of the rear seats. Use the vehicle's seat belts to install child restraint systems without the ISOFIX securing system. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for of child restraint systems. ! When installing the child restraint system, make sure that the seat belt for the center seat does not get trapped. Otherwise, the seat belt could be damaged. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 59 Version: 3.0.3.6 Children in the vehicle Vehicles without a through-loading feature in the rear bench seat Installation instruction : indicates the installation point of securing ring =. X Remove protective caps ; from securing rings = by pulling in the direction of the arrow. occupied by passengers. Lock the rear seat backrests in their upright position before installing the Top Tether straps or when the cargo compartment is not in use. Make sure that rear seat backrests are secured properly by pushing and pulling on the seat backrests. If the seat backrest is not locked properly, the seat backrest could fold forward. The child restraint system is no longer supported properly or held in position and can no longer fulfill its function. This could cause serious or even fatal injuries. Top Tether provides an additional attachment point between the "LATCH" type child seat mount (ISOFIX) child restraint system and the rear seat. This can further reduce the risk of injury. The Top Tether anchorages are located in the rear compartment behind the head restraints. Vehicles with a through-loading feature in the rear bench seat X Install the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint system. Comply with the manufacturer's instructions when installing the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint system. Top Tether G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 55). G Warning Always lock the rear seat backrests in their upright position when the rear seats are X Move head restraint : upwards. X Fold up cover ; of Top Tether anchorage =. Z 59 Safety BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 60 Version: 3.0.3.6 Children in the vehicle 60 Safety X Route Top Tether belt A under the head restraint : between both head restraint bars. X Hook Top Tether hook ? into Top Tether anchorage =. X Make sure that Top Tether belt A is not twisted. X Fold down cover ; of Top Tether anchorage =. X If necessary, push head restraint : back down slightly (Y page 96). Make sure that the routing of Top Tether belt A is not impaired. X Install the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint system with Top Tether. Always comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions. Make sure that Top Tether belt A is taut. Child-proof locks Child-proof locks for the rear doors G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 55). G Warning Children could open a rear door from inside the vehicle. This could result in serious injuries or an accident. Therefore, when children ride in the rear always secure the rear doors with the child-proof locks. X To activate: press the child-proof lock lever up in the direction of arrow :. X Make sure that the child-proof locks are working properly. X To deactivate: press the child-proof lock lever down in the direction of arrow ;. Override feature for the rear side windows G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 55). G Warning When children ride on the vehicle's rear seats, activate the override switch. Otherwise, the children could be injured, e.g. by trapping themselves in the rear side window. You can secure each door individually with the child-proof locks on the rear doors. A door secured with a child-proof lock cannot be opened from inside the vehicle. When the vehicle is unlocked, the door can be opened from the outside. X To activate/deactivate: press button ;. If indicator lamp : is lit, operation of the rear side windows is disabled. Operation is only possible using the switches in the driver's door. If indicator lamp : is off, 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 61 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving safety systems operation is possible using the switches in the rear compartment. Panic alarm This device complies with the RSS-210 regulations of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause interference, and 2. This device must withstand any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. Driving safety systems X To activate: press and hold ! button : for about one second. An alarm sounds and the exterior lighting flashes. X To deactivate: press ! button : again. or X Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock. or X Press the KEYLESS-GO Start-Stop button. The KEYLESS-GO key must be in the vehicle. i USA only: This device complies with the part 15 of the FCC regulations. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause interference, and 2. This device must withstand any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Any unauthorized modification to this device could void the user's authority to operate the equipment. i Canada only: Overview of driving safety systems In this section, you will find information about the following driving safety systems: RABS (Anti-lock Braking System) RBAS (Brake Assist System) RESP® (Electronic Stability Program) REBD (Electronic Brake-power Distribution) RADAPTIVE BRAKE Important safety notes G Warning The following factors increase the risk of accidents: RExcessive speed, especially in turns and slippery road surfaces RFollowing another vehicle too closely The driving safety systems described in this section cannot reduce these risks or prevent the natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle. They cannot increase braking or steering efficiency beyond that afforded by the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires or the traction afforded. Only a safe, attentive, and skillful driver can prevent accidents. The capabilities of a vehicle equipped with the driving safety systems described in this RWet Z 61 Safety BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Safety 62 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 62 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving safety systems section must never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous manner which could jeopardize the user's safety or the safety of others. Always adjust your driving style to the prevailing road and weather conditions and keep a safe distance to other road users and objects on the street. If a driving system malfunctions, other driving safety systems may also switch off. Observe indicator and warning lamps that may come on as well as messages in the multifunction display that may appear. i In wintry driving conditions, always use winter tires (M+S tires) and if necessary, snow chains. Only in this way will the driving safety systems described in this section work as effectively as possible. ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) Important safety notes G Warning Braking If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a pulsing in the brake pedal. X If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over. X To make a full brake application: depress the brake pedal with full force. G Warning If the ABS malfunctions, other driving systems such as the BAS or the ESP® are also switched off. Observe indicator and warning lamps that may come on as well as messages in the multifunction display that may appear. If the ABS malfunctions, the wheels may lock during hard braking, reducing the steering capability and extending the braking distance. The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions and functions as a reminder to take extra care while driving. Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 61). BAS (Brake Assist) G Warning G Warning Do not pump the brake pedal. Use firm, steady brake pedal pressure instead. Pumping the brake pedal defeats the purpose of the ABS and significantly reduces braking effectiveness. ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way that the wheels do not lock when you brake. This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking. ABS works from a speed of about 5 mph (8 km/h) upwards, regardless of roadsurface conditions. ABS works on slippery surfaces, even when you only brake gently. The ! warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the ignition is switched on. It goes out when the engine is running. Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 61). BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly, BAS automatically boosts the braking force, thus shortening the stopping distance. X Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed until the emergency braking situation is over. ABS prevents the wheels from locking. The brakes will function as usual once you release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated. G Warning If the BAS malfunctions, the brake system still functions, but without the additional brake boost available that the BAS would normally provide in an emergency braking maneuver. Therefore, the braking distance may increase. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 63 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving safety systems ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) Important safety notes G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 61). If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating from the direction desired by the driver, one or more wheels are braked to stabilize the vehicle. If necessary, the engine output is also modified to keep the vehicle on the desired course within physical limits. ESP® assists the driver when pulling away on wet or slippery roads. ESP® can also stabilize the vehicle during braking. If ESP® intervenes, the ä warning lamp flashes in the instrument cluster. G Warning! Never switch off the ESP when you see the ESP warning lamp ä flashing in the instrument cluster. In this case proceed as follows: RWhen driving off, apply as little throttle as possible. RWhile driving, ease up on the accelerator pedal. RAdapt your speed and driving style to the prevailing road conditions. Failure to observe these guidelines could cause the vehicle to skid. The ESP cannot prevent accidents resulting from excessive speed. ! Vehicles without 4MATIC: switch the ignition off when: Rthe parking brake is being tested using a dynamometer Rthe vehicle is being towed with the front axle raised Application of the brakes by ESP® may otherwise destroy the brake system. 63 ! Vehicles with 4MATIC: switch off the ignition when the parking brake is being tested on a brake dynamometer. Application of the brakes by ESP® may otherwise destroy the brake system. ! Vehicles with 4MATIC: function or performance tests may only be carried out on a 2-axle dynamometer. If you wish to operate the vehicle on such a dynamometer, please consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center in advance. You could otherwise damage the drive train or the brake system. i Only use wheels with the recommended tire sizes. Only then will ESP® function properly. ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System) G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 61). Traction control is part of ESP®. Traction control brakes the drive wheels individually if they spin. This enables you to pull away and accelerate on slippery surfaces, for example if the road surface is slippery on one side. On vehicles with 4MATIC, more drive torque is also transferred to the wheel or wheels with traction. Traction control remains active if you deactivate ESP®. Deactivating/activating ESP® (except AMG vehicles) G Warning The ESP® should not be switched off during normal driving other than in the circumstances described below. Disabling the system will reduce vehicle stability in driving maneuvers. Do not switch off the ESP® when a spare wheel is mounted. Z Safety BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 64 Driving safety systems ESP® is activated automatically when the engine is running. It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations: Safety 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 64 Version: 3.0.3.6 Rwhen using snow chains Rin deep snow Ron sand or gravel G Warning! ESP® Activate as soon as the situations described above no longer apply. ESP® will otherwise not be able to stabilize the vehicle if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts to spin. If you deactivate ESP®: RESP® no longer improves driving stability. Rthe engine's torque is no longer limited and the drive wheels can spin. The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action, which provides better grip. Rtraction control is still activated. RESP® still provides support when you brake. If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels start to spin, the ä warning lamp in the instrument cluster flashes. In such situations, ESP® will not stabilize the vehicle. X To deactivate:(Y page 178). The å warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up. G Warning When the å ESP OFF warning lamp lights up, ESP is switched off. When the ä ESP warning lamp and the å ESP OFF warning lamp are on continuously, ESP is not operational due to a malfunction. When ESP is switched off or not operational, the vehicle's stability during standard driving maneuvers is reduced. Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road conditions/weather conditions and to the non-operating status of ESP. ! Avoid spinning a drive wheel for an extended period with ESP switched off. This could cause serious damage to the drive train. X To activate:(Y page 178). The å warning lamp in the instrument cluster goes out. Deactivating/activating ESP® (AMG vehicles) Activating/deactivating SPORT handling mode G Warning The SPORT handling mode should not be switched on during normal driving. Switching on the SPORT handling mode will result in the following: Rno restriction to the engine torque supported traction control is limited The SPORT handling mode is designed for driving on closed tracks when the vehicle's own natural oversteer and understeer characteristics are desired and requires a highly skilled and experienced driver able to handle these critical driving situations. You could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident. Please be aware of these limits when you switch on the SPORT handling mode. Do not switch on the SPORT handling when a spare wheel is mounted. Rsystem SPORT handling mode is active automatically as long as the engine is running. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 65 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving safety systems using snow chains deep snow Ron sand or gravel Rin G Warning Switch off the SPORT handling mode and switch on the ESP® immediately if the aforementioned circumstances do not apply anymore. Otherwise the SPORT handling mode will only stabilize the vehicle to a limited extent when it is starting to skid or a wheel is spinning. When SPORT handling mode is activated: RESP® only improves driving stability to a limited degree. Rthe engine's torque is restricted to a limited degree and the drive wheels can spin. The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action, which provides better grip. Rtraction control is still activated. RESP® still provides support when you brake firmly. If SPORT handling mode is activated and one or more wheels start to spin, the ä warning lamp in the instrument cluster flashes. ESP® only stabilizes the vehicle to a limited degree. X To deactivate: briefly press button :. The M warning lamp in the instrument cluster goes out. Activating/deactivating ESP® G Warning! The ESP® should not be switched off during normal driving. Disabling of the system will result in the following: Rno restriction to engine torque of system-supported traction control Rloss "ESP® OFF" is designed for driving on closed tracks when the vehicle’s natural oversteer and understeer characteristics are desired and requires a highly skilled and experienced driver able to handle these critical driving situations. You could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident. Please be aware of these limits when you switch off the ESP®. Do not switch off the ESP® when a spare wheel is mounted. ESP® is activated automatically when the engine is running. It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations: Rwhen using snow chains deep snow Ron sand or gravel Rin G Warning! X To activate: briefly press button :. The M warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up. The SPORT handling Activate ESP® as soon as the situations described above no longer apply. ESP® will otherwise not be able to stabilize the vehicle if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts to spin. Z Safety mode message appears in the multifunction display. It may be best to activate SPORT handling mode in the following situations: Rwhen 65 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 66 Version: 3.0.3.6 Anti-theft systems 66 If you deactivate ESP®: ! Avoid spinning a drive wheel for an extended period with ESP switched off. This could cause serious damage to the drive train. Safety RESP® no longer improves driving stability. Rthe engine's torque is no longer limited and the drive wheels are able to spin. The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action, which provides better grip. Rtraction control is still activated. RESP® still provides support when you brake firmly. If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels start to spin, the ä warning lamp in the instrument cluster does not flash. In such situations, ESP® will not stabilize the vehicle. X To activate: briefly press button :. The å warning lamp in the instrument cluster goes out. The message ESC-ON appears in the multifunction display. EBD G Warning Observe "Important safety notes" (Y page 61). EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure on the rear wheels to improve driving stability while braking. G Warning! X To deactivate: press button : until the å warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster. The message ESC-OFF appears in the multifunction display. G Warning When the å ESP OFF warning lamp lights up, ESP is switched off. When the ä ESP warning lamp and the å ESP OFF warning lamp are on continuously, ESP is not operational due to a malfunction. When ESP is switched off or not operational, the vehicle's stability during standard driving maneuvers is reduced. Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road conditions/weather conditions and to the non-operating status of ESP. If the EBD malfunctions, the brake system will still function with full brake boost. However, the rear wheels could lock up during emergency braking situations, for example. You could lose control of the vehicle and cause an accident. Adapt your driving style to the changed driving characteristics. Adaptive Brake ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety and offers increased braking comfort. In addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE also features the hill start assist function (Y page 135). For further information, see Driving tips (Y page 152). Anti-theft systems Immobilizer The immobilizer prevents your vehicle from being started without the correct key. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 67 Version: 3.0.3.6 Anti-theft systems i The immobilizer is always deactivated when you start the engine. In the event that the engine cannot be started when the starter battery is fully charged, the immobilizer may be faulty. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in USA) or 1-800-387-0100 (in Canada). Safety When leaving the vehicle, always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. The engine can be started by anyone with a valid key that is left inside the vehicle. X To activate with the SmartKey: remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. X To activate with KEYLESS-GO: switch the ignition off and open the driver's door. X To deactivate: switch on the ignition. X To arm: lock the vehicle with the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO. Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system is armed after approximately 15 seconds. X To deactivate: unlock the vehicle using the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO. X ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the alarm system is armed and you open: door Rthe vehicle with the mechanical key Rthe trunk lid Rthe hood The alarm is not switched off, even if you close the open door that has triggered it, for example. seconds, the emergency call system mbrace (USA only) or TELEAID (Canada only) initiates a call to the Customer Assistance Center automatically. The emergency call system initiates the call provided that: To stop the alarm using the SmartKey: insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock. The alarm is switched off. or X Press the % or & button on the SmartKey. The alarm is switched off. X To stop the alarm using KEYLESS-GO: grasp the outside door handle. The key must be outside the vehicle. The alarm is switched off. Ra i If the alarm stays on for more than 30 67 or X Press the Start/Stop button on the dashboard. The key must be inside the vehicle. The alarm is switched off. Ryou have subscribed to the mbrace/ TELEAID service. Rthe mbrace/TELEAID service has been activated properly. Rthe required mobile phone, power supply and GPS are available. Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 68 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 68 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 69 Version: 3.0.3.6 69 Vehicle equipment .............................. SmartKey ............................................. Doors .................................................... Trunk .................................................... Side windows ...................................... Sliding sunroof .................................... 70 70 77 80 83 86 Opening and closing BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 70 SmartKey Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard Opening and closing 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 70 Version: 3.0.3.6 and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. G Warning! Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment or trunk unless they are firmly secured in place. Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo increases a child's risk of injury in the event of Rstrong braking maneuvers changes of direction Ran accident Rsudden SmartKey Important safety notes G Warning! When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. The children could Rinjure themselves on parts of the vehicle seriously or fatally injured through excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with vehicle equipment that can be operated even if the SmartKey is removed from the starter switch or removed from the vehicle, such as seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment, or the memory function If children open a door, they could injure other persons or get out of the vehicle and injure themselves or be injured by following traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and the child could be burned by these parts. General information If the SmartKey is faulty, contact Roadside Assistance or an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. SmartKey functions Locking and unlocking centrally The SmartKey centrally locks/unlocks: Rthe doors trunk lid Rthe fuel filler flap Rthe Rbe : & To lock the vehicle ; F To unlock the trunk lid = % To unlock the vehicle When unlocking, the turn signals flash once. When locking, they flash three times. When it is dark, the surround lighting also comes on if it is activated in the on-board computer. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 71 Version: 3.0.3.6 SmartKey You can also set an audible signal to confirm that the vehicle has been locked or unlocked. The audible signal can be activated and deactivated using the on-board computer (Y page 181). i Only for USA: This equipment complies with Part 15 of the FCC regulations. Operation is subject to the following conditions: Rthis equipment must not emit harmful, electromagnetic radiation. Rthis equipment may be affected by electromagnetic radiation, including radiation which can trigger unwanted functions. Any unauthorized change to this equipment can lead to the user's operating license being withdrawn. i Only for Canada: This equipment complies with the RSS-210 regulations of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following conditions: Rthis equipment must not emit harmful, electromagnetic radiation. Rthis equipment receives electromagnetic radiation, including radiation which can trigger unwanted functions. Any unauthorized change to this equipment can lead to the user's operating license being withdrawn. X To unlock centrally: press the % button. If you do not open a door or the trunk lid within approximately 40 seconds of unlocking the vehicle: Rthe vehicle is locked again. theft deterrent locking system is activated again. X To lock centrally: press the & button. Rthe 71 KEYLESS-GO General notes i Only for USA: This equipment complies with Part 15 of the FCC regulations. Operation is subject to the following conditions: Rthis equipment must not emit harmful, electromagnetic radiation. Rthis equipment may be affected by electromagnetic radiation, including radiation which can trigger unwanted functions. Any unauthorized change to this equipment can lead to the user's operating license being withdrawn. i Only for Canada: This equipment has been released in accordance with RSS - 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following conditions: Rthis equipment must not emit harmful, electromagnetic radiation. Rthis equipment receives electromagnetic radiation, including radiation which can trigger unwanted functions. Any unauthorized change to this equipment can lead to the user's operating license being withdrawn. Important information for using KEYLESS-GO RYou can use the KEYLESS-GO key as a conventional key. RYou can combine KEYLESS-GO functions with those of a conventional key (e.g. open with KEYLESS-GO and close with the & button). RAlways carry your KEYLESS-GO key on your person. RNever keep the KEYLESS-GO key with: - electronic equipment, such as your mobile phone or another key - metal objects, such as coins or metal foil Z Opening and closing BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Opening and closing 72 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 72 Version: 3.0.3.6 SmartKey This may impair the functioning of KEYLESSGO. RTo open or close the vehicle, the KEYLESSGO key should be no more than 3 ft (1 m) from the door or trunk. RWhen the vehicle is parked for more than 72 hours, the KEYLESS-GO function is deactivated. Pull one of the outer door handles and turn on the ignition to reactivate the KEYLESS-GO function. RIf the KEYLESS-GO key is not near the vehicle, it is possible that the system may not recognize it. In this case, the vehicle cannot be locked or started with KEYLESSGO. RIf the KEYLESS-GO key has been removed from the vehicle (e.g. if a passenger leaves the vehicle with the KEYLESS-GO key): - while someone is holding the Start/Stop button or attempting to lock the vehicle with the outer door handle, the message Key not detected appears in the multifunction display - while the engine is running, the red message Key not detected appears in the multifunction display as you pull away. Find the KEYLESS-GO key or change its current position immediately (e.g. place it on the front-passenger seat or carry it in your shirt pocket.) RIf you have started the engine using the Start/Stop button, you can turn if off again by: - pressing the Start/Stop button again - inserting the KEYLESS-GO key in the ignition lock when the vehicle is stationary and the automatic transmission is in parking position P. RYou may accidentally unlock the vehicle if the KEYLESS-GO key is within 3 ft (1 m) of the vehicle and: - an outer door handle comes into contact with water or - you are cleaning an outer door handle. RNote that the engine can be started by any vehicle occupant if a KEYLESS-GO key is in the vehicle. Option 1: there is a KEYLESS-GO key in the vehicle and a KEYLESS-GO key outside the vehicle. If you leave the KEYLESS-GO key behind when you get out and lock the vehicle, a message does not appear in the multifunction display. Option 2: there is a KEYLESS-GO key in the vehicle but no KEYLESS-GO key outside the vehicle. When you get out and try to lock the vehicle, the message Key still in vehicle appears in the multifunction display. The vehicle is not locked in this case. When starting the engine and while driving, KEYLESS-GO also checks whether a valid key is in the vehicle by periodically establishing radio contact. X To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner surface of the door handle. X To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface :. X Convenience closing feature: touch sensor surface ; for an extended period (Y page 84). If you pull on the handle of the trunk lid, only the trunk/cargo area of the vehicle is unlocked. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 73 Version: 3.0.3.6 SmartKey time, the sensor surfaces are deactivated automatically. Pull the door handle to unlock the door and turn on the ignition once to activate the sensor surfaces again. Changing the settings of the locking system You can change the settings of the locking system in such a way that only the driver's door and the fuel filler flap are unlocked. This is useful if you frequently travel on your own. X To change the setting: press the % and & buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until the battery check lamp flashes twice. The SmartKey now functions as follows: X To unlock the driver's door: press the % button once. X To unlock centrally: press the % button twice. X To lock centrally: press the & button. The KEYLESS-GO function is changed as follows: X To unlock the driver's door: touch the inner surface of the door handle on the driver's door. X To unlock centrally: touch the inner surface of the door handle on the frontpassenger door or the rear door. X To lock centrally: touch sensor surface : on one of the door handles. Mechanical key General notes If the vehicle can no longer be locked or unlocked with the SmartKey, use the mechanical key. If you use the mechanical key to unlock and open the driver's door or the trunk lid, the anti-theft alarm system will be triggered (Y page 67). There are several ways to turn off the alarm: X Press the % or & button on the SmartKey. or X Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock. or X Press the Start/Stop button in the ignition lock. The SmartKey must be in the vehicle. or X Lock or unlock the vehicle using KEYLESSGO. The SmartKey must be outside the vehicle. If you unlock the vehicle using the mechanical key, the fuel filler flap will not be unlocked automatically. X To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the SmartKey in the ignition lock. Removing the mechanical key Restoring the factory settings X Press the % and & buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until the battery check lamp flashes twice. X Push release catch : in the direction of the arrow and at the same time remove mechanical key ; from the SmartKey. Z Opening and closing i If the vehicle has been parked for a long 73 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe SmartKey 74 SmartKey battery Important safety notes It is advisable to have batteries replaced at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Opening and closing 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 74 Version: 3.0.3.6 G Warning! Batteries are toxic and contain caustic substances. For this reason, keep batteries out of the reach of children. If a battery has been swallowed, visit a doctor immediately. i You can obtain a SmartKey battery at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. i If the SmartKey battery is checked within signal range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button results in the vehicle being locked or unlocked respectively. Changing the battery You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery. X Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 73). G Warning SmartKey batteries contain perchlorate material, which may require special handling and regard for the environment. Check with your local government's disposal guidelines. California residents, see www.dtsc.ca.gov/ HazardousWaste/Perchlorate/ index.cfm. Checking the battery X Press the & or % button. The SmartKey battery is working properly if battery charge indicator lamp : lights up briefly. If battery charge indicator lamp : does not light up briefly during the test, the SmartKey battery is discharged. X Replace the SmartKey battery (Y page 74). X X Press mechanical key ; into the opening in the SmartKey in the direction of the arrow until battery tray cover : opens. Do not hold the cover closed while doing so. Remove the cover of the battery tray. Repeatedly tap the SmartKey against your palm until battery = falls out. X Insert the new battery with the positive pole facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth to do so. X BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 75 Version: 3.0.3.6 SmartKey 75 X Opening and closing Insert the front tabs of the battery tray's cover first and then press to close it. X Check the function of all SmartKey buttons on the vehicle. Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 76 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 76 Version: 3.0.3.6 SmartKey Problems with the SmartKey Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions You cannot lock/ unlock the vehicle using the SmartKey. The SmartKey battery is discharged or nearly discharged. X Point the tip of the SmartKey at the driver's door handle from a distance of approximately 1.5 ft (50 cm) and try to unlock or lock the vehicle again. Opening and closing Problem If this does not work: X Lock or unlock the vehicle using the mechanical key (Y page 73). X Check the key battery and replace it if necessary (Y page 74). The SmartKey is faulty. X Lock the vehicle as described in the "Locking the vehicle (mechanical key)" section (Y page 79) or unlock it using the mechanical key (Y page 73). X Have the SmartKey checked at a qualified specialist workshop. You can no longer KEYLESS-GO is in standby mode because the vehicle has not been lock/unlock the unlocked for an extended period. vehicle using KEYLESS- X Pull the door handle and then turn the SmartKey to position 2 GO. in the ignition lock. There is a malfunction with KEYLESS-GO. X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of the SmartKey. Point the tip of the SmartKey at the driver's door handle from close range and press the %/& button. X Have the SmartKey checked at a qualified specialist workshop. There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves. X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of the SmartKey. Point the tip of the SmartKey at the driver's door handle from close range and press the %/& button. You have lost a SmartKey. X You have lost the mechanical key. X Have the SmartKey canceled at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. X Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers. X If necessary, have the locks changed as well. X Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers. If necessary, have the locks changed as well. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 77 Version: 3.0.3.6 Doors Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions The engine cannot be started using the SmartKey. The on-board voltage is too low. X Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior lighting, and try to start the engine again. The engine cannot be started using the SmartKey. Opening and closing If this does not work: X Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary (Y page 259). or X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 262). or X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. The steering lock is mechanically blocked. X Remove the SmartKey and re-insert it into the ignition lock. While doing this, turn the steering wheel in both directions. The engine cannot be A door is open. Therefore, the SmartKey cannot be detected as started using KEYLESS- easily. GO. The SmartKey is in X Close the door and try to start the vehicle again. the vehicle. There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves. X Start your vehicle with the SmartKey in the ignition lock. Doors Important safety notes G Warning! When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. The children could Rinjure themselves on parts of the vehicle Rbe seriously or fatally injured through excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with vehicle equipment that can be operated 77 even if the SmartKey is removed from the starter switch or removed from the vehicle, such as seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment, or the memory function If children open a door, they could injure other persons or get out of the vehicle and injure themselves or be injured by following traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and the child could be burned by these parts. G Warning! Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment or trunk unless they are firmly secured in place. Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Doors 78 Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo increases a child's risk of injury in the event of Rstrong braking maneuvers Rsudden changes of direction Ran accident Opening and closing 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 78 Version: 3.0.3.6 Unlocking and opening doors from the inside Centrally locking and unlocking the vehicle from the inside The locking or unlocking buttons of the central locking do not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap. i You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally from the inside if the vehicle has been locked with the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO. i It is only possible to lock the vehicle centrally if the front-passenger door is closed. You can open a door from inside the vehicle even if it has been locked, unless the childproof locks have been activated (Y page 60). Only open the door if traffic conditions allow you to do so. If the vehicle has previously been locked with the SmartKey or with KEYLESS-GO, opening a door from the inside will trigger the antitheft alarm system. Switch off the alarm (Y page 67). X To unlock: press button :. X To lock: press button ;. You can open a locked front door from inside the vehicle. Only open the door if traffic conditions allow you to do so. If the vehicle has previously been locked with the central locking button: X Front door: pull door handle ;. If the door is locked, locking knob : pops up. The door is unlocked and can be opened. X Rear door: pull up locking knob : on the respective rear door. The rear door is unlocked and can be opened. Rand the KEYLESS-GO key is restored to the factory settings, the entire vehicle is unlocked if a front door is opened from inside the vehicle. Rand the KEYLESS-GO key is set to individual settings, only the front door which is opened from inside the vehicle is unlocked. Automatic locking i The vehicle locks automatically when the ignition is switched on and the wheels of the vehicle are moving at a speed of more than 9 mph(15 km/h). You may therefore BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 79 Version: 3.0.3.6 Doors X Insert the mechanical key into the lock of the driver's door as far as it will go. X Turn the mechanical key counter-clockwise to position 1. The door is unlocked. X Turn the mechanical key back and remove it. Locking the vehicle (mechanical key) Emergency locking X To deactivate: press and hold button : for about five seconds until a tone sounds. X To activate: press and hold button ; for about five seconds until a tone sounds. i When you push either of the two buttons and an audible warning signal does not sound, the relevant setting has already been selected. On vehicles with a luxury multifunction steering wheel, you can also activate and deactivate the automatic locking using the on-board computer (Y page 181). If the vehicle can no longer be locked centrally with the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO: X Open the driver's door. X Close the front-passenger door, the rear doors and the trunk lid. X Press the locking button (Y page 78). X Make sure that the locking knobs on the doors are still visible. Press down the locking knobs by hand, if necessary. X Close the driver's door. X Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 73). Unlocking the driver's door (mechanical key) If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked centrally with the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO: X Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 73). X Insert the mechanical key into the lock of the driver's door as far as it will go. X Turn the mechanical key clockwise as far as it will go to position 1. X Turn the mechanical key back and remove it. X Make sure that the doors and the trunk lid are locked. Z Opening and closing lock yourself out if the vehicle is being pushed, towed, or located on a test rig. 79 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 80 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 80 Version: 3.0.3.6 Trunk i If you lock the vehicle as described above, the fuel filler flap is not locked. The antitheft alarm system is not activated. Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo increases a child's risk of injury in the event of Rstrong Trunk Opening and closing Important safety notes Do not leave the SmartKey in the trunk. You could otherwise lock yourself out. G Warning When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unsupervised in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, and do not give them access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. They could: Rinjure themselves on vehicle parts seriously or fatally injured by extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or have an accident with vehicle equipment that may still be in operation even after the SmartKey has been removed from the ignition, such as the seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment or memory function. If children open a door, they could cause severe or even fatal injury to other persons; if they get out of the vehicle, they could injure themselves when doing so or be seriously or even fatally injured by any passing traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and a child could be burned on these parts. Rbe G Warning! Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment or trunk unless they are firmly secured in place. braking maneuvers changes of direction Ran accident Rsudden G Warning Make sure the trunk lid is closed when the engine is running and while driving. Among other dangers, deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may enter the vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and death. ! The trunk lid swings upwards when opened. Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient clearance above the trunk lid. For the trunk lid to be opened fully, there must be a minimum clearance from floor to ceiling of 5.90 ft (1.80 m). The trunk lid can be: Ropened Ropened and closed manually from outside automatically from outside Opening and closing manually Opening You can only open the trunk lid after unlocking it first. You can only unlock the trunk lid when the vehicle is stationary. X Press the % button on the SmartKey. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 81 Version: 3.0.3.6 Trunk Pull handle :. X Raise the trunk lid. Closing G Warning To prevent possible personal injury, always keep hands and fingers away from the trunk opening when closing the trunk lid. Be especially careful when small children are around. Opening You can open the trunk lid automatically using the SmartKey or the handle in the trunk lid. X Press and hold the F button on the SmartKey until the trunk lid opens. or X When the trunk is unlocked, pull on the trunk lid handle and let it go again immediately. Closing i If you leave a KEYLESS-GO key in the trunk, the trunk lid will not lock. Opening automatically from the inside G Warning X Pull the trunk lid down using recess :. X Lock the vehicle if necessary with the & button on the SmartKey or with KEYLESS-GO (Y page 71). Automatic opening and closing from the outside Make sure the trunk lid is closed when the engine is running and while driving. Among other dangers, deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may enter the vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and death. You can open the tailgate from the driver's seat when the vehicle is stationary. Important safety guidelines G Warning Make sure the trunk lid is closed when the engine is running and while driving. Among other dangers, deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may enter the vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and death. ! The trunk lid swings upwards when opened. Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient clearance above the trunk lid. X To open: press the upper section of remote operating switch : for the trunk lid until the trunk lid opens. For the trunk lid to be opened fully, there must be a minimum clearance from floor to ceiling of 5.90 ft (1.80 m). Z Opening and closing X 81 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 82 Version: 3.0.3.6 Trunk 82 Opening and closing Locking the trunk separately You can lock the trunk separately. If you then unlock the vehicle centrally, the trunk remains locked and cannot be opened. X Close the trunk lid. X Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 73). X Turn the mechanical key counter-clockwise as far as it will go to position 2. The trunk is unlocked. X Turn the mechanical key back to basic position 1 and remove it. Emergency trunk release X Insert the mechanical key into the trunk lid lock as far as the stop. X Turn the mechanical key clockwise from position 1 to position 2. X Remove the mechanical key. You can open the trunk lid from inside the vehicle with the emergency release button. Unlocking the trunk (mechanical key) ! The trunk lid swings upwards when opened. Therefore, make sure that there is sufficient clearance above the trunk lid. If the trunk can no longer be unlocked with the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO: X Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 73). X Insert the mechanical key into the trunk lid lock as far as the stop. The trunk lid can be unlocked and opened with the trunk lid emergency release when the vehicle is stationary or while driving. Trunk lid emergency release light: RThe button flashes for 30 minutes after the trunk lid is opened. RThe button flashes for 60 minutes after the trunk lid is closed. The trunk lid emergency release does not open the trunk lid if the battery is disconnected or discharged. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 83 Version: 3.0.3.6 Side windows Side windows G Warning! themselves on parts of the vehicle seriously or fatally injured through excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with vehicle equipment that can be operated even if the SmartKey is removed from the starter switch or removed from the vehicle, such as seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment, or the memory function If children open a door, they could injure other persons or get out of the vehicle and injure themselves or be injured by following traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and the child could be burned by these parts. When opening or closing the door windows, make sure there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the opening/closing procedure. The door windows are equipped with the automatic operation and anti-entrapment features. If during automatic operation a door window encounters an obstruction that blocks its path, the anti-entrapment feature will stop the door window and open it slightly. The door windows operate differently when the switch is pulled and held. See the section about the side windows for details. The closing of the door windows can be immediately halted by releasing the switch or, if the switch was pulled past the resistance point and released, by either pressing or pulling the respective switch. If a door window encounters an obstruction that blocks its path in a circumstance where you are closing the door windows by pressing and holding button & on the SmartKey or by pressing and holding the sensor surface (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO) on an outside door handle, the anti-entrapment feature will not operate. Activate the override switch when children are riding in the back seats of the vehicle. The children may otherwise injure themselves, e.g. by becoming trapped in the door window opening. G Warning! G Warning! Important safety notes G Warning! When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. The children could Rinjure Rbe Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment or trunk unless they are firmly secured in place. Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo increases a child's risk of injury in the event of 83 Do not keep any part of your body up against the window pane when opening a window. The downward motion of the pane may pull that part of your body down between the window pane and the door frame and trap it there. If there is a risk of entrapment, release the switch and pull it to close the window. Rstrong braking maneuvers changes of direction Ran accident Rsudden Z Opening and closing BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 84 Version: 3.0.3.6 Side windows 84 Opening and closing the side windows Convenience opening You can ventilate the vehicle before you start driving. To do this, you can use the key to simultaneously: Ropen the side windows the tilt/sliding sunroof or the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel and the roller sunblinds Opening and closing Ropen i The convenience opening feature can : Front left ; Front right = Rear right ? Rear left The switches for all side windows are located on the driver's door. There is also a switch on each door for the corresponding side window. i Operation of the side windows in the rear compartment is not possible when the override switch for the side windows is activated. X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock. i You can continue to operate the side windows after you switch off the engine. This function remains active for five minutes or until one of the front doors is opened. X To open: press the corresponding switch. To close: pull the corresponding switch. i If you press the switch beyond the point of resistance, an automatic opening/ closing process is started in the corresponding direction. You can stop automatic operation by pressing again. X only be operated using the key. The key must be near the handle of the driver's door. X Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle. X Press and hold the % button until the side windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof or panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel are in the desired position. The vehicle is unlocked. If the roller sunblinds of the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel are closed, the roller sunblinds are opened first. X Press and hold the % button again until the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel is in the desired position. X To interrupt the convenience opening procedure: release the % button. Convenience closing General information When you lock the vehicle, you can simultaneously: Rclose the side windows the tilt/sliding sunroof or the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel On vehicles with a panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel, you can then close the roller sunblinds. Rclose BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 85 Version: 3.0.3.6 Side windows When closing the door windows and the tilt/ sliding sunroof or panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel, make sure there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the closing procedure. If potential danger exists, proceed as follows: Using KEYLESS-GO The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO must be outside the vehicle but no more than 3 ft (1 m) away from a door. X Close all the doors. RRelease button & to stop the closing procedure. To open, press and hold button %. To continue the closing procedure after making sure that there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the closing procedure, press and hold button &. Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: RRelease the sensor surface on the outside door handle to stop the closing procedure. RImmediately pull on the same outside door handle and hold firmly. The door windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof or panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel will open for as long as the door handle is held but the door not opened. Using the SmartKey i The key must be near the handle of the driver's door. X Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle. X Press and hold the & button until the side windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof or the panorama roof with power tilt/ sliding panel are fully closed. X Make sure that all the side windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof or panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel are closed. On vehicles with a panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel: X Press and hold the & button again until the roller sunblinds of the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel close. X To interrupt the convenience closing procedure: release the & button. X Touch the sensor surface on door handle : until the side windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof or panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel are fully closed. i Make sure you only touch sensor surface :. X Make sure that all the side windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof or panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel are closed. On vehicles with a panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel: X Touch sensor surface : on the door handle again until the roller sunblinds of the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel close. X To interrupt convenience closing: release sensor surface : on the door handle. Resetting the side windows You must reset all the side windows if the side window cannot be closed fully. X Close all the doors. X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock. Z Opening and closing G Warning! 85 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Sliding sunroof 86 X Pull on the corresponding switch on the door control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 84). X Hold the switch for an additional second. If the side window opens again slightly: X Opening and closing 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 86 Version: 3.0.3.6 Pull the corresponding switch again immediately and hold it for approximately one second. Problems with the side windows Problem: a side window cannot be closed because objects are trapped between the side window and the door frame. X If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens again slightly: X Immediately after the window blocks, pull on the corresponding switch again until the side window has closed. The side window is closed without the antientrapment feature. G Warning! Pulling and holding the switch to close the door window immediately after it had been blocked two times will cause the door window to close without the anti-entrapment feature for as long as you hold the switch. Remove the objects. X Close the side window. Sliding sunroof Problem: a side window cannot be closed because objects in the guide rail are preventing the window from being raised. G Warning! X Remove the objects. X Close the side window. Problem: a side window cannot be closed, and you cannot see the cause. G Warning! Closing the side windows with increased force or without the anti-entrapment feature could lead to serious or even fatal injury. Make sure that nobody can become trapped when closing the side windows. If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again slightly: X Immediately after the window blocks, pull on the corresponding switch again until the side window has closed. The side window is closed with increased force. Important safety notes When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. The children could Rinjure themselves on parts of the vehicle seriously or fatally injured through excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with vehicle equipment that can be operated even if the SmartKey is removed from the starter switch or removed from the vehicle, such as seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment, or the memory function If children open a door, they could injure other persons or get out of the vehicle and injure themselves or be injured by following traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very Rbe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 87 Version: 3.0.3.6 Sliding sunroof hot, and the child could be burned by these parts. G Warning! Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the passenger compartment or trunk unless they are firmly secured in place. Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo increases a child's risk of injury in the event of Rstrong braking maneuvers changes of direction Ran accident Rsudden G Warning! When opening or closing the tilt/sliding sunroof, make sure there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the opening/closing procedure. The tilt/sliding sunroof is equipped with the automatic operation and anti-entrapment features. If the movement of the tilt/sliding sunroof is blocked during the closing procedure, the tilt/sliding sunroof will stop and open slightly. The tilt/sliding sunroof operates differently when the sunroof switch is pressed and held. See the section about problems with the sliding sunroof for details. The opening/closing procedure of the tilt/ sliding sunroof can be immediately halted by releasing the sunroof switch or, if the sunroof switch was moved past the resistance point and released, by moving the sunroof switch in any direction. G Warning! The tilt/sliding sunroof is made out of glass. In the event of an accident, the glass may shatter. This may result in an opening in the roof. In a vehicle rollover, occupants not wearing their seat belts or not wearing them properly may be thrown out of the opening. Such an opening also presents a potential for injury for 87 occupants wearing their seat belts properly as entire body parts or portions of them may protrude from the passenger compartment. G Warning! When opening or closing the tilt/sliding panel, make sure there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the opening/closing procedure. The tilt/sliding panel is equipped with the automatic operation and anti-entrapment features. If the movement of the tilt/sliding panel is blocked during the closing procedure, the tilt/sliding panel will stop and open slightly. The tilt/sliding panel operates differently when the roof panel switch is pressed and held. See the relevant section in this chapter for details. The opening/closing procedure of the tilt/ sliding panel can be immediately halted by releasing the roof panel switch or, if the roof panel switch was moved past the resistance point and released, by moving the roof panel switch in any direction. G Warning! The panorama roof with tilt/sliding panel is made out of glass. In the event of an accident, the glass may shatter. This may result in an opening in the roof. In a vehicle rollover, occupants not wearing their seat belts or not wearing them properly may be thrown out of the opening. Such an opening also presents a potential for injury for occupants wearing their seat belts properly as entire body parts or portions of them may protrude from the passenger compartment. ! Only open the sliding sunroof if it is free of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions may occur. Do not allow anything to protrude from the sliding sunroof. Otherwise, the seals could be damaged. ! If the sliding sunroof cannot be opened or closed due to a malfunction, contact a Z Opening and closing BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Sliding sunroof 88 qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. ! Do not forget that the weather can Opening and closing 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 88 Version: 3.0.3.6 change abruptly. Make certain that the sliding sunroof is closed when you leave the vehicle. The vehicle electronics can be damaged if water enters the vehicle interior. i Resonance noises can occur in addition to the usual airflow noises when the sliding sunroof is open. They are caused by minor pressure fluctuations in the vehicle interior. Change the position of the sliding sunroof or open a side window slightly to reduce or eliminate these noises. Operating the tilt/sliding sunroof Opening and closing i You can still operate the tilt/sliding sunroof even if you switch off the engine or remove the SmartKey. This function remains active for five minutes or until one of the front doors is opened. Overhead control panel : To raise ; To open = To close X Switch on the ignition. Push or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction. i If you press the 3 switch beyond the point of resistance, an automatic opening/ X closing process is started in the corresponding direction. You can stop automatic operation by pressing again. Automatic opening/raising is only available if the tilt/sliding sunroof is in the closed position. You can open/close the cover for the sunblind manually when the tilt/sliding sunroof is raised/closed. Resetting Reset the tilt/sliding sunroof if it does not open smoothly. ! Contact a qualified specialist workshop if the tilt/sliding sunroof cannot be closed fully or reset. X Switch on the ignition. Raise the tilt/sliding sunroof fully at the rear (Y page 88). X Keep the 3 switch pressed for another second. X Make sure that the tilt/sliding sunroof can be opened or closed fully again using the opening/closing process (Y page 88). X If the tilt/sliding sunroof can be raised fully at the rear it is set correctly. If this is not the case, you must repeat the previously described steps. X BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 89 Version: 3.0.3.6 Sliding sunroof Opening and closing Overhead control panel : To raise ; To open = To close The panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel can only be moved when the roller sunblinds are open. X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Push or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction. i If you press the 3 switch beyond the point of resistance, an automatic opening/ closing process is started in the corresponding direction. You can stop automatic operation by pressing again. Automatic raising is only available if the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel is in the closed position. Operating the roller sunblinds of the panorama sliding sunroof General notes The roller sunblinds provide protection from the sun. The two roller sunblinds can only be opened and closed together when the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel is closed. G Warning When opening the roller sunblinds, make sure that nobody can be injured during the opening procedure. The roller sunblinds are equipped with the express operation and anti-entrapment features. If the roller sunblinds block during the opening procedure, the anti-entrapment feature stops the roller sunblinds and opens them again slightly. The opening procedure of the roller sunblinds can be stopped immediately by releasing the roof switch or by operating the roof switch in any direction if the roof switch has been pressed beyond the point of resistance and has been released. Opening and closing Overhead control panel : To open ; To open = To close X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Push or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction. i If you press the 3 switch beyond the point of resistance, an automatic opening/ closing process is started in the corresponding direction. You can stop automatic operation by pressing again. Z Opening and closing Operating the panorama sliding sunroof 89 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Sliding sunroof 90 Resetting the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel and the roller sunblinds Reset the panorama roof with power tilt/ sliding panel and the roller sunblinds if the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel or the roller sunblind do not open smoothly. Opening and closing 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 90 Version: 3.0.3.6 ! Do not open the panorama sliding sunroof until it has been reset properly. Otherwise, the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel may lock in the open position. If the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel cannot be closed or adjusted, contact a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Center. Problems with the sliding sunroof Problem: the sunroof cannot be closed and you cannot see the cause. G Warning! You could be severely or even fatally injured when closing the sliding sunroof with increased closing force or if the antientrapment feature is deactivated. Make sure that nobody can become trapped when closing the sliding sunroof. If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during closing: X X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Press the 3 switch to the point of resistance in the direction of arrow ; and hold it until the roller sunblinds are fully open. X Press the 3 switch to the point of resistance in the direction of arrow ; and hold it until the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel has opened about 10 cm. X Pull the 3 switch repeatedly to the point of resistance in the direction of arrow = until the panorama roof with power tilt/ sliding panel is fully closed. X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional second. X Pull the 3 switch to the point of resistance in the direction of arrow = and hold it until the roller sunblinds are fully closed. X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional second. X Make sure that the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel can be opened fully again (Y page 89). X If this is not the case, the previously described steps must be repeated or you should consult a qualified specialist workshop. Immediately after the sliding sunroof blocks, pull the 3 switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed. The sliding sunroof is closed with increased force. If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during closing again: X Immediately after the sliding sunroof blocks, pull the 3 switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed. The sliding sunroof is closed without the anti-entrapment feature. G Warning! Pressing and holding the sliding sunroof switch to close the sliding sunroof immediately after it had been blocked two times will cause the sliding sunroof to close without the anti-entrapment feature for as long as you hold the switch. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 91 Version: 3.0.3.6 91 Vehicle equipment .............................. 92 Correct driver's seat position ............ 92 Seats .................................................... 93 Steering wheel .................................... 98 Mirrors ................................................. 99 Memory functions ............................. 102 Seats, steering wheel and mirrors BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 92 Correct driver's seat position Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. Seats, steering wheel and mirrors 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 92 Version: 3.0.3.6 Correct driver's seat position Ryou have moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. Ryou have set the seat cushion angle so that your thighs are gently supported. Ryou can depress the pedals properly. X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted properly (Y page 95). When doing so, make sure that you have adjusted the head restraint so that the back of your head is supported at eye level by the center of the head restraint. Observe the important safety notes on (Y page 98). X Check whether steering wheel : is adjusted properly. Adjusting the steering wheel manually(Y page 98) Adjusting the steering wheel electrically (Y page 98) When adjusting the steering wheel, make sure: Ryou can hold the steering wheel with your arms slightly bent. can move your legs freely. Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly. Ryou Observe the important safety notes on (Y page 93). X Check whether you have adjusted seat = properly. Manual and electrical seat adjustment (Y page 94) Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 94) When adjusting the seat, make sure: Ryou are as far away from the driver's air bag as possible. Ryou are sitting in a normal upright position. Ryou can fasten the seat belt properly. Observe the important safety notes on (Y page 50). X Check whether you have fastened seat belt ; properly (Y page 52). The seat belt should: Rfit snugly across your body routed across the middle of your shoulder Rbe routed in your pelvic area across the hip joints X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror and the exterior mirrors (Y page 100) in such a way that you have a good view of road and traffic conditions. X Vehicles with memory function: save the seat, steering wheel and exterior mirror settings (Y page 102). Rbe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 93 Version: 3.0.3.6 Seats Seats Important safety notes G Warning In order to avoid possible loss of vehicle control, all seat, head restraint, steering wheel and rear view mirror adjustments, as well as fastening of seat belts, must be done before setting the vehicle in motion. G Warning Do not adjust the driver's seat while driving. Adjusting the seat while driving could cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Never travel in a moving vehicle with the seat backrest in an excessively reclined position as this can be dangerous. You could slide under the seat belt in a collision. If you slide under it, the seat belt would apply force at the abdomen or neck. This could cause serious or fatal injuries. The seat backrest and seat belts provide the best restraint when the wearer is in a position that is as upright as possible and seat belts are properly positioned on the body. G Warning Your seat belt must be adjusted so that you can correctly fasten your seat belt. Observe the following points: Radjust the seat backrest until your arms are slightly angled when holding the steering wheel. Radjust the seat to a comfortable seating position that still allows you to reach the accelerator/brake pedal safely. The position should be as far back as possible with the driver still able to operate the controls properly. Radjust the head restraint so that it is as close to the head as possible and the center 93 of the head restraint supports the back of the head at eye level. Rnever place hands under the seat or near any moving parts while a seat is being adjusted. Failure to do so could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. G Warning The electrically adjustable seats can be operated at any time. Therefore, do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. G Warning! According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in the rear seating positions than in the front seating position. Thus, we strongly recommend that children be placed in the rear seats whenever possible. Regardless of seating position, children 12 years old and under must be seated and properly secured in an appropriately sized infant restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat recommended for the size and weight of the child. For additional information, see "Children in the vehicle". A child's risk of serious or fatal injuries is significantly increased if the child restraints are not properly secured in the vehicle and/ or the child is not properly secured in the child restraint. G Warning For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints. Adjust the head restraint so that it is as close to the head as possible and the center of the head restraint supports the back of the head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in the event of an accident or similar situation. Z Seats, steering wheel and mirrors BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 94 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 94 Version: 3.0.3.6 Seats Do not drive the vehicle without the seat head restraints. Head restraints are intended to help reduce injuries during an accident. Adjusting the seat manually and electrically ! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat heating, observe the following information: Seats, steering wheel and mirrors Rdo not spill any liquids on the seats. If liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as soon as possible. Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not switch on the seat heating. The seat heating should also not to be used to dry the seats. Rclean the seat covers as recommended; see the " Interior care" section. Rdo not transport heavy loads on the seats. Do not place sharp objects on the seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools. The seats should only be occupied by passengers, if possible. Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. covers, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats. ! When you move the seats, make sure that there are no objects in the footwell or behind the seats. Otherwise, you could damage the seats and the objects. i The head restraints in the front seats are installed with the NECK-PRO system (Y page 49). For this reason, it is not possible to remove the head restraints from the front seats. Vehicles without the through-loading feature: the head restraints cannot be removed from the rear compartment seats. Please contact an authorized MercedesBenz Center for more information. i Related topics: RThrough-loading feature in the rear bench seat (Y page 218) : Backrest angle ; Seat height = Seat cushion angle ? Seat fore-and-aft adjustment i AMG vehicles are equipped with a seat with an integrated head restraint. It is, therefore, not possible to set the height and angle of the head restraint. i Adjust the seat cushion angle so that your thighs are lightly supported. Seat fore-and-aft adjustment X Lift handle ? and slide the seat forwards or backwards. X Release lever ? again. Make sure that you hear the seat engage in position. Seat cushion angle X Turn handwheel = in the desired direction. Adjusting the seat electrically i Vehicles without the memory function: the seats can be adjusted within five minutes of opening a front door. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 95 Version: 3.0.3.6 Seats The time span starts over if, within these five minutes, you: consequently the head restraint adjustment button is disabled. It is, therefore, not possible to set the height and angle of the head restraint. Ropen Rinsert Depending on the equipment, the seat adjustment switches are located either on the side of the seat or on the door control panel. Adjusting the head restraints Adjusting the head restraints manually Adjusting the head restraint height6 X To raise: pull the head restraint up to the desired position. X To lower: press release catch : in the direction of the arrow and push the head restraint down to the desired position. Adjusting the angle of the head restraints : Seat cushion angle ; Seat height = Seat fore-and-aft adjustment ? Backrest angle A Head restraint height5 i You can store the seat settings using the memory function (Y page 102). X Push or pull the lower edge of the head restraint in the direction of the arrow. i AMG vehicles are equipped with a seat with an integrated head restraint and 5 6 Only for vehicles with the memory function. For vehicles without memory function only. Z Seats, steering wheel and mirrors or close a front door the key into or remove the key from the ignition lock Rswitch the ignition on or off. If the key is in position 2 in the ignition, you can adjust the seats at any time. 95 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 96 Version: 3.0.3.6 Seats 96 Adjusting the head restraints electrically7 X To raise: pull the head restraint up to the desired position. X X To lower: press release catch : and push the head restraint down until it is in the desired position. To adjust the head restraint height: slide the switch for head restraint adjustment (Y page 94) up or down in the direction of the arrow. Rear seat head restraints Seats, steering wheel and mirrors G Warning! For your protection, drive only with properly positioned head restraints. Adjust the head restraint in such a way that it is as close to the head as possible and the center of the head restraint supports the back of the head at eye level. This will reduce the potential for injury to the head and neck in the event of an accident or similar situation. With a rear seat occupied, make sure to move the respective head restraint up from the lowest non-use position and have the occupant adjust the head restraint properly. Do not drive the vehicle without the seat head restraints installed when the rear seats are occupied. Head restraints are intended to help reduce injuries during an accident. Adjusting the rear seat head restraint height If the head restraint is fully lowered, it is necessary to press release catch :. 7 8 Only for vehicles with memory function. Only for vehicles with the through-loading feature. Removing and installing the rear head restraints8 G Warning! Occupants should only travel sitting on seats which have the head restraints installed. In the event of an accident, this reduces the risk of injury for passengers seated in the rear compartment. X Release the rear seat backrest and fold it slightly forwards (Y page 218). X To remove: pull the head restraint up to the stop. X Press release catch : and pull the head restraint out of the guides. X To re-install: insert the head restraint so that the notches on the bar are on the left when viewed in the direction of travel. X Push the head restraint down until you hear it engage in position. X Fold back the rear seat backrest until it engages. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 97 Version: 3.0.3.6 Seats Adjusting the lumbar support You can adjust the contour of the front seats so as to provide optimum support for your back. 97 i If, after a certain amount of time, the seat no longer has the desired contour, repeat the adjustment. Switching the seat heating on/off Switching on/off X Move adjustment lever : in the direction of the arrow until the desired backrest contour is achieved. Adaptive seat backrests (AMG vehicles) Repeatedly setting the seat heating to level 3 may result in excessive seat temperatures. The health of passengers that have limited temperature sensitivity or a limited ability to react to excessively high temperatures may be affected or they may even suffer burn-like injuries. Therefore, do not use seat heating level 3 repeatedly. The three red indicator lamps in the button indicate the heating level you have selected. i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat heating may switch off. You can adjust the contour of the front seat backrests individually so as to provide optimum support for your back. Driver's and front-passenger seat : To adjust the upper back support ; To adjust the contour of the backrest in the lumbar region = To adjust the lateral structure and support of the seat X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the ignition lock. The system automatically switches down from level 3 to level 2 after approximately eight minutes. The system automatically switches down from level 2 to level 1 after approximately ten minutes. The system automatically switches off approximately 20 minutes after it is set to level 1. Z Seats, steering wheel and mirrors G Warning! BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 98 Version: 3.0.3.6 Steering wheel 98 X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the ignition lock. X To switch on: press button : repeatedly until the desired heating level is set. X To switch off: press button : repeatedly until all the indicator lamps go out. Adjusting the steering wheel manually Seats, steering wheel and mirrors Problems with the seat heating The seat heating has switched itself off prematurely or cannot be switched on. The vehicle's electrical system voltage is too low because too many electrical consumers are switched on. : Release lever X ; To adjust the steering wheel height Switch off electrical consumers which you do not need, such as the rear window defroster or interior lighting. = To adjust the steering wheel position (fore-and-aft adjustment) X Steering wheel Important safety notes G Warning Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving. Adjusting the steering wheel while driving, or driving without the steering wheel adjustment feature locked could cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle. The electrical steering wheel adjustment feature can be operated at any time. Therefore, do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. Push release lever : down completely. The steering column is unlocked. X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired position. X Push release lever : up completely. The steering column is locked. X Check if the steering column is locked. When doing so, try to push the steering wheel up or down or try to move it in the fore-and-aft direction. Adjusting the steering wheel electrically : To adjust the steering wheel height ; To adjust the steering wheel position (fore-and-aft adjustment) 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 99 Version: 3.0.3.6 Mirrors i Related topics: REASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature (Y page 99) Rstoring settings (Y page 102) EASY-ENTRY/EXIT G Warning! You must make sure no one can become trapped or injured by the moving steering wheel when the easy-entry/exit feature is activated. To stop steering wheel movement, move steering wheel adjustment stalk or press the memory position switch. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could open the driver's door and unintentionally activate the easy-entry/exit feature, which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. The EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature makes getting in and out of your vehicle easier. The steering wheel swings upwards when you: Rremove also automatically moved to the previously set position. The last position of the steering wheel is stored when you switch off the ignition or when you store the setting with the memory function (Y page 102). You can activate and deactivate the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature in the on-board computer (Y page 181). G Warning Let the system complete the adjustment procedure before setting the vehicle in motion. All steering wheel adjustment must be completed before setting the vehicle in motion. Driving off with the steering wheel still adjusting could cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle. i If the crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is triggered in an accident, the steering column will move upwards when the driver's door is opened. This occurs irrespective of the position of the key in the ignition lock. This makes it easier to exit the vehicle and rescue the occupants. The crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is only operational after an accident if the EASY-EXIT/ENTRY feature is activated in the on-board computer. the key from the ignition lock. the driver's door and KEYLESS-GO is in position 1 Ropen the driver's door and the key is in position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock. Mirrors i The steering wheel only moves upwards if Rear-view mirror Ropen it has not already reached the upper end stop. Rear-view mirror (manual anti-glare) The steering wheel is moved to the last selected position when: Rthe Ryou 99 driver's door is closed, and insert the key into the ignition lock. or Rin vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, you press the Start/Stop button once. When you close the driver's door with the ignition switched on, the steering wheel is Z Seats, steering wheel and mirrors BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 100 Version: 3.0.3.6 Mirrors 100 X Anti-glare mode: flick anti-glare switch : forwards or back. Exterior mirrors Adjusting the exterior mirrors Folding the exterior mirrors in or out electrically This function is only available in vehicles for Canada. ! Fold in the exterior mirrors when driving the vehicle into an automatic car wash. The mirrors could otherwise be damaged. Seats, steering wheel and mirrors G Warning Exercise care when using the passenger-side exterior rear view mirror. The mirror surface is convex (outwardly curved surface for a wider field of view). Objects in mirror are closer than they appear. Check your interior rear view mirror and glance over your shoulder before changing lanes. The exterior mirrors are automatically heated if the rear window defroster is switched on and the outside temperature is low. X Make sure that the key is in position 1 or 2 in the ignition lock. X Briefly press button :. Both exterior mirrors fold in or out. i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are always folded out fully while the vehicle is in motion as they may otherwise vibrate. i If you are driving faster than X Make sure that the key is in position 1 or 2 in the ignition lock. X Press button : for the left-hand exterior mirror or button ; for the right-hand exterior mirror. The indicator lamp in the corresponding button lights up in red. The indicator lamp goes out again after some time. You can adjust the selected mirror using adjustment button = as long as the indicator lamp is lit. X Press adjustment button = up, down, to the right or to the left until the exterior mirror is set to a position which provides you with a good overview of traffic conditions. 9 mph(15 km/h), you can no longer fold in the exterior mirrors. Resetting the exterior mirrors This function is only available in vehicles for Canada. If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must be reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise not fold in when you select the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function in the on-board computer (Y page 182). X Make sure that the key is in position 1 in the ignition lock. X Briefly press button :. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 101 Version: 3.0.3.6 Mirrors This function is only available in vehicles for Canada. If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function is activated in the on-board computer (Y page 182): Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside. Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle and then open the driver's or frontpassenger door. i The mirrors do not fold out if they have been folded in manually. Exterior mirror out of position If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of position, proceed as follows: X Vehicles without electrically folding exterior mirrors: move the exterior mirror into the correct position manually. X Vehicles with electrically folding exterior mirrors (only vehicles for Canada): press the mirror-folding button (Y page 100) repeatedly until you hear the mirror engage in position. The mirror housing is engaged again and you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual (Y page 100). Automatic anti-glare mirrors G Warning! The auto dimming function does not react if incoming light is not aimed directly at sensors in the interior rear view mirror. The interior rear view mirror and the exterior rear view mirror on the driver's side do not react, for example, if the rear window sunshade is in raised position. Light hitting the mirror(s) at certain angles (incident light) could blind you. As a result, you may not be able to observe traffic conditions and could cause an accident. The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror on the driver's side automatically go into antiglare mode if the ignition is switched on and incident light from headlamps strikes the sensor in the rear-view mirror. The mirrors do not go into anti-glare mode if reverse gear is engaged or the interior lighting is switched on. Parking position for the exterior mirror on the front-passenger side Setting and storing the parking position You can position the front-passenger side exterior mirror in such a way that you can see the rear wheel on that side as soon as you engage reverse gear. You can store this position. X Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and that the key is in position 2 in the ignition lock. X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on the front-passenger side. Z Seats, steering wheel and mirrors Folding the exterior mirrors in or out automatically 101 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Memory functions 102 X Engage reverse gear. The exterior mirror on the front-passenger side moves to the preset parking position. X Use adjustment button = to adjust the exterior mirror to a position which allows you to see the rear wheel and the curb. The parking position is stored. i If you shift the transmission to another Seats, steering wheel and mirrors 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 102 Version: 3.0.3.6 position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving position. i You can also store the parking position using memory button M ?. X With the key in position 2 in the ignition lock and with the exterior mirror on the front-passenger side activated, use adjustment button = to set the exterior mirror such that the rear wheel and curb are visible. X Press memory button M ? and one of the arrows on adjustment button = within three seconds. The parking position is stored if the exterior mirror does not move. If the mirror moves out of position, repeat the steps. Calling up a stored parking position setting X With the key in position 2 in the ignition lock and the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side activated, engage reverse gear. The exterior mirror on the front-passenger side moves to the stored parking position. The exterior mirror on the front-passenger side moves back to its original position: Ras soon as you exceed a speed of 6 mph (10 km/h) Rabout ten seconds after you have disengaged reverse gear Rif you press button : for the exterior mirror on the driver's side Memory functions Storing settings With the memory function, you can store up to three different settings, e.g. for three different people. The following settings are stored as a single memory preset: Rposition of the seat, backrest and head restraint Rdriver's side: steering wheel position Rdriver's side: position of the exterior mirrors on the driver's and front-passenger sides G Warning! The memory function can still be used when the key has been removed. For this reason, children should never be left unsupervised in the vehicle. They could otherwise become trapped when adjusting the seat or the steering wheel. G Warning! Only use the memory function on the driver's side when the vehicle is stationary. You could otherwise be distracted from the traffic conditions by the steering wheel and seat moving of their own accord, and as a result cause an accident. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 103 Version: 3.0.3.6 Memory functions 103 X Seats, steering wheel and mirrors Adjust the seat (Y page 94). X On the driver's side, adjust the steering wheel (Y page 98) and the exterior mirrors (Y page 100). X Press memory button M and one of the storage position buttons 1, 2 or 3 within three seconds. The settings are stored in the selected preset position. A tone sounds when the settings have been completed. Calling up a stored setting ! If you want to move the seat from the fully reclined position to a stored seat position, first raise the backrest. The seat could otherwise be damaged. X Press and hold the relevant storage position button 1, 2 or 3, until the seat, steering wheel and exterior mirrors are in the stored position. i The setting procedure is interrupted as soon as you release the storage position button. Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 104 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 104 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 105 Version: 3.0.3.6 105 Vehicle equipment ............................ Exterior lighting ................................ Interior lighting ................................. Changing bulbs ................................. Windshield wipers ............................ 106 106 110 111 115 Lights and windshield wipers BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 106 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 106 Version: 3.0.3.6 Exterior lighting Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard Light switch Operation Lights and windshield wipers and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. Exterior lighting Important safety notes For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched on even during the daytime. In some countries, operation of the headlamps varies due to legal requirements and self-imposed obligations. In these countries, the daytime running lamps are automatically switched on when the engine is started. Notes on driving abroad Converting to symmetrical low beam when driving abroad: switch the headlamps to symmetrical low beam in countries in which traffic drives on the opposite side of the road to the country where the vehicle is registered. This prevents oncoming traffic from being dazzled. Symmetrical lights do not illuminate as large an area of the edge of the road. Have the headlamps converted at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, as close to the border as possible before driving in these countries. Converting to asymmetrical low beam after returning: have the headlamps converted back to asymmetrical low beam at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, as soon as possible after crossing the border when returning. 1W Left-hand standing lamps 2X Right-hand standing lamps 3T Parking lamps, license plate and instrument lighting 4c Automatic headlamp mode/daytime running lamps 5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps BR Rear fog lamp CN Front fog lamps The turn signals, high-beam headlamps and the high beam flasher are operated using the combination switch (Y page 108). ! Switch off the parking lamps and standing lamps when you leave the vehicle. This prevents the battery from discharging. The exterior lighting (except the parking lamps/standing lamps) switches off automatically if you: Rremove the key from the ignition lock the driver's door with the key in position 0 If you hear a warning tone when you leave the vehicle, the lights may still be switched on. X Turn the light switch to c. Ropen BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 107 Version: 3.0.3.6 Exterior lighting X To switch on the low-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start the engine. X Turn the light switch to L. The L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up. Daytime running lamps Daytime running lamps in Canada In Canada, the "daytime running lamps" function is required by law. It can therefore not be deactivated. X Turn the light switch to c. With the engine running: depending on the ambient light, either the daytime running lamps or the low-beam headlamps are switched on. If the low-beam headlamps are switched on, the L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up. With the engine running while the vehicle is stationary: if you shift the selector lever to P from a driving position (vehicles with automatic transmission), or if the parking brake is applied, the low-beam headlamps switch off automatically after 3 minutes. With the engine running while the vehicle is stationary: if you set the light switch to T, the parking lamps and the low-beam headlamps switch on. Daytime running lamps in the USA This function is only available on vehicles equipped with daytime running lamps. The daytime running lamps are deactivated ex works on vehicles for the USA. X To switch on the daytime running lamps (vehicles with luxury multifunction steering wheel): switch on 9 the "daytime running lamps" function via the on-board computer (Y page 180). X Turn the light switch to c. With the engine running: depending on the ambient light, either the daytime running lamps or the low-beam headlamps are switched on. If the low-beam headlamps are switched on, the L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up. You can only switch on the high-beam headlamps if there is little ambient light. However, the headlamp flashers can always be applied. If you set the light switch to T or L while the engine is running, the manual setting overrides the daytime running lamps. Automatic headlamps G Risk of accident If the light switch is set to c, the low-beam headlamps will not come on automatically if it is foggy. This could endanger you and others. Therefore, turn the light switch to L in fog. The automatic headlamp feature is only an aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle's lighting at all times. X To switch on automatic headlamp mode: turn the light switch to c. SmartKey in position 1 in the ignition lock: the parking lamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the ambient light. With the engine running: depending on the brightness of the ambient light, the daytime running lamps9 or the low-beam headlamps are switched on or off automatically. When the low-beam headlamps are switched on, the L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up. Only if daytime running lamps have been activated via the on-board computer. Z Lights and windshield wipers Low-beam headlamps 107 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 108 Version: 3.0.3.6 Exterior lighting 108 Fog lamps and rear fog lamps Front fog lamps Only vehicles with front fog lamps have the "fog lamps" function. Combination switch Turn signals G Warning! Lights and windshield wipers If you suspect that driving conditions will be foggy, turn the light switch to L before you start your journey. Otherwise, your vehicle may not be visible and you could endanger yourself and others. X To switch on the front fog lamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start the engine. X Turn the light switch to L or c. X Press the N button. The green N indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up. X To switch off the front fog lamps: press the N button. The green N indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out. Rear fog lamp X To switch on the rear fog lamp: turn the key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start the engine. X Turn the light switch to L or c. When the light switch is set to c, the rear fog lamp only lights up if the low-beam headlamps are switched on. X Press the R button. The yellow R indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up. X To switch off the rear fog lamp: press the R button. The yellow R indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out. : High-beam headlamps ; Right turn signal = High beam flasher ? Left turn signal X To indicate briefly: press the combination switch briefly to the pressure point in the direction of arrow ; or ?. The corresponding turn signal flashes three times. X To indicate: press the combination switch beyond the pressure point in the direction of arrow ; or ?. High-beam headlamps X To switch on the high-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start the engine. X Turn the light switch to L or c. X Press the combination switch beyond the pressure point in the direction of arrow :. In the c position, the high-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark and the engine is running. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 109 Version: 3.0.3.6 Exterior lighting The K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the high-beam headlamps are switched on. X To switch off the high-beam headlamps: move the combination switch back to its normal position. The K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out. High-beam flasher X To switch on: turn the key in the ignition lock to position 1 or 2 or start the engine. X Pull the combination switch briefly in the direction of arrow =. Hazard warning lamps The hazard warning lamps automatically switch on: Rif an air bag is deployed vehicle decelerates rapidly from a speed of more than 45 mph (70 km/h) and comes to a standstill. X To switch on the hazard warning lamps: press button :. All turn signals flash. If you now switch on a turn signal using the combination switch, only the turn signal lamp on the corresponding side of the vehicle will flash. X To switch off the hazard warning lamps: press button :. Rthe 109 vehicle then reaches a speed above 6 mph (10 km/h) again. i The hazard warning lamps still operate if the ignition is switched off. Headlamp cleaning system The headlamps are cleaned automatically if the "Wipe with washer fluid" function is operated ten times while the lights are on and the engine is running (Y page 116). When you switch off the ignition, the automatic headlamp cleaning system is reset and counting is resumed from 0. Active light function The active light function is a system that moves the headlamps according to the steering movements of the front wheels. In this way, relevant areas remain illuminated while driving. This allows you to recognize pedestrians, cyclists and animals. Active: when the lights are switched on. The hazard warning lamp switches off automatically after full brake application if the Z Lights and windshield wipers BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 110 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 110 Version: 3.0.3.6 Interior lighting Cornering light function Interior lighting Lights and windshield wipers Overview of interior lighting The cornering light function improves the illumination of the road over a wide angle in the direction you are turning, enabling better visibility in tight bends, for example. It can only be activated when the low-beam headlamps are switched on. Active: if you are driving at speeds below 25 mph (40 km/h) and switch on the turn signals or turn the steering wheel. Not active: if you are driving at speeds above 25 mph (40 km/h) or switch off the turn signal or turn the steering wheel to the straight-ahead position. The cornering light function may remain lit for a short time, but is automatically switched off after no more than three minutes. : u To switch the rear interior lighting on/off ; | To switch the automatic interior lighting control on/off = p To switch the right-hand front reading lamp on/off ? c To switch the front interior lighting on/off A p To switch the left-hand front reading lamp on/off B Front reading lamps Headlamps fogged up on the inside The headlamps may fog up on the inside if there is high atmospheric humidity. X Drive with the headlamps switched on. The headlamps clear up after a short distance. If the moisture does not disappear, the headlamp casing is not sealed correctly and moisture has been able to enter. X Have the headlamps checked at a qualified specialist workshop. C Front interior lighting BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 111 Version: 3.0.3.6 Changing bulbs 111 Manual interior lighting control X To switch the front interior lighting on/ off: press the c button. X To switch the rear interior lighting on/ off: press the u button. X To switch the reading lamps on/off: press the p button. lamp on/off ; p To switch the left-hand reading lamp on/off Interior lighting control Important notes In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from discharging, the interior lighting functions are automatically deactivated after some time except for when the key is in position 2 in the ignition lock. Automatic interior lighting control X To switch on/off: press the | button. When the automatic interior lighting control is activated, the button is flush with the overhead control panel. The interior lighting automatically switches on if you: Runlock the vehicle a door Rremove the key from the ignition lock The interior light is activated for a short while when the key is removed from the ignition lock. You can activate this delayed switch-off using the on-board computer (Y page 180). Ropen Crash-responsive emergency lighting If the interior lighting is set to automatic, the interior lighting is activated automatically if the vehicle is involved in an accident. X To switch off the crash-responsive emergency lighting: press the hazard warning lamp button. or X Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the key. Changing bulbs Important safety notes Xenon bulbs If your vehicle is equipped with Xenon bulbs, you can recognize this by the following: the cone of light from the Xenon bulbs moves from the top to the bottom and back again when you start the engine. For this to be observed, the lights must be switched on before starting the engine. G Warning! Xenon bulbs carry a high voltage. You could get an electric shock and be seriously or even fatally injured if you touch the electric contacts on Xenon bulbs. Therefore, never remove the cover from Xenon bulbs. Do not change Xenon bulbs yourself, but have them replaced at a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry out the work required. Z Lights and windshield wipers Rear-compartment overhead control panel : p To switch the right-hand reading BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 112 Changing bulbs Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure that these function correctly at all times. Have the headlamp setting checked regularly. Other bulbs Lights and windshield wipers 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 112 Version: 3.0.3.6 G Warning! Bulbs and lamps can be very hot. You should therefore allow them to cool down before you change them. Otherwise, you could be burned if you touch them. Keep bulbs out of the reach of children. Otherwise, they could damage the bulbs, for example, and injure themselves. Never use a bulb which has been dropped. Such a bulb may break or even explode and injure you. Halogen bulbs are pressurized and can explode when you change them, particularly if they are very hot. You should therefore wear eye protection and gloves when you are changing them. There are bulbs other than the Xenon bulbs that you cannot replace. Replace only the bulbs listed (Y page 112). Have the bulbs that you cannot replace yourself changed at a qualified specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. If you require assistance changing bulbs, consult a qualified specialist workshop. Do not touch the glass tube of new bulbs with your bare hands. Even minor contamination can burn into the glass surface and reduce the service life of the bulbs. Always use a lint- free cloth or only touch the base of the bulb when installing. Only use bulbs of the correct type. If the new bulb still does not light up, consult a qualified specialist workshop. Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure that these function correctly at all times. Have the headlamp setting checked regularly. Overview: changing bulbs/bulb types You can change the following bulbs. The bulb type can be found in the legend. Halogen headlamps : Low-beam headlamp: H7 55 W ; High-beam headlamp: H7 55 W = Parking lamp/standing lamp: W 5 W ? Parking lamp/standing lamp: W 5 W A Turn signal lamp: 3457A Bi-Xenon headlamps : High-beam headlamp: H7 55 W ; Parking lamp/standing lamp: W 5 W BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 113 Version: 3.0.3.6 Changing bulbs = Parking lamp/standing lamp: W 5 W ? Turn signal lamp: 3457A 113 X Detach retaining spring = downwards. X Pull out bulb ?. X Insert the new bulb. X Attach retaining spring =. X Attach connector ; to bulb ?. X Place housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages. Tail lamp with/without LED : Fog lamp/tail lamp (driver's side), tail lamp (passenger side): P 21 W ; Side marker lamp: W 5 W = Turn signal lamp10: PY 21 W ? Brake lamp/tail lamp: P 21 W A Brake lamp/tail lamp: P 21 W B Backup lamp: P 21 W X Switch off the lights. Open the hood. X Turn housing cover : counter-clockwise and pull it out. X Push bulb = on connector ; down until it is released. X Pull connector ; from bulb =. X Attach connector ; to new bulb =. X Align new bulb = at the bottom and push connector ; upwards until it engages. X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages. X Changing the front bulbs Low-beam headlamp (halogen headlamp) X Switch off the lights. Open the hood. X Turn housing cover : counter-clockwise and pull it out. X Pull connector ; from bulb ?. X 10 Vehicles with LED turn signal lamps: the bulb cannot be changed. Z Lights and windshield wipers High-beam headlamps BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 114 Version: 3.0.3.6 Changing bulbs 114 Standing lamps/parking lamps X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder : and turn it clockwise while applying slight pressure. X Place bulb holder : in the headlamp so that retainer = is upright and mark ; is at the top. X Insert bulb holder : into the lamp and turn it clockwise. Lights and windshield wipers Changing the rear bulbs X Switch off the lights. Open the hood. X Turn housing cover : counter-clockwise and pull it out. X Pull out bulb holder ;. X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;. X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;. X Insert bulb holder ;. X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages. X Opening/closing the side trim You must open the side trim panel in the trunk before you can change the bulbs in the tail lamps. Turn signals Left-hand side trim panel X Switch off the lights. Open the hood. X Turn bulb holder : counter-clockwise and pull it out. X Turn the bulb counter-clockwise, applying slight pressure, and remove it from bulb holder :. X Right-hand side trim panel BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 115 Version: 3.0.3.6 Windshield wipers To open: turn release knob : 90° in the direction of the arrow and remove side trim panel ;. X To close: insert side trim panel ; and turn release knob : 90° in the opposite direction to the arrow. Tail lamp X Switch off the lights. Open the trunk. X Open the side trim panel (Y page 114). X X Simultaneously press retaining lugs : in the direction of the arrow and slightly pull out the bulb holder with the bulbs. X Vehicles with LED turn signals: disconnect the cables of the LED turn signal from the bulb holder connectors. X Pull the bulb holder out with the bulbs. ? Parking lamp/standing lamp/brake lamp/tail lamp A Brake lamp/tail lamp B Backup lamp X Rear fog lamp/turn signal lamp/ parking lamp/standing lamp/brake lamp/tail lamp/backup lamp: press the respective bulb back and turn it counterclockwise to remove it from the bulb holder. X Side marker lamp: remove bulb ; from the bulb holder. X Rear fog lamp/turn signal/parking lamp/standing lamp/brake lamp/tail lamp/backup lamp: insert the new bulb into the bulb holder and turn it clockwise. X Side marker lamp: insert the new bulb into the bulb holder and press it in. X Insert the bulb holder again and lock it in. X Close the side trim panel (Y page 114). Windshield wipers Important safety notes G Warning! Wiper blades are components that are subject to wear and tear. Replace the wiper blades twice a year, preferably in the spring and fall. Otherwise the windshield will not be wiped properly. As a result, you may not be able to observe surrounding traffic conditions and could cause an accident. ! Do not operate the windshield wipers Bulb holder without LED turn signal lamp : Rear fog lamp/side marker lamp ; Side marker lamp = Turn signals when the windshield is dry, as this could damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dust that has collected on the windshield can scratch the glass if wiping takes place when the windshield is dry. If it is necessary to switch on the windshield wipers in dry weather conditions, always use washer fluid when operating the windshield wipers. Z Lights and windshield wipers X 115 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Windshield wipers 116 ! If the windshield wipers leave smears on the windscreen after the vehicle has been washed in an automatic car wash, wax or other residues may be the reason for this. Clean the windshield using washer fluid after washing the vehicle in an automatic car wash. Switching the windshield wipers on/ off Lights and windshield wipers 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 116 Version: 3.0.3.6 For this reason, you should always switch off the windshield wipers in dry weather. Vehicles with a rain sensor: in the Ä or Å position, the appropriate wiping frequency is automatically set according to the intensity of the rain. In the Å position, the rain sensor is more sensitive than in the Ä position, causing the windshield wipers to wipe more frequently. Intermittent wiping is interrupted when you stop the vehicle and open a front door. This prevents a person from being splashed inadvertently when getting into or out of the vehicle. Intermittent wiping continues when all doors are closed and Ryou Combination switch 1 $ Windshield wipers off 2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low11 3 Å Intermittent wipe, high12 4 ° Continuous wipe, slow 5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast B í Single wipe/ î to wipe the windshield using washer fluid Switch the ignition on. X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position. X i When you stop the vehicle, the wipers wipe more slowly. ! Vehicles with a rain sensor: if the windshield becomes dirty in dry weather conditions, the windshield wipers may be activated inadvertently. This could then damage the windshield wiper blades or scratch the windshield. 11 Rain 12 Rain sensor set to low sensitivity. sensor set to high sensitivity. depress the clutch (vehicles with manual transmission) or Ryou shift the automatic transmission to drive position D (vehicles with automatic transmission) or to reverse gear R or Ryou change the wipe setting on the combination switch. i To prevent smearing on the windshield or noise when wiping, wipe the windshield occasionally with washer fluid. Replacing the wiper blades Important safety notes G Warning For safety reasons, switch off the windshield wipers and remove the key from the ignition lock before changing the wiper blades (vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: make sure that the on-board electronics are in state 0). Otherwise, the wiper motor could be switched on suddenly and cause injury. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 117 Version: 3.0.3.6 Windshield wipers make sure that you touch only the wiper arm of the wiper. Replacing the wiper blades Removing the wiper blades X Remove the key from the ignition lock or turn the key to position 0 (KEYLESS-GO). X Fold the wiper arm away from the windshield until it engages. X Set the wiper blade at right angles to the wiper arm. X X For safety reasons, you should remove the key from the ignition lock. or X Switch off the engine using the Start/Stop button and open the driver's door. X Remove the cause of the obstruction. X Switch the windshield wipers back on. The windshield wipers are inoperative The windshield wiper drive is malfunctioning. X Select another wiper speed on the combination switch. X Have the windshield wipers checked at a qualified specialist workshop. Remove the wiper blade from the retainer on the wiper arm in the direction of the arrow. Installing the wiper blade X Slide the new wiper blade into the retainer on the wiper arm in the opposite direction to the arrow. Make sure that the wiper blade slides fully into the retainer on the wiper arm. X Turn the wiper blade parallel to the wiper arm. X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windshield. Problems with the windshield wipers The windshield wipers are obstructed Leaves or snow, for example, may be obstructing the windshield wiper movement. The wiper motor has been deactivated. Z Lights and windshield wipers ! To avoid damaging the wiper blades, 117 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 118 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 118 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 119 Version: 3.0.3.6 119 Vehicle equipment ............................ Overview of climate control systems ................................................... Operating the control systems ........ Setting the air vents ......................... 120 120 122 126 Climate control BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 120 Overview of climate control systems Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. Overview of climate control systems Important safety notes Climate control 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 120 Version: 3.0.3.6 G Warning Severe conditions (e.g. strong air pollution) may require replacement of the filter before its scheduled replacement interval. A clogged filter will reduce the air volume to the interior and the windows could fog up, impairing visibility and endangering you and others. Have a clogged filter replaced as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. G Warning Follow the recommended settings for heating and cooling given on the following pages. Otherwise, the windows could fog up, impairing visibility and endangering you and others. Dual-zone automatic climate control controls the temperature and the humidity of the vehicle interior and filters out undesirable substances from the air. Dual-zone automatic climate control is only operational when the engine is running. Optimum operation is only achieved when you drive with the side windows and tilt/ sliding sunroof/panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel closed. i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period during warm weather, e.g. using the convenience opening feature (Y page 84). This will speed up the cooling process and the desired vehicle interior temperature will be reached more quickly. i The integrated filter can filter out most particles of dust and completely filters out pollen. A clogged filter reduces the amount of air supplied to the vehicle interior. For this reason, you should always observe the interval for replacing the filter, which is specified in the Service Booklet. As it depends on environmental conditions, e.g. heavy air pollution, the interval may be shorter than stated in the Service Booklet. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 121 Version: 3.0.3.6 Overview of climate control systems 121 Control panel for the dual-zone automatic climate control i Notes/tips : Sets the temperature, left Set the temperature to 72 ‡ (22 †). ; Sets climate control to automatic Activate climate control using the à and ¿ buttons. The indicator lamps in the à and ¿ buttons light up. = Switches climate control on/ off Activate climate control using the à and ¿ buttons. The indicator lamps in the à and ¿ buttons light up. ? Switches the MONO/ZONE function on/off13 Switches maximum cooling MAX COOL on/off14 Use the MONO function if you want to adopt the temperature and air distribution settings from the driver's side for the front-passenger side. The indicator lamp in the º button lights up. A Switches cooling with air dehumidification on/off Activate climate control using the à and ¿ buttons. The indicator lamps in the à and ¿ buttons light up. B Defrosts the windshield Only use the "defrosting" function briefly until the windshield is clear again. C Activates/deactivates airrecirculation mode Only use "air-recirculation" mode briefly, e.g. if there are unpleasant outside odors or when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise fog up as, in airrecirculation mode, no fresh air is drawn into the vehicle. D Sets the temperature, right Set the temperature to 72 ‡ (22 †). E Switches the rear window heating on/off F Increases the airflow 13 Only 14 Only for Canada. for USA. Z Climate control Function BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 122 Version: 3.0.3.6 Operating the control systems 122 Function i Notes/tips G Reduces the airflow H Display I Sets the air distribution Operating the control systems Switching the control on/off Important information Climate control G Warning! When the climate control system is deactivated, the outside air supply and circulation are also deactivated. Only choose this setting for a short time. Otherwise the windows could fog up, impairing visibility and endangering you and others. i Activate climate control primarily using the à button (Y page 123). Activating/deactivating X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock. X To activate: press the à button. The indicator lamp in the à button lights up. Airflow and air distribution are set to automatic mode. or X Press the ^ button. The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes out. The previously selected settings come into effect again. X To deactivate: press the ^ button. The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights up. Switching cooling with air dehumidification on/off Important information The cooling with air dehumidification function is only available when the engine is running. The air inside the vehicle is cooled and dehumidified according to the temperature selected. G Warning If you switch off the cooling function, the vehicle will not be cooled when weather conditions are warm. The windows can fog up more quickly. Window fogging may impair visibility and endanger you and others. Condensation may drip from the underside of the vehicle when automatic climate control is in cooling mode. This is normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction. i The cooling with air dehumidification function uses refrigerant R134a. This coolant does not contain chlorofluorocarbons, and therefore does not damage the ozone layer. Activating/deactivating i The evaporator is ventilated when the airconditioning system is operated. The blower switches on automatically approximately one hour after the vehicle is locked. The blower runs for 30 minutes on the lowest level. The blower noise is normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction. If you unlock the vehicle during this time, the ventilation will be interrupted. To save battery power, the evaporator will not BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 123 Version: 3.0.3.6 Operating the control systems X To switch on: press the ¿ button. The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights up. X To switch off: press the ¿ button. The indicator lamp in the ¿ button goes out. The cooling with air dehumidification function has a delayed switch-off feature. Problems with the "cooling with air dehumidification" function If the indicator lamp in the ¿ button does not go out when switched off, the cooling with air dehumidification function is switched off due to a malfunction. You can no longer activate the cooling with air dehumidification function. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. Setting climate control to automatic G Warning If you switch off the cooling function, the vehicle will not be cooled when weather conditions are warm. The windows can fog up more quickly. Window fogging may impair visibility and endanger you and others. In automatic mode, the set temperature is maintained automatically at a constant level. The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and the air distribution. Automatic mode will achieve optimal operation if cooling with air dehumidification is also activated. If desired, cooling with air dehumidification can be deactivated. 15 USA X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Set the desired temperature. X To activate: press the à button. The indicator lamp in the à button lights up. Automatic air distribution and airflow are activated. X To deactivate: press the _ button. or X Press the K or I button. The indicator lamp in the à button goes out. Automatic air distribution and airflow are deactivated. Setting the temperature Different temperatures can be set for the driver's and front-passenger sides. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X To increase/reduce: turn controls : and D clockwise or counter-clockwise (Y page 121). Only change the temperature setting in small increments. Start at 72 ‡ (22 †). Setting the air distribution Dual-zone automatic climate control: the air distribution can be set individually for the driver's and front-passenger sides. ¯ directs the airflow through the defroster vents P directs the airflow through the center and side air vents O directs the airflow through the footwell air vents S directs the airflow through the center and side air vents, as well as the footwell air vents15 only. Z Climate control ventilate automatically if the starter battery is weak. 123 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Operating the control systems 124 _ directs the airflow to the entire vehicle interior16 b directs the airflow through the defroster, center and side air vents16 a directs the airflow through the footwell and defroster vents You can use this function to defrost the windshield or to defrost the inside of the windshield and the side windows. i Regardless of the air distribution setting, X airflow is always directed through the side air vents. The side air vents can only be closed when the controls on the side air vents are turned downwards. X Climate control 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 124 Version: 3.0.3.6 Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Press the _ button repeatedly until the desired symbol appears in the display. The indicator lamp in the à button goes out. Automatic control is deactivated and the air distribution is controlled according to the selected setting. Setting the airflow Defrosting the windshield i You should only select the defrosting function until the windshield is clear again. Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X To activate: press the ¬ button. The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights up. The climate control system switches to the following functions: Rcooling with air dehumidification on airflow17 Rhigh temperature17 Rair distribution to the windshield and front side windows Rair-recirculation mode off Rhigh X X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X To increase/reduce: press the K or I button. To deactivate: press the ¬ button. The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes out. The previously selected settings come into effect again. The cooling with air dehumidification function remains on. Airrecirculation mode remains deactivated. or Switching the MONO function on/off This function is only available in vehicles in Canada. You can use the MONO function to adopt the temperature and air distribution settings on the driver's side for the front-passenger side. X Press the º button. The indicator lamp in the º button lights up or goes out. X Press the à button. The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes out. Airflow and air distribution are set to automatic mode. or X Turn controls : or D clockwise or counter-clockwise (Y page 121). or X Press the K or I button. Maximum cooling MAX COOL The MAX COOL function is only available in vehicles for the USA. 16 Canada only. on the outside temperature. 17 Depending BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 125 Version: 3.0.3.6 Operating the control systems Rmaximum cooling airflow Rair-recirculation mode on X To activate: press the Ù button. The indicator lamp in the button lights up. X To deactivate: press the Ù button again. The indicator lamp goes out. The previously selected settings come into effect again. Rmaximum Defrosting the windows Windows fogged up on the inside X Activate the "cooling with air dehumidification" function ¿. X Activate automatic mode Ã. X If the windows continue to fog up, activate the defrosting function (Y page 124). i You should only select this setting until the windshield is clear again. Windows fogged up on the outside X Switch on the windshield wipers. X Press the _ button repeatedly until the O or P symbol appears in the display. i You should only select this setting until the windshield is clear again. Rear window heating Activating/deactivating G Warning Any accumulation of snow and ice should be removed from the rear window before driving. Visibility could otherwise be impaired, endangering you and others. The rear window heating has a high current draw. You should therefore switch it off as soon as the window is clear as it only switches off automatically after several minutes. If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window heating may switch off. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Press the ¤ button. The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights up or goes out. Problems with the rear window heating The rear window heating has deactivated itself prematurely or cannot be activated. X Switch off any consumers that are not required, e.g. reading lamps or interior lighting. When the battery is sufficiently charged, the rear window heating is activated again automatically. Activating/deactivating airrecirculation mode You can deactivate the flow of fresh air if unpleasant odors are entering the vehicle from outside. The air already inside the vehicle will then be recirculated. G Warning Fogged windows impair visibility, endangering you and others. If the windows begin to fog on the inside, switching off the air recirculation mode immediately should clear interior window fogging. If interior window fogging persists, make sure the air conditioning is activated, or press the ¬ button. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X To activate: press the g button. The indicator lamp in the g button lights up. Z Climate control MAX COOL is only operational when the engine is running. When you activate MAX COOL, climate control switches to the following functions: 125 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 126 Version: 3.0.3.6 Setting the air vents 126 i Air-recirculation mode is activated automatically at high outside temperatures. When air-recirculation mode is activated automatically, the indicator lamp in the g button is not lit. Outside air is added after about 30 minutes. X To deactivate: press the g button. The indicator lamp in the g button goes out. In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air through the air vents into the vehicle interior, please observe the following notes: Rkeep the air inlet between the windshield and the hood free of blockages, such as ice, snow or leaves Rnever cover the vents or air inlet and outlet grilles in the vehicle interior. i For virtually draft-free ventilation, adjust the sliders of the air vents to the center position. i Air-recirculation mode switches off automatically: Climate control Rafter approximately five minutes if outside temperatures are under about 41 ‡ (5 †) Rafter approximately five minutes if cooling with air dehumidification is deactivated Rafter approximately 30 minutes if outside temperatures are over about 41 ‡ (5 †) Setting the center air vents Setting the air vents Important safety notes G Warning When operating the climate control, the air that enters the passenger compartment through the air vents can be very hot or very cold (depending on the set temperature). This could cause burns or frostbite to unprotected skin in the immediate area of the air vents. Always keep sufficient distance between unprotected parts of the body and the air vents. If necessary, use the air distribution adjustment to direct the air to air vents in the vehicle interior that are not in the immediate area of unprotected skin. : Center air vent, left ; Center air vent, right = Center vent thumbwheel, right ? Center vent thumbwheel, left X To open/close: turn thumbwheels = and ? up or down. Setting the side air vents BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 127 Version: 3.0.3.6 Setting the air vents X To open/close: turn thumbwheel = up or down. i Side window defroster vent : is never completely shut, even if side air vent ; is shut. 127 Setting the rear-compartment air vents Setting the center vents in the rear compartment Setting the air vent in the glove box ! Close the air vent when heating the vehicle. At high outside temperatures, open the air vent and activate the "cooling with air dehumidification" function. Otherwise, temperature-sensitive items stored in the glove box could be damaged. : Rear-compartment air vent thumbwheel ; Rear-compartment air vent, right = Rear-compartment air vent, left X To open/close: turn thumbwheel : up or down. : Air vent thumbwheel ; Air vent X To open/close: turn thumbwheel : clockwise or counter-clockwise. Z Climate control When automatic climate control is activated, the glove box can be ventilated, for instance to cool its contents. The level of airflow depends on the airflow and air distribution settings. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 128 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 128 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 129 Version: 3.0.3.6 129 Vehicle equipment ............................ Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle Driving ............................................... Manual transmission ........................ Automatic transmission ................... Refueling ............................................ Parking ............................................... Driving tips ........................................ Driving systems ................................ 130 130 130 137 138 145 148 150 156 Driving and parking BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 130 Driving Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard Driving and parking 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 130 Version: 3.0.3.6 and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle Additional breaking-in notes for AMG vehicles: RFor the first 1000 miles (1500 km), do not exceed a speed of 85 mph (140 km/h). ROnly allow the engine to briefly reach a maximum engine speed of 4500 rpm. RShift gears in good time. i Also observe these breaking-in notes when the vehicle's engine or axle gear have been replaced. i Always observe the respective limit speeds. The first 1000 miles (1500 km) The more you look after the engine when it is new, the happier you will be with its performance in the future. RDrive at varying vehicle speeds and engine speeds for the first 1000 miles (1500 km) for this reason. RAvoid overstraining the vehicle during this period, e.g. driving at full throttle. RChange gear in good time, at the latest when the tachometer needle is 2/3 of the way to the red area in the tachometer display. Vehicles with automatic transmission: RIdeally, drive program C should be selected for driving the first 1000 miles (1500 km). RDo not manually shift to a lower gear to brake the vehicle. RIf possible, do not depress the accelerator pedal past the point of resistance (kickdown). ROnly select shift ranges 3, 2 or 1 when driving slowly, e.g. in mountainous terrain. After 1000 miles (1500 km) you may gradually bring the vehicle up to full road and engine speeds. AMG vehicles with rear axle locking differential Your vehicle is equipped with a self-locking differential on the rear axle. Change the oil after a breaking-in period of 2000 miles(3000 km) to improve protection of the rear axle differential. This oil change extends the service life of the differential. Have the oil change carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this purpose. Driving Important safety notes G Warning Make sure absolutely no objects are obstructing the pedals' range of movement. Keep the driver's footwell clear of all obstacles. If there are any floormats or carpets in the footwell, make sure the pedals still have sufficient clearance. During sudden driving or braking maneuvers the objects could get caught between the pedals. You could then no longer brake or accelerate. This could lead to accidents and injury. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 131 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving G Warning On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in order to obtain braking action. This could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle's ABS will not prevent this type of loss of control. SmartKey positions SmartKey G Warning Manual transmission: Wait until the vehicle is stationary before removing the SmartKey from the starter switch. The vehicle cannot be steered when the SmartKey is removed from the starter switch. G Warning It is dangerous to shift the automatic transmission out of parking position P or neutral position N if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If your foot is not firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit someone or something. Only shift into gear when the engine is idling normally and when your right foot is firmly on the brake pedal. ! Warm up the engine quickly. Do not use the engine's full performance until it has reached operating temperature. Only shift the automatic transmission to the desired drive position when the vehicle is stationary. Where possible, avoid spinning the drive wheels when pulling away on slippery roads. You could otherwise damage the drive train. ! AMG vehicles: at low engine oil temperatures (below 68 ‡ (+20 †), the maximum engine speed is restricted in order to protect the engine. To protect the engine and maintain smooth engine operation, avoid driving at full throttle when the engine is cold. 131 g To remove the SmartKey Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission to position P. 1 Power supply for some consumers, such as the windshield wipers 2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers) and drive position 3 To start the engine Once the ignition is switched on, all the indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light up. The indicator lamps of the low-beam headlamps, high-beam headlamps, turn signal lamps or front fog lamps only light up if the low-beam headlamps, high-beam headlamps, turn signal lamps or front fog lamps are switched on. If an indicator lamp does not light up when the ignition is switched on, check it and replace it if necessary. If an indicator lamp does not go out after starting the engine or lights up while the vehicle is in motion, see (Y page 203). If the SmartKey is in position 0 in the ignition lock for an extended period of time, it can no longer be turned in the ignition lock. The steering is then locked. To unlock, remove the SmartKey and reinsert it in the ignition lock. The steering is locked when you remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. X Remove the SmartKey when the engine is switched off. The battery may otherwise discharge. Z Driving and parking BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Driving and parking 132 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 132 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving If you cannot turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock, the vehicle battery may not be charged sufficiently. X Check the vehicle battery and charge if necessary (Y page 261). or X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 262). i The SmartKey can be turned in the ignition lock even if it is not the correct SmartKey for the vehicle. The ignition is not switched on. The engine cannot be started. KEYLESS-GO Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO are equipped with a SmartKey with an integrated KEYLESS-GO function and a detachable Start/Stop button. The Start/Stop button must be inserted in the ignition lock and the SmartKey must be in the vehicle. Pressing the Start/Stop button several times in succession corresponds to the different key positions in the ignition lock. This is only the case if you are not depressing the brake pedal. If you depress the brake pedal and press the Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately. The Start/Stop button can be removed from the ignition lock. Then you can insert the SmartKey in the ignition lock. : Start/Stop button ; Ignition lock X Insert Start/Stop button : into ignition lock ;. i When you insert Start/Stop button : into ignition lock ;, the system requires a detection time of two seconds before you can use Start/Stop button :. X Vehicles with manual transmission: shift to neutral. or X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission to position N. X Do not press the brake pedal. i You do not have to remove the Start/Stop button from the ignition lock when you leave the vehicle. However, you should always take the SmartKey with you when leaving the vehicle. The vehicle can be started with the Start/Stop button and the electrical equipment can be operated while the SmartKey is in the vehicle. Start/Stop button = USA only ? Canada only BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 133 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving Position 0: if Start/Stop button : has not yet been pressed, this corresponds to the SmartKey being removed from the ignition. X Position 1: press Start/Stop button :. You can now activate the windshield wipers, for example. i If you then open the driver's door when in this position, the power supply is deactivated. X Position 2 (ignition): press Start/Stop button : twice. i If you press Start/Stop button : once when in this position and the driver's door is open, the power supply is deactivated again. As soon as the ignition is switched on, all the indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light up. The indicator lamps of the low-beam headlamps, high-beam headlamps, turn signal lamps or front fog lamps only light up if the low-beam headlamps, high-beam headlamps, turn signal lamps or front fog lamps are switched on. If an indicator lamp does not light up when the ignition is switched on, check it and replace it if necessary. If an indicator lamp does not go out after the engine is started or if it lights up while the vehicle is in motion, see (Y page 203). Starting the engine Important safety notes G Warning Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and possible death. Do not run the engine in confined areas (such as a garage) which are not properly ventilated. If you think that exhaust gas fumes are entering the vehicle while driving, have the cause determined and corrected immediately. If you must drive under these conditions, drive only with at least one window fully open at all times. ! Do not depress the accelerator pedal when starting the engine. Manual transmission X Depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed. X Fully depress the clutch pedal. X Shift to neutral N. i You can only start the engine when the clutch pedal is fully depressed. Automatic transmission X Shift the transmission to position P. i The transmission position display in the multifunction display shows P. Starting procedure with the SmartKey X Turn the SmartKey to position 3 in the ignition lock (Y page 131) and release it as soon as the engine is running. Using KEYLESS-GO to start the engine G Warning! As long as the SmartKey is in your vehicle, the vehicle can be started. Therefore, never leave children unattended in the vehicle, as they could otherwise accidentally start the engine. When leaving the vehicle, always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. i The Start/Stop button can be used to start the vehicle without inserting the SmartKey in the ignition lock. The SmartKey must be in the vehicle. Z Driving and parking X 133 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Driving 134 X The Start/Stop button must be inserted in the ignition lock. i To start the engine with the SmartKey Driving and parking 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 134 Version: 3.0.3.6 instead of with KEYLESS-GO, remove the Start/Stop button from the ignition lock. X Depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed. X Press the Start/Stop button once (Y page 132). The engine starts. Pulling away Automatic transmission G Warning It is dangerous to shift the automatic transmission out of parking position P or neutral position N if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If your foot is not firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit someone or something. Only shift into gear when the engine is idling normally and when your right foot is firmly on the brake pedal. i It is only possible to shift the transmission from position P to the desired position if you depress the brake pedal. Only then is the selector lever lock released. Manual transmission X Depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed. X Fully depress the clutch pedal. X Shift to either 1st gear or reverse gear R. X Release the parking brake (Y page 149). X Release the brake pedal. X Slowly release the clutch pedal and gently depress the accelerator pedal. ! If a warning signal sounds and the Release the parking brake message appears in the instrument cluster, the parking brake is still applied. Release the parking brake. ! Change gear in good time and avoid spinning the wheels. You could otherwise damage the vehicle. i The vehicle locks centrally once you have pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors drop down. You can open the doors from the inside at any time. You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 181). X Depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed. X Shift the transmission to position D or R. X Wait until the gear change is completed before pulling away. X Release the parking brake (Y page 149). X Release the brake pedal. X Carefully depress the accelerator pedal. ! If a warning tone sounds and the Release Park. Brake message appears in the instrument cluster, the parking brake is still applied. Release the parking brake. i The vehicle locks centrally once you have pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors drop down. You can open the doors from the inside at any time. You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 181). i Upshifts take place at higher engine speeds after a cold start. This helps the catalytic converter to reach its operating temperature more quickly. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 135 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving 135 Hill start assist Driving and parking Hill start assist helps you when pulling away forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient. It holds the vehicle for a short time after you have removed your foot from the brake pedal. This gives you enough time to move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal and depress it before the vehicle begins to roll. G Warning Never leave the vehicle when it is held by hill start assist. After approximately one second, hill start assist will no longer brake your vehicle and it could roll away. X Take your foot off the brake pedal. i Once you have taken your foot off the brake pedal, the vehicle is held for around one second. X Pull away. Hill start assist will not function if: Ryou are pulling away on a level road or a downhill gradient. Ron vehicles with automatic transmission, the transmission is in position N. Rthe parking brake is applied. RESP® is malfunctioning. Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 136 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 136 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving Driving and parking Problems with the engine Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions The engine does not start. The starter motor can be heard. RThere is a malfunction in the engine electronics. is a malfunction in the fuel supply. X Turn the SmartKey back to position 0 in the ignition lock before the next attempt to start with the SmartKey. X Before the next starting attempt with KEYLESS-GO: shut all open vehicle doors so that the signals from the SmartKey may be better received. or X Pull the Start/Stop button out of the ignition. X Use the SmartKey to start the engine, (Y page 133) as external radio signals cause KEYLESS-GO to malfunction. Avoid excessively long and frequent attempts to start the engine as these will drain the battery. RThere If the engine does not start after several attempts: X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. The engine does not start. You cannot hear the starter motor. The on-board voltage is too low because the starter battery is too weak or discharged. X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 262). If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it: X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. The starter motor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high. X Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two minutes. X Try to start the engine again. If the engine still does not start: X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 137 Version: 3.0.3.6 Manual transmission Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions The engine is not running smoothly and is misfiring. There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or a mechanical component of the engine management system. X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly. X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist workshop. Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter and damage it. The coolant temperature gauge shows a value above 248 ‡(120 †). The coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled sufficiently. X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant to cool down. X Check the coolant level (Y page 240). Observe the warning notes as you do so and add coolant if necessary. Manual transmission ! When shifting between 5th and 6th gear, you should always push the gear lever all the way to the right. You could otherwise shift unintentionally into 3rd or 4th gear and damage the transmission. If you shift down at too high a speed (transmission braking), this can cause the engine to overrev, leading to engine damage. Never hold the vehicle stopped on a hill by using the clutch pedal. There is otherwise a risk of damaging the clutch. Important safety notes G Warning When working on the vehicle, engage the parking brake and shift the manual transmission into the 1st gear or reverse R. The vehicle could otherwise roll away, which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. Gear lever Engaging reverse gear ! Only shift into reverse gear R when the vehicle is stationary as you can otherwise damage the transmission. X Stop the vehicle. Depress the clutch pedal fully. X Shift to neutral. X Move the gear lever firmly to the left beyond the point of resistance and then forwards. X Gear lever k Reverse 1 to 6 Forward gears Z 137 Driving and parking BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Automatic transmission 138 Shift recommendation Driving and parking 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 138 Version: 3.0.3.6 The gearshift recommendations assist you in adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction display. Otherwise the vehicle could roll away which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. Selector lever Overview of transmission positions X Shift gear according to the gearshift recommendation : shown in the multifunction display of the instrument cluster. Automatic transmission Important safety notes G Warning Selector lever P Park position with selector lever lock R Reverse N Neutral D Drive Transmission position display It is dangerous to shift the automatic transmission out of parking position P or neutral position N if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. If your foot is not firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit someone or something. Only shift into gear when the engine is idling normally and when your right foot is firmly on the brake pedal. G Warning! Keep in mind that turning off the engine alone only will shift the automatic transmission into neutral position N automatically. Always shift the automatic transmission into park position P before turning off the engine. : Transmission position display Displays on the cover beside the selector lever also indicate the current position of the selector lever. The displays light up when the SmartKey is inserted in the ignition lock. The displays go out when the SmartKey is removed from the ignition lock. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 139 Version: 3.0.3.6 Automatic transmission Drive program display A : Drive program display ! Driving in neutral N can Transmission positions B C Park position Do not shift the transmission into position P unless the vehicle is stationary. The parking lock should not be used as a brake when parking. In addition to engaging the parking lock, you must always apply the parking brake to secure the vehicle. The SmartKey can only be removed if the transmission is in position P. If the SmartKey is removed from the ignition lock, the selector lever is locked. In the event of a fault in the vehicle electronics, the selector lever can be locked in position P. To release the selector lever lock, see "Releasing the parking lock manually" (Y page 144). Reverse Only shift the transmission to R when the vehicle is stationary. Neutral Do not shift the transmission to N while driving. The transmission could otherwise be damaged. No power is transmitted from the engine to the drive wheels. Releasing the brakes will allow you to move the vehicle freely, e.g. to push it or tow it. If ESP® is deactivated or faulty: only shift the transmission to position N if the vehicle is in danger of skidding, e.g. on icy roads. damage the drive train. 7 Drive The automatic transmission changes gear automatically. All forward gears are available. Gearshifting The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. This automatic gearshifting behavior is determined by: Ra shift range restriction, if selected selected drive program E/S or M (vehicles with the dynamic handling package and AMG vehicles) (Y page 140) Rthe position of the accelerator pedal Rthe road speed Rthe Driving tips AMG vehicles When shifting down, the double-clutch function is active regardless of the currently selected drive program. The double-clutch function reduces load change reactions and is conducive to a sporty driving style. The Z 139 Driving and parking BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 140 Version: 3.0.3.6 Automatic transmission 140 Driving and parking sound generated by the double-clutch function depends on the drive program selected. Kickdown Use kickdown for maximum acceleration. X Vehicles for USA except AMG vehicles: fully depress the accelerator pedal. The transmission shifts to a lower gear depending on the engine speed. X Vehicles for Canada except AMG vehicles: depress the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point. The transmission shifts to a lower gear depending on the engine speed. Program selector button on AMG vehicles Working on the vehicle G Warning When working on the vehicle, engage the parking brake and shift the automatic transmission into park position P. Otherwise the vehicle could roll away which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. Program selector button Program selector button on vehicles with the dynamic handling package E Economy Comfortable, economical driving S Sport Sporty driving style M Manual Manual gearshifting i For further information on "Automatic drive program" (Y page 141). Program selector button Only change from automatic drive program E or S to manual drive program M when the vehicle is stationary. X Press program selector button : repeatedly until the letter for the desired gearshift program appears in the multifunction display. i The automatic transmission switches to automatic drive program E each time the engine is started. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 141 Version: 3.0.3.6 Automatic transmission Steering wheel paddle shifters 141 Shift ranges When the automatic transmission is in position D, it is possible to restrict or derestrict the shift range (Y page 141). The shift range selected is shown in the multifunction display. The automatic transmission shifts only as far as the selected gear. Driving situations : Left-hand steering wheel paddle shifter = You can use the engine's braking effect. In the automatic drive program, you can restrict or derestrict the shift range by using the steering wheel paddle shifters (Y page 141). In the manual drive program, you can change gear using the steering wheel paddle shifters or the selector lever (Y page 141). 5 To use the braking effect of the engine on downhill gradients and for driving: i You can only change gear with the 4 ; Right-hand steering wheel paddle shifter Ron steep mountain roads mountainous terrain Rin arduous conditions Rin steering wheel paddle shifters when the transmission is in position D. Automatic drive program Drive program E is characterized by the following: Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in forward and reverse gears, unless the accelerator pedal is depressed fully Rincreased sensitivity, which improves driving stability on slippery road surfaces, for example Rthe automatic transmission shifting up sooner, which results in the vehicle being driven at lower engine speeds and the wheels being less likely to spin In drive program S, the automatic transmission shifts up later. To use the braking effect of the engine on extremely steep downhill gradients and on long downhill stretches Restricting the shift range X Press the selector lever to the left towards D–. or X Pull the left-hand steering wheel paddle shifter. The shift range is restricted. i In order to prevent the engine from overrevving, the automatic transmission does not shift down when the engine speed is too high. i If the maximum engine speed for the shift range is reached and you continue to accelerate, the automatic transmission shifts up in order to prevent the engine from overrevving, even if the shift range is restricted. Z Driving and parking Introduction BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Automatic transmission 142 Derestricting the shift range X Driving and parking 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 142 Version: 3.0.3.6 Briefly press the selector lever to the right towards D+. or X Pull the right-hand steering wheel paddle shifter. The shift range is derestricted. Clearing the shift range restriction X Press and hold the selector lever towards D+ until D is shown once more in the multifunction display. Manual drive program M can be selected using the program selector button. You can change gears using the steering wheel paddle shifters or the selector lever in manual drive program M if the transmission is in position D. The gear selected is shown in the multifunction display. X Press program selector button (Y page 140) repeatedly until M appears in the multifunction display. Upshifting i Vehicles with the dynamic handling package: if the maximum engine speed for the shift range is reached and you continue to accelerate, the automatic transmission shifts up, except when manual program M is selected. or X Pull and hold the right-hand steering wheel paddle shifter until D is shown again in the multifunction display. The automatic transmission shifts from the current shift range directly to D. Selecting the ideal shift range Vehicles with AMG engines X Briefly press the selector lever to the right towards D+. X or Press the selector lever to the left towards D– and hold it in position. or X Pull the left-hand steering wheel paddle shifter and hold it in position. The automatic transmission shifts to the gear which allows ideal acceleration and deceleration. To do this, the automatic transmission shifts down one or more gears. X Pull the right-hand steering wheel paddle shifter (Y page 141). The automatic transmission shifts up to the next gear. AMG vehicles: before the engine speed reaches the red area, you will see an upshift indicator in the multifunction display. Manual drive program Switching on the manual drive program The manual drive program is only available for vehicles with the dynamic handling package and for AMG vehicles. Manual drive program M is different from drive program S with regard to spontaneity, responsiveness and smoothness of gear changes. : Gear indicator ; Upshift indicator 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 143 Version: 3.0.3.6 Automatic transmission Downshifting Switching off the manual drive program X X Briefly press the selector lever to the left towards D–. or X Pull the left-hand steering wheel paddle shifter (Y page 141). The automatic transmission shifts down to the next gear. AMG vehicles: press the program selector button (Y page 140) repeatedly until E or S appears in the multifunction display. X Vehicles with the dynamic handling package: press the program selector button (Y page 140). M is no longer shown in the multifunction display. i If you brake the vehicle or stop without shifting down, the automatic transmission will shift down to a gear that will allow the vehicle to accelerate or pull away again. i Vehicles with the dynamic handling package: to avoid overrevving the engine when downshifting, the automatic transmission does not shift to a lower gear if this would result in the maximum engine speed being exceeded. i If you desire maximum acceleration, push the selector lever to the left or pull and hold the left-hand steering wheel paddle shifter until the transmission shifts to the optimal gear for the current speed. Kickdown i Vehicles with an AMG engine: it is not possible to use kickdown in manual drive program M. You can also use kickdown for maximum acceleration in manual drive program M. X Vehicles for USA: fully depress the accelerator pedal. The automatic transmission shifts to a lower gear depending on the engine speed. X Vehicles for Canada: depress the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point. The automatic transmission shifts to a lower gear depending on the engine speed. i During kickdown, you cannot change gear using the steering wheel paddle shifters or the selector lever. Z 143 Driving and parking BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 144 Version: 3.0.3.6 Automatic transmission 144 Problems with the transmission Driving and parking Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions The acceleration ability The transmission is in emergency mode. is deteriorating. It is only possible to shift into 2nd gear and reverse gear. The transmission no X Stop the vehicle. longer changes gear. X Shift the transmission to position P. X Switch off the engine. X Wait at least 10 seconds before restarting the engine. X Shift the transmission to position D or R. If D is selected, the transmission shifts into 2nd gear; if R is selected, the transmission shifts into reverse gear. X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately. Releasing the parking lock manually In the event of an electrical malfunction, it is possible to release the selector lever lock manually to move it out of position P, e.g. if you wish to tow the vehicle away. cloth) from the right-hand edge, pulling it up and out. X Press release button ; down and simultaneously move the selector lever out of position P. The selector lever can now be moved freely until it is returned to position P. Transfer case This section is only valid for vehicles with 4wheel drive (4MATIC). Power is always transmitted to both axles. ! Performance tests may only be carried ! Do not use any sharp-edged objects to remove the selector lever cover in the center console. This can damage the selector lever cover. X X Depress the parking brake firmly. Pry out selector lever gaiter : with a flat, blunt object (e.g. a screwdriver wrapped in out on a 2-axle dynamometer. The brake system or transfer case could otherwise be damaged. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for a performance test. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this purpose. ! If the parking brake is being tested on a brake dynamometer, the ignition must be switched off (SmartKey or Start/Stop button in position 0 or 1), as ESP® will otherwise automatically intervene. The brake system could otherwise be damaged. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 145 Version: 3.0.3.6 Refueling Refueling Important safety notes G Warning Gasoline is highly flammable and poisonous. It burns violently and can cause serious personal injury. Never allow sparks, flames or smoking materials near gasoline. Turn off the engine before refueling. Whenever you are around gasoline, avoid inhaling fumes and any skin or clothing contact. Direct skin contact with fuels and the inhalation of fuel vapors are damaging to your health. ! Do not switch on the ignition if you accidentally refuel with the wrong fuel. Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel lines. Notify a qualified specialist workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel lines drained completely. gasoline Fuel grade ! You should only refuel with unleaded G Warning premium-grade gasoline as this avoids damaging the catalytic converter. Flexible fuel vehicles (recognizable by the sticker Premium gasoline or E85 only! on the inside of the fuel filler flap) can be refueled with E85. For further information on flexible fuel, see "Fuel". If engine running problems are apparent, have the cause checked immediately and repaired. Excess unburned fuel can otherwise enter the catalytic converter, leading to overheating and possibly causing a fire. G Warning! i Only refuel with unleaded premium-grade Overfilling of the fuel tank may create pressure in the system which could cause a gas discharge. This could cause the gasoline to spray back out when removing the fuel pump nozzle, which could cause personal injury. C 300 and C 300 Sport with automatic transmission: Flexible Fuel Vehicles (identified by a label reading Premium gasoline or E85 only! on the fuel filler flap): Ethanol fuel (E85) and its fumes are highly flammable, poisonous and burn easily. Ethanol fuel can cause serious injuries if ignited or if you come into contact with it or inhale fumes of it. Avoid inhalation of ethanol fumes and skin contact with ethanol. Extinguish all open flames before refueling. Never smoke or create sparks close to ethanol. ! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a gasoline engine. Even small amounts of the wrong fuel result in damage to the fuel system and engine. 145 gasoline with a specified minimum octane number of 91 (average value of 96 RON/ 86 MON). Usually you will find information about the fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the label on the gasoline pump, ask the gas station staff. C 300 and C 300 Sport with automatic transmission: you can recognize flexible fuel vehicles by the sticker Premium gasoline or E85 only! on the inside of the fuel filler flap. You can find further information under "Fuel" (Y page 306), by consulting an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or visiting http://www.mbusa.com (USA only). Z Driving and parking BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Refueling 146 Refueling Fuel filler flap Driving and parking 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 146 Version: 3.0.3.6 The fuel filler flap is unlocked or locked automatically when you open or close the vehicle with the SmartKey or using KEYLESSGO. The position of the fuel filler flap is to the rear on the right. The position of the fuel filler cap is displayed in the instrument cluster 8. The arrow next to the gas pump indicates the side of the vehicle. removed. The driver's door can be closed again. X Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of arrow :. The fuel filler flap opens slightly. X Open the fuel filler flap. X Turn the fuel filler cap counter-clockwise and remove it. X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder bracket on the inside of filler flap ;. X Completely insert the filler neck of the fuel pump nozzle into the tank and refuel. X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle switches off. ! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the fuel system. Closing X : To open the fuel filler flap ; To insert the fuel filler cap = Tire pressure table ? Fuel type Replace the fuel filler cap and turn it clockwise. The fuel filler cap audibly engages. i Close the fuel filler flap before locking the vehicle. A locking pin otherwise prevents the fuel filler flap from closing after the vehicle has been locked. X Close the fuel filler flap. Opening X Switch off the engine. i When the engine is running and the fuel filler flap is open, the ; engine diagnostics warning lamp may light up. For further information on warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster, see (Y page 210). X Remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. KEYLESS-GO: the driver's door is open. This returns the ignition to position 0, which corresponds to the SmartKey being Emergency fuel filler flap release G Warning! Avoid contact with the vehicle walls as they may contain sharp edges. Otherwise, you could injure yourself while releasing the fuel filler flap. The emergency release is located behind the side trim panel in the trunk. X Open the trunk lid. X Open the right-hand side trim panel (Y page 268). BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 147 Version: 3.0.3.6 147 Driving and parking Refueling X Pull emergency release : in the direction of the arrow. The fuel filler flap is unlocked. X Open the fuel filler flap. Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 148 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 148 Version: 3.0.3.6 Parking Problems with the fuel and fuel tank Driving and parking Problem Fuel is leaking from the vehicle. The fuel filler flap cannot be opened. Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of explosion or fire The fuel line or the fuel tank is defective. X Turn the key to position 0(Y page 131) in the ignition lock immediately and remove it. X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. The fuel filler flap is not unlocked. or The key batteries are discharged. X Unlock the vehicle using the mechanical key (Y page 73). X Open the trunk lid. X Manually unlock the fuel filler flap using the emergency release (Y page 146). The fuel filler flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is jammed. X Manually unlock the fuel filler flap using the emergency release (Y page 146). X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. Parking Important safety notes G Warning Do not park this vehicle in areas where combustible materials such as grass, hay or leaves can come into contact with the hot exhaust system. These materials could be ignited and cause a vehicle fire. Vehicle movement can cause serious personal injury or damage to the vehicle or the vehicle drivetrain. Therefore, always do the following before turning off the engine and leaving the vehicle: RKeep right foot on the brake pedal. the parking brake. REngage RManual transmission: Shift the manual transmission into 1st gear or reverse gear R. RAutomatic transmission: Shift the automatic transmission into park position P. RSlowly release the brake pedal. RWhen parked on an incline, always turn the front wheels towards the road curb. RTurn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to position 0 and remove it from the ignition lock or press the KEYLESS-GO Start/Stop button. RTake the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle when leaving. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 149 Version: 3.0.3.6 Parking G Warning Switching off the engine button moves to position 0. This corresponds to removing the SmartKey. If you attempt to turn off the engine when the selector lever is not in position P, a warning signal sounds. Observe the messages in the multifunction display. i In an emergency, you can turn off the engine while the vehicle is in motion by pressing and holding the Start/Stop button for three seconds. Important safety notes G Warning Do not turn off the engine before the vehicle has come to a complete stop. With the engine not running, there is no power assistance for the brake and steering systems. In this case, it is important to keep in mind that a considerably higher degree of effort is necessary to brake and steer the vehicle. If you have started the engine with the Start/ Stop button and it cannot be switched off as described: X remove the Start/Stop button from the ignition lock. X insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock. The engine stops. The ignition lock is in position 0. Vehicles with manual transmission X Shift to either first gear or reverse gear R. Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock and remove it. The immobilizer is activated. X Apply the parking brake firmly. X Vehicles with automatic transmission X X Apply the parking brake firmly. Shift the transmission to position P. Using the SmartKey X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock and remove it. The immobilizer is activated. i The SmartKey can only be removed if the transmission is in position P. Using KEYLESS-GO X Press the Start/Stop button (Y page 132). When the driver's door is closed, the Start/ Stop button is in position 1. When the driver's door is opened, the Start/Stop Parking brake G Warning Engaging the parking brake while the vehicle is in motion can cause the rear wheels to lock up. You could lose control of the vehicle and cause an accident. In addition, the vehicle's brake lights do not light up when the parking brake is engaged. G Warning When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could release the parking brake and/or shift the automatic transmission out of park position P (manual transmission: shift into the neutral position), either of which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. Z Driving and parking Manual transmission: Wait until the vehicle is stationary before removing the SmartKey from the starter switch. The vehicle cannot be steered when the SmartKey is removed from the starter switch. 149 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 150 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving tips 150 Driving tips General driving tips Driving and parking Important safety notes G Warning X To apply: depress parking brake ; firmly. When the engine is running, the $ (USA only) or J (Canada only) indicator lamp lights up in the instrument cluster. X To release: depress the brake pedal and keep it depressed. X Pull release handle :. When the ignition is switched on or the engine is running, the $ (USA only) or J (Canada only) indicator lamp goes out in the instrument cluster. Parking up the vehicle If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer than four weeks, the battery may be damaged by exhaustive discharge. X Disconnect the battery or connect it to a trickle charger. i You can obtain information about trickle chargers from a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized MercedesBenz Center. If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer than six weeks, the vehicle may suffer damage as a result of lack of use. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop and seek advice. 18 Observe all legal requirements. Please do not forget that your primary responsibility is to drive the vehicle. A driver's attention to the road must always be his/her primary focus when driving. For your safety and the safety of others, we recommend that you pull over to a safe location and stop before placing or taking a telephone call. If you use the telephone18 while driving, please use the hands-free device and only use the telephone when road, weather and traffic conditions permit. Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from using a mobile telephone while driving a vehicle. Only operate the audio system or COMAND18 (Cockpit Management and Data System) if road, weather and traffic conditions permit. Otherwise, you may not be able to observe traffic conditions and could endanger yourself and others. Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second. Drive sensibly – save fuel To save fuel, observe the following notes: X Keep tires at the recommended inflation pressures. X Remove unnecessary cargo. X Remove the roof rack when not in use. X Maintain a low engine speed until the engine is warm. X Avoid frequent acceleration and deceleration. X Have all maintenance work performed at the service intervals specified in the Service Booklet or indicated by the service interval indicator. Fuel consumption is also increased by driving in cold weather, in stop-and-go traffic, on short trips and in mountainous areas. Drinking and driving G Warning Drinking and driving and/or taking drugs and driving are very dangerous combinations. Even a small amount of alcohol or drugs can affect your reflexes, perceptions and judgment. The possibility of a serious or even fatal accident are greatly increased when you drink or take drugs and drive. Do not drink or take drugs and drive or allow anyone to drive who has been drinking or taking drugs. Pedals G Warning Make sure absolutely no objects are obstructing the pedals' range of movement. Keep the driver's footwell clear of all obstacles. If there are any floormats or carpets in the footwell, make sure that the pedals still have sufficient clearance. During sudden driving or braking maneuvers, the objects could get caught between the pedals. You could then no longer brake or accelerate. This could lead to accidents and injury. Coasting with the engine switched off G Warning! There is no power assistance for the steering and the brake when the engine is not running. Steering and braking requires significantly more effort and you could lose control of the vehicle and cause an accident as a result. Do not turn off the engine while the vehicle is in motion. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 151 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving tips 151 Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and possible death. Do not run the engine in confined areas (such as a garage) which are not properly ventilated. If you think that exhaust gas fumes are entering the vehicle while driving, have the cause determined and corrected immediately. If you must drive under these conditions, drive only with at least one window fully open at all times. Driving and parking BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Exhaust check G Warning Certain engine systems are designed to keep the level of poisonous components in exhaust fumes within legal limits. These systems only work optimally if they are maintained exactly in accordance with the manufacturer's specifications. For this reason, all work on the engine must be carried out by qualified and authorized MercedesBenz technicians. The engine settings must not be changed in any circumstances. Furthermore, all specific service work must be carried out at regular intervals and in accordance with the Mercedes-Benz service requirements. Details can be found in the Service Booklet. Brakes Important safety notes G Warning On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in order to obtain braking action. This could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle's ABS will not prevent this type of loss of control. G Warning Make sure that you do not endanger other road users when you apply the brakes. Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 152 Driving tips Downhill gradients ! On long and steep gradients, you must Driving and parking 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 152 Version: 3.0.3.6 reduce the cargo on the brakes by shifting to a lower gear in good time. This allows you to take advantage of engine braking and helps you to avoid overheating the brakes and wearing them out excessively. When you take advantage of engine braking, a drive wheel may not turn for some time, e.g. on a slippery road surface. This could cause damage to the drive train. Such damage is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz warranty. Heavy and light loads G Warning Depressing the brake pedal constantly results in excessive and premature wear to the brake pads. It may also cause the brakes to overheat, seriously impairing their effectiveness. It may then not be possible to stop the vehicle in sufficient time to avoid an accident. If the brakes have been subjected to a heavy cargo, do not stop the vehicle immediately, but drive on for a short while. This allows the airflow to cool the brakes more quickly. Wet roads G Warning After driving in heavy rain for some time without applying the brakes or through water deep enough to wet brake components, the first braking action may be somewhat reduced. You have to depress the brake pedal more firmly. Maintain a safe distance from vehicles in front. After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying attention to the traffic conditions. This will warm up the brake discs, thereby drying them more quickly and protecting them against corrosion. Limited braking performance on salt treated roads G Warning The layer of salt on the brake discs and the brake pads/linings may cause a delay in the braking effect, resulting in a significantly longer braking distance, which could lead to an accident. To avoid this danger, you should: Roccasionally brake carefully, without putting other road users at risk, when you are driving on salted roads. This helps to remove any salt that may have started to build up on the brake discs and the brake pads/linings. Rmaintain a greater distance to the vehicle ahead and drive with particular care. Rcarefully apply the brakes at the end of a trip and immediately after commencing a new trip, so that salt residues are removed from the brake discs. Maintenance of the brakes ! If the red brake warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster and you hear a warning tone while the engine is running, the brake fluid level may be too low. Observe additional warning messages in the multifunction display. The brake fluid level may be too low due to brake pad wear or leaking brake lines. Have the brake system checked immediately. This work should be carried out at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. All checks and maintenance work on the brake system must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. This work should be carried out at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Only install brake pads and use brake fluid recommended by Mercedes-Benz. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 153 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving tips G Warning If other than recommended brake pads are installed, or other than recommended brake fluid is used, the braking properties of the vehicle can be degraded to an extent that safe braking is substantially impaired. This could result in an accident. ! Vehicles with 4MATIC: a function or performance test may only be carried out on a two-axle dynamometer. If you are planning to have the vehicle tested on such a dynamometer, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center to obtain further information first. Otherwise, the drive train or the brake system may suffer damage. ! Vehicles with 4MATIC: as the ESP® system operates automatically, the engine and the ignition must be switched off (SmartKey in position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock or Start/Stop button in position 0 or 1) while the parking brake is being tested on a brake dynamometer. Braking maneuvers triggered automatically by ESP® may seriously damage the brake system. ! Vehicles with 4MATIC: as the ESP® G Warning Make sure that you do not endanger other road users when you apply the brakes. You can find a description of Brake Assist (BAS) on (Y page 62). High-performance brake system for AMG vehicles The high-performance brake system is only installed on the C 63 AMG. G Warning New vehicle brake pads and discs, and replacement brake pads and discs may take several hundred miles of driving until they provide optimum braking efficiency. Until that time, you may need to use increased brake pedal pressure while braking. Please be aware of this and adjust your driving and braking accordingly during this break-in period. Excessive high-demand braking will cause correspondingly high brake wear. Please be attentive to the brake warning lamp in the instrument cluster and brake condition messages in the multifunction display. Especially for high performance driving, it is important to maintain and have the brake system checked regularly. system operates automatically, the engine and the ignition system must be switched off (SmartKey in position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock or Start/Stop button in position 0 or 1) when: The high-performance brake system is designed for heavy loads. This may lead to noise when braking. This will depend on: Rtesting Rspeed the parking brake on a brake dynamometer. Ryou intend to have the vehicle towed with the front axle raised. Braking maneuvers triggered automatically by ESP® may seriously damage the brake system. If your brake system is only subjected to moderate loads, you should regularly test your brake system's function by forcefully depressing the brake pedal when driving at high speed. This will give the brake pads better grip. 153 Rbraking force Renvironmental conditions, such as temperature and humidity The wear of individual components of the brake system, such as the brake pads/linings or brake discs, depends on the individual driving style and operating conditions. Z Driving and parking BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 154 Driving tips Driving on wet roads Hydroplaning Driving and parking 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 154 Version: 3.0.3.6 If water has accumulated to a certain depth on the road surface, there is a danger of hydroplaning occurring, even if: Ryou drive at low speeds tires have adequate tread depth For this reason, in the event of heavy rain or in conditions in which hydroplaning can occur you must drive in the following manner: Rthe RLower your speed ruts RBrake carefully RAvoid Driving on flooded roads ! Do not drive through flooded areas. Check the depth of any water before driving through it. Drive slowly through standing water. Otherwise, water may enter the vehicle interior or the engine compartment. This can damage the electronic components in the engine or the automatic transmission. Water can also be drawn in by the engine's air suction nozzles and this can cause engine damage. Winter driving General information Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, at the onset of winter. Observe the notes in the "Winter operation" section (Y page 155). Winter tires At temperatures below 45 ‡(+7 †), use winter tires or all-season tires. Both types of tire are identified by the M+S marking. Only winter tires also bearing the i snowflake symbol next to the M+S marking provide the best possible grip in wintry road conditions. Only these tires will allow driving safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to function optimally in winter, as these tires have been designed specifically for driving on snow. Use M+S tires of the same make and tread on all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics. G Warning M+S tires with a tread depth of less than 1/6 inch (4 mm) must be replaced. They are no longer suitable for winter operation. Always observe the maximum permissible speed specified for the M+S tires you have mounted. Once you have installed the winter tires: X Check the tire pressures (Y page 275). X Restart the tire pressure monitor (Y page 277). G Warning If you use your spare wheel when M+S tires are fitted on the other wheels, be aware that the difference in tire characteristics may very well impair turning stability and that overall driving stability may be reduced. Adapt your driving style accordingly. Have the spare wheel replaced by a regular road wheel with an M+S tire at the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Snow chains For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains which have been specially approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz, or are of a corresponding standard of quality. ! There is not enough space for snow chains on some wheel sizes. Observe the information under "Tires and wheels" in the "Technical Data" section to avoid damage to the vehicle or the wheels. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 155 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving tips ROnly use snow chains when driving on an area completely covered by snow. Do not exceed the maximum permissible speed of 30 mph (50 km/h). Remove the snow chains as soon as possible when you are no longer driving on snow-covered roads. RLocal regulations may restrict the use of snow chains. Applicable regulations must be observed if you wish to mount snow chains. RSnow chains must not be mounted on emergency spare wheels. If you intend to mount snow chains, please bear the following points in mind: Ryou may not attach snow chains to all wheel-tire combinations; see the "Tires and wheels" section in the "Technical data" chapter. Rmount snow chains only in pairs and only on the rear wheels. Observe the manufacturer's installation instructions. ! If snow chains are mounted on the front wheels, the snow chains could grind against the bodywork or components of the chassis. This could result in damage to the vehicle or the tires. ! Vehicles with steel wheels If you wish to mount snow chains to steel wheels, make sure that you remove the respective wheels' hubcaps first. The hubcaps may otherwise be damaged. i You may wish to deactivate ESP®(Y page 63) when pulling away with snow chains installed. This way you can allow the wheels to spin in a controlled manner, achieving an increased driving force (cutting action). (CO) gases may enter vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and death. To assure sufficient fresh air ventilation, open a window slightly on the side of the vehicle not facing the wind. G Warning! The outside temperature indicator is not designed to serve as an ice-warning device and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose. Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. The road may still be icy, especially in wooded areas or on bridges. G Warning On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in order to obtain braking action. This could result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle control. Your vehicle's ABS will not prevent this type of loss of control. You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering and braking maneuvers. Do not use cruise control. If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be stopped when moving at low speed: X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage neutral. X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission to position N. i For more information on driving with snow chains, see (Y page 154). G Warning Make sure that you do not endanger other road users when you apply the brakes. Slippery road surfaces G Warning If the vehicle becomes stuck in snow, make sure snow is kept clear of the exhaust pipe and from around the vehicle with the engine running. Otherwise, deadly carbon monoxide Driving abroad An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network is also available in other countries. The Service Hotline's current telephone numbers for use when you are abroad are to be found Z 155 Driving and parking BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 156 Driving systems in the "Service24h" section of the Service Booklet. Driving and parking 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 156 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving systems Cruise control Important safety notes Cruise control maintains a constant road speed for you. It brakes automatically in order to avoid exceeding the set speed. On long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden, you must shift to a lower gear in good time or select shift range 1, 2 or 3 in vehicles with automatic transmission. By doing so, you will make use of the braking effect of the engine, which relieves the load on the brake system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly. Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions make it appropriate to maintain a steady speed for a prolonged period. You can store any road speed above 20 mph (30 km/h). G Warning The cruise control is a convenience system designed to assist the driver during vehicle operation. The driver is and must always remain responsible for the vehicle's speed and for safe brake operation. Only use the cruise control if the road, traffic, and weather conditions make it advisable to travel at a constant speed. RThe use of the cruise control can be dangerous on winding roads or in heavy traffic because conditions do not allow safe driving at a constant speed. RThe use of the cruise control can be dangerous on slippery roads. Rapid changes in tire traction can result in wheel spin and loss of control. RDeactivate the cruise control when driving in fog. The "Resume" function should only be operated if the driver is fully aware of the previously set speed and wishes to resume this particular preset speed. G Warning! The cruise control brakes automatically so that the set speed is not exceeded. Cruise control lever : To store the current speed or a higher speed ; To store the current speed or a lower speed = To deactivate cruise control ? To store the current speed or to call up the last stored speed When you activate cruise control, the stored speed is shown in the multifunction display for five seconds. In the multifunction display, the segments between the stored speed and the maximum speed light up. Storing and maintaining the current speed You can store the current speed if you are driving faster than 20 mph (30 km/h). X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed. X Briefly press the cruise control lever up : or down ; to the pressure point. X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. Cruise control is activated. The vehicle automatically maintains the stored speed. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 157 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving systems the stored speed on uphill gradients. The stored speed is resumed when the gradient evens out. Cruise control maintains the stored speed on downhill gradients by automatically applying the brakes. i Vehicles with manual transmission: RAlways drive at adequate, but not excessive, engine speeds. RChange gear in good time. RIf possible, do not change down several gears at a time. Storing the current speed or calling up the last stored speed G Warning The set speed stored in memory should only be set again if prevailing road conditions and legal speed limits permit. Possible acceleration or deceleration differences arising from returning to the preset speed could cause an accident and/or serious injury to you and others. X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards you ?. X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. The first time cruise control is activated, it stores the current speed or regulates the speed of the vehicle to the previously stored speed. Setting a speed G Warning Keep in mind that it may take a brief moment until the vehicle has made the necessary adjustments. Increase or decrease the set vehicle speed to a value that the prevailing road conditions and legal speed limits permit. Otherwise, sudden and unexpected acceleration or deceleration of the vehicle could cause an accident and/ or serious injury to you and others. X Press the cruise control lever to the pressure point, up : for a higher speed or down ; for a lower speed. X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until the desired speed is reached. X Release the cruise control lever. The new speed is stored. i Cruise control is not deactivated if you depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if you accelerate briefly to overtake, cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking. Setting in 1 mph (Canada: 1 km/h) increments X Briefly press the cruise control lever to the pressure point, up : for a higher speed or down ; for a lower speed. The last speed stored is increased or reduced. Setting in 5 mph (Canada: 10 km/h) increments X Briefly press the cruise control lever beyond the pressure point, up : for a higher speed or down ; for a lower speed. The last speed stored is increased or reduced. Deactivating cruise control There are several ways to deactivate cruise control: X Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards =. or X Brake. Cruise control is automatically deactivated if: Ryou depress the parking brake. are driving below 20 mph (30 km/h). RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®. Ryou Z Driving and parking i Cruise control may be unable to maintain 157 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 158 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 158 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving systems Driving and parking Ryou shift into neutral in a vehicle with manual transmission while driving, or depress the clutch pedal for longer than 6 seconds. Ron vehicles with manual transmission, you shift to a gear that is too high, and as a result the engine speed is too low. Ron vehicles with automatic transmission, you shift into position N while driving. If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear a warning tone. You will see the Cruise control off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds. i The last speed stored is cleared when you switch off the engine. Dynamic handling package with sports mode General notes The most important part of the dynamic handling package with sports mode is the adjustable suspension system. This automatically controls and adapts the suspension to the respective driving situation. The calibration of the suspension depends on: X Start the engine. Sports tuning The firmer setting of the suspension tuning in sports mode ensures even better contact with the road. Select this mode when employing a sporty driving style, e.g. on winding country roads. Your selection remains stored until you switch off the engine. X Press button ;. Indicator lamp : lights up. Sports suspension tuning is selected. Depending on the engine output, the accelerator pedal is more responsive. On vehicles with automatic transmission, drive program S is selected. Ryour Comfort tuning Rthe In comfort mode, the driving characteristics of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select this mode if you prefer a more comfortable driving style, but also when driving fast on straight roads, e.g. highways. X Press button ;. Indicator lamp : goes out. Comfortable suspension tuning is selected. On vehicles with automatic transmission, drive program C is selected. driving style road surface conditions Ryour individual selection; see the following description If your vehicle is equipped with automatic transmission, the dynamic handling package with sports mode also includes steering wheel paddle shifters (Y page 141) with a manual drive program (Y page 142). 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 159 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving systems 4MATIC (permanent four-wheel drive) 4MATIC ensures that all four wheels are permanently driven. Together with ESP®, it improves the traction of your vehicle whenever a drive wheel spins due to insufficient grip. G Warning! If a drive wheel is spinning due to insufficient traction: RWhile driving off, apply as little throttle as possible. RWhile driving, ease up on the accelerator pedal. RAdapt your speed and driving style to the prevailing road conditions. Failure to observe these guidelines could cause the vehicle to skid. The 4MATIC cannot prevent accidents resulting from excessive speed. ! Never tow the vehicle with one axle raised. This may damage the transfer case. Damage of this sort is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. All wheels must remain either on the ground or be fully raised. Observe the instructions for towing the vehicle with all wheels in full contact with the ground. G Warning! Make sure no persons or animals are in or near the area in which you are parking/ maneuvering. Otherwise, they could be injured. PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with ultrasonic sensors. It indicates visually and audibly the distance between your vehicle and an object. PARKTRONIC is activated automatically when you: Rswitch on the ignition. the transmission to position D, R or N on vehicles with automatic transmission. Rrelease the parking brake. PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above 11 mph (18 km/h). It is reactivated at lower speeds. PARKTRONIC monitors the area around your vehicle using six sensors in the front bumper and four sensors in the rear bumper. Rshift i In wintry driving conditions, the maximum effect of 4MATIC can only be achieved if you use winter tires (M+S tires), with snow chains if necessary. : Sensors in the front bumper, left-hand side (example) PARKTRONIC Important safety notes i PARKTRONIC is only available in Canada. G Warning! The PARKTRONIC is a supplemental system. It is not intended to, nor does it replace, the need for extreme care. The responsibility during parking and other critical maneuvers always remains with the driver. 159 Range of the sensors The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and slush; otherwise they may not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking care not to scratch or damage them (Y page 247). Z Driving and parking BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 160 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 160 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving systems Driving and parking Minimum distance Center Approx. 8 in (20 cm) Corners Approx. 6 in (15 cm) If there is an obstacle within this range, all warning displays light up and a warning tone sounds. If the distance falls below the minimum, the distance may no longer be shown. Side view Warning displays The warning displays show the distance between the sensors and the obstacle. The warning display for the front area is located on the dashboard above the center air vents. The warning display for the rear area is located on the headliner in the rear compartment. Top view Front sensors Center Approx. 40 in (100 cm) Corners Approx. 24 in (60 cm) Rear sensors Center Approx. 48 in (120 cm) Corners Approx. 32 in (80 cm) ! When parking, pay particular attention to objects above or below the sensors, such as flower pots or trailer drawbars. PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects when they are in the immediate vicinity of the vehicle. You could damage the vehicle or the objects. Ultrasonic sources such as an automatic car wash, a truck's compressed-air brakes or a pneumatic drill could cause PARKTRONIC to malfunction. Warning display for the front area : Segments on the left-hand side of the vehicle ; Segments on the right-hand side of the vehicle = Segments showing operational readiness The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red segments. PARKTRONIC is operational if yellow segments showing operational readiness = light up. The gear lever position or the transmission position of the automatic transmission determines which warning display is active when the engine is running. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 161 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving systems 161 Gear lever position Warning display Forwards gear or Neutral Front area activated Reverse gear Rear and front areas activated Automatic transmission: : To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC Transmission position Warning display ; Indicator lamp D Front area activated If indicator lamp ; lights up, PARKTRONIC is deactivated. R or N Rear and front areas activated P No areas activated i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated when you turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. One or more segments light up as the vehicle approaches an obstacle, depending on the vehicle's distance from the obstacle. From the: Rsixth segment onwards, you will hear an intermittent warning tone for approximately two seconds. Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a warning tone for approximately two seconds. This indicates that you have now reached the minimum distance. Z Driving and parking Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC Manual transmission: BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 162 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 162 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving systems Problems with PARKTRONIC Driving and parking Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions Only the red segments PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has switched off. in the PARKTRONIC X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified warning displays are lit. specialist workshop. You also hear a warning tone for approximately two seconds. PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approximately 20 seconds, and the indicator lamp in the PARKTRONIC button lights up. Only the red segments The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference. in the PARKTRONIC X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 247). warning displays are lit. X Switch the ignition back on. PARKTRONIC is deactivated after The problem may be caused by an external source of radio or approximately 20 ultrasound waves. seconds. X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location. Rear view camera Important safety notes The rear view camera is an optical parking aid. It shows the area behind your vehicle in the COMAND display. G Warning! Make sure no persons or animals are in or near the area in which you are parking/ maneuvering. Otherwise, they could be injured. The rear view camera is located in the handle strip of the trunk lid. : Rear view camera View through the camera The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 163 Version: 3.0.3.6 Driving systems G Warning! The rear view camera is only an aid and may display obstacles Rfrom a distorted perspective Rinaccurately Rmay not display obstacles at all The rear view camera does not relieve you of the responsibility to be cautious. Take care and pay careful attention. The rear view camera may not show objects which are Rvery close to the rear bumper the rear bumper Rabove the trunk handle You are responsible for safety at all times and must continue to pay attention to the immediate surroundings when parking and maneuvering. This includes the area behind, in front of, and beside the vehicle. Otherwise you could endanger yourself and/or others. Runder Do not use the rear view camera in these situations. Otherwise you could injure yourself or others and/or damage property including your vehicle while parking/ maneuvering. Activating the rear view camera X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2 in the ignition lock. X Make sure that the "rear view camera" function is selected in COMAND (see the separate operating instructions for COMAND). X Engage reverse gear. The area behind the vehicle is shown in the COMAND display. G Warning! The rear view camera either will not function or will not function to its full capability if Rthe trunk lid is open Rit is raining very hard, snowing or foggy Rit is night or you are parking/maneuvering your vehicle in an area where it is very dark Rthe camera is exposed to a very bright white light Rthe immediate surroundings are illuminated with fluorescent light (the COMAND system display can flicker) Rthere is a sudden change in temperature, e.g. if you drive into a heated garage from the cold (lens condensation) Rthe camera lens is dirty or covered Rthe rear of your vehicle is damaged In this case, have the position and setting of the camera checked by a qualified specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you contact a MercedesBenz Center for this purpose. Z 163 Driving and parking BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 164 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 164 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 165 Version: 3.0.3.6 165 Vehicle equipment ............................ Important safety notes .................... Displays and operation .................... Menus and submenus ...................... Display messages ............................. Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster ............................ 166 166 166 169 183 203 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 166 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 166 Version: 3.0.3.6 Displays and operation Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. Important safety notes You will find an illustration of the instrument cluster in the "At a glance" section (Y page 26). G Warning A driver's attention to the road and traffic conditions must always be his/her primary focus when driving. For your safety and the safety of others, selecting features through the multifunction steering wheel should only be done by the driver when traffic and road conditions permit it to be done safely. Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h ), your vehicle is covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second. G Warning! No messages will be displayed if either the instrument cluster or the multifunction display is inoperative. As a result, you will not be able to see information about your driving conditions, such as Rspeed Routside temperature Rwarning/indicator lamps Rmalfunction/warning messages Rfailure of any systems Driving characteristics may be impaired. If you must continue to drive, do so with added caution. Contact an authorized MercedesBenz Center as soon as possible. G Warning Malfunction and warning messages are only indicated for certain systems and are intentionally not very detailed. The malfunction and warning messages are simply a reminder with respect to the operation of certain systems. They do not replace the owner's and/or driver's responsibility to maintain the vehicle's operating safety. Have all required maintenance and safety checks performed on the vehicle. Bring the vehicle to an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center to address the malfunction and warning messages. Displays and operation Coolant temperature gauge G Warning Driving when your engine is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the engine compartment to catch fire. You could be seriously burned. Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns which can occur just by opening the engine hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it. Stop the vehicle in a safe location away from other traffic. Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle and do not stand near the vehicle until the engine has cooled down. The coolant temperature gauge is in the instrument cluster on the right-hand side. Under normal operating conditions and with the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 248 ‡ (120 †). ! If the coolant temperature is too high a display message is shown. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 167 Version: 3.0.3.6 Displays and operation the buttons on the multifunction steering wheel. On-board computer and displays If the coolant temperature rises above 248 ‡(120 †), do not drive any further as this could damage the engine. Tachometer The red band in the tachometer indicates the engine's overrevving range. ! Do not drive in the overrevving range, as this could damage the engine. The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the engine when the red band is reached. Outside temperature display The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display. G Warning! The outside temperature indicator is not designed to serve as an ice-warning device and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose. Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. The road may still be icy, especially in wooded areas or on bridges. : Multifunction display ; ~6 Makes/accepts or rejects/ends a call WX Adjusts the volume or operates the RACETIMER in AMG vehicles 8 Mute = ? Activates voice control; see the separate operating instructions ? %Press briefly: Back Deactivates voice control Hides display messages Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay. Speedometer with segments The segments in the speedometer indicate which speed range is available. Cruise control mode: The segments light up from the stored speed to the maximum speed. Operating the on-board computer The on-board computer is activated as soon as you turn the SmartKey to position 1 in the ignition lock. You can control the multifunction display and the settings in the on-board computer using %Press and hold: Selects the standard display A 167 =; Calls up the menu and menu bar Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 168 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 168 Version: 3.0.3.6 Displays and operation 9:Press briefly: Selects the submenu or scrolls through lists In the Audio menu: selects a stored station, an audio track or a video scene In the Tel (telephone) menu: switches to the phone book and selects a name or telephone number 9:Press and hold: In the Audio menu: selects the previous/next station or selects an audio track or a video scene using rapid scrolling In the Tel (telephone) menu: starts rapid scrolling through the phone book a Confirms selections and hides display messages In the Tel (telephone) menu: switches to the phone book and starts dialing Multifunction display To activate the multifunction display: Rswitch on the ignition. on the lights. Ropen the driver's door. Values and settings as well as display messages are shown in the multifunction display. Rswitch : Description field ; Menu bar X To show menu bar ;: press the = or ; button on the steering wheel. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 169 Version: 3.0.3.6 Menus and submenus On-board computer and displays Menus and submenus Menu overview The number of menus shown depends on the optional equipment in the vehicle. Function : Trip menu (Y page 170) ; AMG menu in AMG vehicles (Y page 171) = Navi menu (navigation details) (Y page 174) ? Audio menu (Y page 175) A Tel menu (telephone) (Y page 176) B DriveAssist menu (assistance) (Y page 178) C Serv. menu (Y page 178) Rcall up display messages (Y page 183) Rtire pressure loss warning system (Canada only) (Y page 275) Rtire pressure monitor (USA only) (Y page 277) RASSYST PLUS service interval display (Y page 243) D Settings menu (Y page 178) 169 Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Menus and submenus 170 On-board computer and displays 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 170 Version: 3.0.3.6 The Audio and Tel menus differ slightly in vehicles with an audio system and vehicles with COMAND. The examples given in this Operator's Manual apply to vehicles equipped with COMAND. Trip menu Standard display X Press and hold the % button on the steering wheel until the Trip menu with odometer : and trip odometer ; is shown. Trip computer "From start" or "From reset" The values in the From Start submenu are calculated from the start of a journey whilst the values in the From Reset submenu are calculated from the last time the submenu was reset. X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu. X Press 9 or : to select From Start or From Reset. The From Start trip computer is reset automatically when Rthe ignition has been switched off for more than 4 hours. R999 hours have been exceeded. R9999 miles have been exceeded. The From Reset trip computer is automatically reset if the trip exceeds 9999 hours or 99,999 miles. You can select km or miles as the unit of measurement for distance (Y page 178). Displaying the range and current fuel consumption X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu. X Press the 9 or : button to select current fuel consumption and approximate range. : Current fuel consumption19 ; Approximate range Trip computer "After start" (example) : Distance ; Time = Average speed ? Average fuel consumption 19 Not in AMG vehicles. Approximate range ; is calculated according to current driving style and the amount of fuel in the tank. If there is only a small amount of fuel left in the fuel tank, the display shows a vehicle being refueled C instead of range ;. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 171 Version: 3.0.3.6 Menus and submenus Digital speedometer X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu. X Press 9 or : to select the digital speedometer. AMG menu in AMG vehicles AMG displays X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu. : Shift recommendation ; Digital speedometer i If the gearshift recommendation is shown in the multifunction display, it is not shown in the status bar. Further information on gearshift recommendations (Y page 138). Resetting values You can reset the values of the following functions: RTrip odometer computer "From start" RTrip computer "From reset" X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu. X Press 9 or : to select the function that you wish to reset. X Press a. RTrip Resetting the trip computer "From start" (example) X : Digital speedometer ; Gear indicator = Upshift instruction ? Engine oil temperature A Coolant temperature Shift UP instruction = indicates that the engine has reached the overrevving range when in the manual gearshift program. Shift up instruction = overrides other messages in the multifunction display until you have shifted up. When the engine temperature is below 80 †, the oil temperature gauge flashes. Avoid driving at full engine output during this time. SETUP SETUP shows the drive program, the ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) mode and the SPORT handling mode. X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu. X Press the 9 button repeatedly until SETUP is displayed. Press the : button to select Yes and press the a button to confirm. Z 171 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Menus and submenus 172 On-board computer and displays 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 172 Version: 3.0.3.6 : Drive program (S/C/M) : RACETIMER ; ESP® mode (ON/OFF) or SPORT handling ; Lap mode (SPORT) RACETIMER You can start the RACETIMER when the engine is running or if the SmartKey is in position 2 in the ignition lock. Displaying and starting RACETIMER X G Warning The RACETIMER feature is only for use on roads and in conditions where high speed driving is permitted. Racing on public roads is prohibited under all circumstances. The driver is and must always remain responsible for following posted speed limits. You can use the RACETIMER to store lap times. When RACETIMER is displayed, you cannot adjust the volume using the W and X buttons on the steering wheel. X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu. X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the RACETIMER is shown. To start: press the W button to start the RACETIMER. X To display the intermediate time: press X to show the intermediate time. The intermediate time is displayed for five seconds. X To stop: press the W button to stop the RACETIMER. The RACETIMER interrupts timing when you stop the vehicle and turn the SmartKey to position 1 in the ignition lock. When you turn the SmartKey to position 2 or 3 and then press the W button, timing is continued. Storing the lap time and starting a new lap It is possible to store a maximum of sixteen laps. X Press the X button on the steering wheel to show the intermediate time during timing. The intermediate time is displayed for five seconds. X Press the X button again within five seconds. The displayed intermediate time is stored as a lap time. Timing starts for a new lap. The new lap is timed from when the intermediate time is called up. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 173 Version: 3.0.3.6 Menus and submenus Overall evaluation This function is shown if you have stored at least one lap and stopped the RACETIMER. X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu. X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the overall evaluation is shown. : RACETIMER ; Fastest lap time (best lap) = Lap Resetting the current lap X Press the W button on the steering wheel to stop the RACETIMER. X Press X to reset the lap time to "0”. Deleting all laps You cannot delete individual stored laps. X Press the W button on the steering wheel to stop the RACETIMER. X Press a. Reset Race Timer? appears in the multifunction display. : RACETIMER overall evaluation ; Total time driven = Average speed ? Distance covered A Top speed Lap evaluation This function is only available if you have stored at least two laps and have stopped the RACETIMER. X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu. X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the lap evaluation is shown. Each lap is shown in a separate submenu. The fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol :. X Press the : button to select YES and press the a button to confirm. All laps are deleted. Z 173 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Menus and submenus 174 On-board computer and displays 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 174 Version: 3.0.3.6 Route guidance active No change of direction announced : Lap ; Lap time = Average lap speed ? Lap length A Top speed during lap X Press 9 or : to select a different lap evaluation. : Distance to destination ; Distance to next change of direction = Current road ? Symbol for "follow the road's course" Change of direction announced without a lane recommendation Navigation menu Displaying navigation instructions In the Navi menu, the multifunction display shows navigation instructions. For more information, see the separate operating instructions. X Switch on COMAND (see the separate operating instructions). X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Navi menu. Route guidance inactive : Road into which the change of direction leads ; Distance to change of direction and visual distance display = Symbol for change of direction When a change of direction has been announced, you will see visual distance display ; next to symbol = for the change of direction. This decreases in size as you approach the announced change of direction. Change of direction announced with a lane recommendation Lane recommendations are only displayed if the relevant data is available on the digital map. : Direction of travel ; Current road 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 175 Version: 3.0.3.6 Menus and submenus Audio menu Selecting a radio station i SIRIUS XM satellite radio acts like a normal radio. For more information on satellite radio operation, see the separate operating instructions. : Road into which the change of direction leads ; Distance to change of direction and visual distance display = Lane recommendation ? Symbol for change of direction On multi-lane roads, lane recommendation = may be shown for the next change of direction. Lanes may be added during a change of direction. You can only change the waveband and store new stations using the audio system or COMAND. X Switch on the audio system or COMAND and select Radio (see the separate operating instructions). X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu. Lane recommendation display (example) : Uninterrupted lane : Waveband20 ; Station ; New lane during a change of direction X = Lane recommended for the change of direction Other status indicators of the navigation system you have reached the destination. Route... or Calculating Route: a new route is being calculated. ROff Map or Off Mapped Road: the vehicle position is outside the area of the digital map (off-map position). RNo Route: no route could be calculated to the selected destination. RO: RNew To select a stored channel: briefly press the 9 or : button. X To select a channel from the channel list: press and briefly hold the 9 or : button. X To select a station using the station search21: press and briefly hold the 9 or : button. Audio player or audio media operation Audio data from various audio devices or media can be played, depending on the equipment installed in the vehicle. 20 When 21 Only station ; has been stored, the memory position will also be displayed. if no station list is received. Z 175 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Menus and submenus 176 On-board computer and displays 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 176 Version: 3.0.3.6 X Switch on the audio system or COMAND and select the audio drive or medium (see the separate operating instructions). X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu. 9 or : button until the desired scene has been reached. Telephone menu Introduction You can establish a Bluetooth® wireless connection to the audio system or to COMAND (see the separate operating instructions). CD player display (example) : Current track X To select the next/previous track: briefly press the 9 or : button. X To select a track from the track list (rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9 or : button until the desired track has been reached. If track information is stored on the audio player or medium, the multifunction display will show the number and name of the track. The current track does not appear in audio AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode: external audio source connected). Video DVD operation X Switch on COMAND and select video DVD (see the separate operating instructions). X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu. G Warning A driver's attention to the road must always be his/her primary focus when driving. For your safety and the safety of others, we recommend that you pull over to a safe location and stop before placing or taking a telephone call. If you choose to use the telephone while driving, please use the handsfree device and only use the telephone when weather, road and traffic conditions permit. Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from using a mobile phone while driving a vehicle. Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph (approximately 50 km/h ), your vehicle is covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately 14 m) every second. X Switch on the mobile phone and audio system or COMAND (see the separate operating instructions). X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu. You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display: RTelephone Ready or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found a network and is ready to receive. RNo Service: No network is available. : Current scene X To select the next or previous scene: briefly press the 9 or the : button. X To select a scene from the scene list (rapid scrolling): press and hold the Accepting a call If someone calls you when you are in the Tel menu, a display message appears in the multifunction display, for example: 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 177 Version: 3.0.3.6 Menus and submenus X If only one telephone number is stored for a name: press the 6 or a button to start dialing. or X X Press 6 on the steering wheel to accept an incoming call. You can accept a call even if you are not in the Tel menu. Rejecting or ending a call X Press the ~ button on the steering wheel. You can end or reject a call even if you are not in the Tel menu. Dialing a number from the phone book If your mobile phone is able to receive calls, you can search for and dial a number from the phone book in the audio system or COMAND at any time. X Copy the telephone book of the mobile phone into the audio system or to COMAND (see the separate operating instructions). X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu. X Press the 9, : or a button to call up the phone book. X Press 9 or : to select the name you are searching for. To start scrolling rapidly, press and hold the 9 or : button for longer than one second. After a short time, the rapid scroll speeds up. Rapid scrolling stops when you release the button or reach the end of the list. If there is more than one number for a particular name: press the 6 or a button to display the numbers. X Press the 9 or : button to select the number you want to dial. X Press the 6 or a button to start dialing. or X If you do not want to make a call: press the ~ button. Redialing The on-board computer saves the last names or numbers dialed in the redial memory. X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu. X Press the 6 button to switch to the redial memory. X Press the 9 or : button to select the desired name or number. X Press the 6 or a button to start dialing. Assistance menu Deactivating/activating ESP® G Warning! Never switch off the ESP when you see the ESP warning lamp ä flashing in the instrument cluster. In this case proceed as follows: RWhen driving off, apply as little throttle as possible. RWhile driving, ease up on the accelerator pedal. RAdapt your speed and driving style to the prevailing road conditions. Z 177 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Menus and submenus 178 On-board computer and displays 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 178 Version: 3.0.3.6 Failure to observe these guidelines could cause the vehicle to skid. The ESP cannot prevent accidents resulting from excessive speed. Further information about ESP®(Y page 63). This function is not available in AMG vehicles. X Start the engine. X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the DriveAssist menu. X Press 9 or : to select ESP. X Press a. X To deactivate: press a again. The å warning lamp in the instrument cluster comes on. In the Service menu you can: Rcall up display messages (Y page 183) Rrestart the tire pressure loss warning system (Canada only) (Y page 275) Rcheck the tire pressure electronically (USA only) (Y page 277) Rcall up the service due date (Y page 243) Settings menu Introduction G Warning When the å ESP OFF warning lamp lights up, ESP is switched off. When the ä ESP warning lamp and the å ESP OFF warning lamp are on continuously, ESP is not operational due to a malfunction. When ESP is switched off or not operational, the vehicle's stability during standard driving maneuvers is reduced. Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road conditions/weather conditions and to the non-operating status of ESP. X To activate: press a again. The å warning lamp in the instrument cluster goes out. Maintenance menu In the Settings menu, you have the following options: RChanging the instrument cluster settings RChanging the time/date settings22 RChanging the lighting settings RChanging the vehicle settings RChanging the convenience settings RRestoring the factory settings Instrument cluster Selecting the unit of measurement for distance The Display Unit Speed-/Odometer: function allows you to choose whether certain displays appear in km/h or mph in the multifunction display. The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to: digital speedometer in the Trip menu odometer and the trip odometer Rthe trip computer Rthe navigation instructions in the Navi menu Rthe Rthe 22 This function is not available in vehicles with COMAND. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 179 Version: 3.0.3.6 Menus and submenus X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Instr. Cluster submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Display Unit Speed-/Odometer. function. You will see the selected setting: km or miles. X Press the a button to save the setting. Switching the additional speedometer on/off Only vehicles with manual transmission have this function. The Additional Speedometer: function allows you to choose whether the multifunction display also shows the speed in km/h (USA) or mph (Canada). X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Instr. Cluster submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Additional Speedometer function. You will see the selected setting: On or Off. X Press the a button to save the setting. Selecting the permanent display function Only vehicles with automatic transmission have this function. The Permanent Display: function allows you to choose whether the multifunction display always shows the outside temperature or the speed in km/h (USA) or mph (Canada). X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Instr. Cluster submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. X Press : or 9 to select the Permanent Display: function. You will see the selected setting Outside Temperature or Speedometer [km/h]:. X Press the a button to save the setting. Time/date This submenu is only available on vehicles with Audio 20. To set the time and date on vehicles with COMAND, see the separate operating instructions. In the Time/date submenu, you can set the time and date. X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Time/date submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. X Press the : or 9 button to select Time: or Date:. The current time or date set is displayed. X Press a to change the setting. X Press the = or ; button to select the display you want to change: hour, minute, day, month, year. X Press the : or 9 button to set the selected display. X Press the a button to store the entry. Lights Switching the daytime running lamps on/ off This function is not available in Canada. If you have activated the Daytime Running Lights: function and the light switch is in the Z 179 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 180 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 180 Version: 3.0.3.6 Menus and submenus c position the daytime running lamps are switched on automatically when the engine is running. In the dark, the following also light up: Rthe low-beam headlamps parking lamps Rthe tail lamps Rthe license plate lamp Rthe side marker lamps X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Lights submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Daytime Running Lights: function. You will see the selected setting: Enabled or Disabled. X Press the a button to save the setting. Rthe Activating/deactivating surround lighting and exterior lighting delayed switch-off If you switch on the Locator Lighting: function and the light switch is set to c, Rthe exterior lighting switches on when it is dark after unlocking the vehicle with the SmartKey. The exterior lighting switches off when you open the driver’s door. Rthe exterior lighting remains on for 15 seconds when it is dark after closing the doors. If the engine is switched off and then none of the doors are opened, or if an open door is not closed, the exterior lighting goes out after 60 seconds. If you activate the Locator Lighting: function, the following light up: 23 Only 24 Only for vehicles with front fog lamps. for vehicles without front fog lamps. Rthe parking lamps tail lamps Rthe fog lamps23 Rthe low-beam headlamps24 Rthe license plate lamp Rthe side marker lamps X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Lights submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Locator Lighting: function. You will see the selected setting: Enabled or Disabled. X Press the a button to save the setting. Rthe To deactivate the delayed shut-off temporarily: X Before leaving the vehicle, turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock and back to position 0. The delayed shut-off is deactivated. The delayed shut-off is reactivated the next time you start the engine. Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off If the Interior Lighting Delay: function is activated and you pull the SmartKey out of the ignition lock, the interior lighting remains on for around 10 seconds. X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Lights submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 181 Version: 3.0.3.6 Menus and submenus X Press the : or 9 button to select the Interior Lighting Delay: function. You will see the selected setting: Enabled or Disabled. X Press the a button to save the setting. X Vehicle Convenience Activating/deactivating the automatic locking feature If you select the Automatic Door Lock: function, the vehicle is centrally locked above a speed of around 9 mph (15 km/h). Activating/deactivating the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature You can use the Easy Entry/Exit: function to activate or deactivate the easy-entry/exit feature (Y page 99). i Further information on the automatic locking feature (Y page 78). X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Vehicle submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Automatic Door Lock: function. You will see the selected setting: Enabled or Disabled. X Press the a button to save the setting. Activating/deactivating the acoustic locking confirmation If you switch on the Acoustic Lock Feedback: function, an acoustic signal sounds when you lock or unlock the vehicle. When unlocking, the signal sounds once. When locking, it sounds three times. X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Vehicle submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. Press the : or 9 button to select the Acoustic Lock Feedback: function. You will see the selected setting: Enabled or Disabled. X Press the a button to save the setting. G Warning! You must make sure no one can become trapped or injured by the moving steering wheel when the easy-entry/exit feature is activated. To stop steering wheel movement, move steering wheel adjustment lever or press one of the memory position buttons. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could open the driver's door and unintentionally activate the easy-entry/exit feature, which could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Convenience submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Easy Entry/Exit: feature. You will see the selected setting: Enabled or Disabled. X Press the a button to save the setting. Switching the fold in mirrors when locking function on/off This function is only available in Canada. If you switch on the Fold Mirrors In when Locking: function, the exterior mirrors fold Z 181 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 182 Menus and submenus in when you lock the vehicle. When you unlock the vehicle and then open the driver's or front-passenger door, the exterior mirrors fold out again. If you have switched the function on and you fold the exterior mirrors in using the button on the door (Y page 100), they will not fold out automatically. The exterior mirrors can then only be folded out using the button on the door. X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Convenience submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Fold Mirrors in when Locking: function. You will see the selected setting: Enabled or Disabled. X Press the a button to save the setting. Resetting to factory settings For safety reasons, the Daytime Running Lights: function in the Light submenu is only reset if the vehicle is stationary. X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu. X Press the : or 9 button to select the Factory Setting submenu. X Press the a button to confirm. The Reset All Settings? message appears. X Press the : or 9 button to select No or Yes. X Press the a button to confirm the selection. If you have selected Yes, the multifunction display shows a confirmation message. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 182 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 183 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages Display messages Hiding display messages G Warning All categories of messages contain important information which should be taken note of and, where a malfunction is indicated, addressed as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Failure to repair the condition noted may cause damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty, or result in property damage or personal injury. Display messages appear in the multifunction display. X Press the a or % button on the steering wheel to hide the display message. The display message is cleared. The multifunction display shows high-priority display messages in red. You cannot hide display messages of the highest priority. The multifunction display shows these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied. Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone. Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in this Operator's Manual. Message memory You can read the display messages in the message memory. X Press = or ; on the steering wheel to select the Service menu. If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 messages, for example. X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 messages. X Confirm with a. X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages. When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some highpriority display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been rectified, the corresponding display messages are also deleted. Z 183 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 184 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 184 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages Safety systems Display messages ÷ Inoperative See Operator's Manual ÷ ESC Currently Unavailable See Operator's Manual Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of accident ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist) and hill start assist are not available due to a malfunction. In addition, the ä and å warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. G Risk of accident ESP®, BAS and hill start assist are temporarily unavailable. In addition, the ä and å warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster. The self-diagnosis function might not be complete, for example. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. X Carefully drive a suitable distance making slight steering movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h). If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned above are available again. If the display message continues to be displayed: X X Drive on carefully. Visit a qualified specialist workshop. G Risk of accident ESP®, BAS and hill start assist are temporarily unavailable. In addition, the ä and å warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster. The on-board voltage may be insufficient, for example. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. X Drive on carefully. If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned above are available again. If the display message continues to be displayed: X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 185 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of accident If the display message is shown and the ä warning lamp flashes at the same time, ETS (Electronic Traction System) is deactivated. The brakes on the drive wheels could otherwise overheat. X Let the brakes cool down until the display message disappears and the ä warning lamp goes out. ETS is active again. G Tele Aid Inoperative Check Child Seat Pos. See Operator's Manual USA only: one or more main functions in the mbrace system are malfunctioning. Canada only: one or more of the main functions of the TELEAID system is malfunctioning. X USA only: have the mbrace system checked at a qualified specialist workshop. X Canada only: have the TELEAID system checked at a qualified specialist workshop. G Risk of injury Vehicles with BabySmart™ (Canada only): The BabySmart™ child seat is positioned incorrectly. X Install the child seat in the correct position. G Risk of injury Vehicles with BabySmart™ (Canada only): The sensor for automatic child seat recognition is faulty. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. 6 SRS Malfunction Service Required 6 Front Left SRS Malfunction Service Required or Front Right SRS Malfunction Service Required G Risk of injury There is a malfunction in the SRS (Supplemental Restraint System). The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. G Risk of injury SRS has malfunctioned at the front on the left or right. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Z 185 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 186 Display messages On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Display messages 6 Rear Left SRS Malfunction Service Required or Rear Right SRS Malfunction Service Required 6 Rear Center SRS Malfunction Service Required 6 Left Side Curtain Airbag Malfunction Service Required or Right Side Curtain Airbag Malfunction Service Required G Warning 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 186 Version: 3.0.3.6 Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of injury SRS has malfunctioned at the rear on the left or right. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. G Risk of injury SRS has malfunctioned at the rear center. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. G Risk of injury There is a malfunction in the left-hand and/or right-hand window curtain air bag. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. In the event a malfunction of the SRS is indicated as outlined above, the SRS may not be operational. For your safety, we strongly recommend that you contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately to have the system checked. Otherwise the SRS may not be activated when needed in an accident, which could result in serious or fatal injury, or it might deploy unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could also result in injury. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 187 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions Front Passenger Airbag Enabled See Operator's Manual The front-passenger air bag is enabled during the journey, although: Rthere is a child, a small adult or an object weighing less than the system's weight threshold on the front-passenger seat. Rthe front-passenger seat is unoccupied. The system may detect the additional weight of objects on the seat or forces acting on the seat. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. X Engage the parking brake. X Switch off the ignition. X Open the front-passenger door. X Remove the child and the child restraint system from the frontpassenger seat. X If necessary, secure the child in a child restraint system on a suitable rear seat. X Make sure that there are no objects adding to the weight applied to the seat. The system may otherwise detect the additional weight and interpret the seat occupant's weight as greater than it actually is. X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied and has no objects placed on it, close the front-passenger door, and switch on the ignition. Observe the 45(Y page 41) indicator lamps and the multifunction display and check the following: Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on: Rthe 45 indicator lamp must light up and remain lit. When the indicator lamp is on, OCS (Y page 41) has deactivated the front-passenger air bag. RThe Front Passenger Airbag Enabled See Operator's Manual or Front Passenger Airbag Disabled See Operator's Manual display messages must not appear. Wait for at least 60 seconds until the necessary system checks have been completed and to make sure that the display messages do not appear in the multifunction display. If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be occupied again. Whether the 45 indicator lamp remains lit or goes out depends on how OCS classifies the occupant. If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately. Z 187 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 188 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 188 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages G Warning If the 45 indicator lamp remains off even after performing the above corrective steps, do not have any children 12 years old and under and other small individuals use the front-passenger seat until the system has been repaired. Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions Front Passenger Airbag Disabled See Operator's Manual The front-passenger air bag is deactivated during the journey even though an adult or a person larger than a certain size is occupying the front-passenger seat. If additional forces are applied to the seat, the system may interpret the occupant's weight as lower than it actually is. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. X Engage the parking brake. X Switch off the ignition. X Have the occupant get out of the vehicle. X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied and has no objects placed on it, close the front-passenger door, and switch on the ignition. Observe the 45(Y page 41) indicator lamps and the multifunction display and check the following: Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on: Rthe 45 indicator lamp must light up and remain lit. When the indicator lamp is on, OCS (Y page 41) has deactivated the front-passenger air bag. RThe Front Passenger Airbag Enabled See Operator's Manual or Front Passenger Airbag Disabled See Operator's Manual display messages must not appear. Wait for at least 60 seconds until the necessary system checks have been completed and to make sure that the display messages do not appear in the multifunction display. If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be occupied again. Whether the 45 indicator lamp remains lit or goes out depends on how OCS classifies the occupant. If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately. G Warning If the 45 indicator lamp remains lit with an adult occupant on the front-passenger seat even after performing the above corrective steps, do not have any passenger use the frontpassenger seat until the system has been repaired. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 189 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages Brakes Display messages $(USA only) J(Canada only) ABS and ESC Currently Unavailable See Operator's Manual Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of accident ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist) and hill start assist are temporarily unavailable. The self-diagnosis might not be finished, for example. In addition, the ä, å and ! warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. X Carefully drive a suitable distance making slight steering movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h). If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned above are available again. If the display message continues to be displayed: X X Drive on carefully. Visit a qualified specialist workshop. G Risk of accident ABS, ESP®, BAS and hill start assist are temporarily unavailable. The on-board voltage may be insufficient, for example. In addition, the ä, å and ! warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. X Drive on carefully. If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned above are available again. If the display message continues to be displayed: X X Drive on carefully. Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Z 189 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 190 Display messages On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Display messages $(USA only) J(Canada only) ABS and ESC Inoperative See Operator's Manual $(USA only) J(Canada only) EBD, ABS, and ESC Inoperative See Operator's Manual # Check Brake Pad Wear $(USA only) J(Canada only) 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 190 Version: 3.0.3.6 Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of accident ABS, ESP®, BAS and hill start assist are unavailable due to a malfunction. In addition, the ä, å and ! warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. G Risk of accident EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution), ABS, ESP®, BAS and hill start assist are unavailable due to a malfunction. In addition, the ä, å and ! warning lamps in the instrument cluster light up and a warning tone sounds. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately. The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. You are driving with the parking brake engaged. A warning tone also sounds. X Release the parking brake. Release Park. Brake $(USA only) J(Canada only) Check Brake Fluid Level G Risk of accident There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir. Additionally, the red $ (USA only)/ J (Canada only) warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster and a warning tone sounds. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstances. X Engage the parking brake. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. X Do not add brake fluid. This will not rectify the malfunction. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 191 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages G Warning Driving with the message Check Brake Fluid Level displayed can result in an accident. Have your brake system checked immediately. Do not add brake fluid before checking the brake system. Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts and the brake fluid catching fire. You can be seriously burned. Lights i Display messages about LEDs: This display message will only appear if all LEDs have failed. Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions b The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Check Left Cornering Light or Check Right Cornering Light The left or right-hand low-beam headlamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself Check Left Low Beam (Y page 111). or or Check Right Low X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Beam b b Check Rear Left Turn Signal or Check Rear Right Turn Signal b Check Front Left Turn Signal or Check Front Right Turn Signal The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Z 191 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 192 Version: 3.0.3.6 192 Display messages On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions b The turn signal in the left-hand and/or right-hand exterior mirror is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Check Left Mirror Turn Signal or Check Right Mirror Turn Signal b Check Center Brake Lamp b Check Left Brake Lamp or Check Right Brake Lamp b Check Left Tail and Brake Lamps or Check Right Tail and Brake Lamps b Check Left Tail Lamp or Check Right Tail Lamp b Check Left High Beam or Check Right High Beam The high-mounted brake lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The left or right-hand brake lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The left or right brake/tail lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The left or right-hand tail lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The left or right-hand high beam is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 193 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions b The left or right-hand license plate lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Check Left License Plate Lamp or Check Right License Plate Lamp The left-hand or right-hand front fog lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself Check Left Fog Lamp (Y page 111). or or Check Front Fog X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Lamp b b Check Rear Left Fog Lamp or Check Rear Right Fog Lamp b Check Front Left Parking Lamp or Check Front Right Parking Lamp b Check Left Reverse Lamp or Check Right Reverse Lamp b Check Front Left Sidemarker Lamp or Check Front Right Sidemarker Lamp The left-hand or right-hand rear fog lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The front left or front right standing lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The left or right-hand backup lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The front left or right side marker lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Z 193 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 194 Version: 3.0.3.6 194 Display messages On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions b The rear left or right side marker lamp is faulty. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Check Rear Sidemarker or Check Rear Sidemarker Left Lamp Right Lamp b Check Left Daytime Running Light or Check Right Daytime Running Light b Active Headlamps Inoperative b Malfunction See Operator's Manual b Auto Lamp Function Inoperative b Switch Off Lights The left or right-hand daytime running light is defective. X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself (Y page 111). or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The active light function is faulty. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The exterior lighting is faulty. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The light sensor is faulty. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A warning tone also sounds. X Turn the light switch to c. Engine Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions + The coolant level is too low. X Add coolant, observing the warning notes when doing so (Y page 240). X If coolant needs adding more often than usual, have the engine coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop. Check Coolant Level See Operator's Manual 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 195 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages G Warning Do not spill antifreeze on hot engine parts. Antifreeze contains ethylene glycol which may burn if it comes into contact with hot engine parts. You could be seriously burned. ! The coolant level is too low. Avoid making long journeys with too little coolant in the cooling system. The engine will otherwise be damaged. The display messages and the corresponding symbol that indicate that the coolant level is too low must not be ignored. Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions ? The coolant is too hot. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. X Make sure that the air supply to the radiator is not blocked, e.g. by snow, slush or ice. X Wait until the display message disappears before restarting the engine. There is otherwise a risk of engine damage. X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display. X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately. Coolant Level Low Stop Vehicle Turn Engine Off The poly-V-belt may have torn. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. X Open the hood. X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn. If the poly-V-belt is torn: ! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. If the poly-V-belt is OK: X Wait until the display message disappears before restarting the engine. There is otherwise a risk of engine damage. X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. G Warning Driving when your engine is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the engine compartment to catch fire. You could be seriously burned. Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns which can occur just by opening the engine hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it. Stop the vehicle in a safe location away from other traffic. Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle and do not stand near the vehicle until the engine has cooled down. Z 195 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 196 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 196 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages ! If the coolant temperature exceeds 248 ‡(120 †) do not continue driving. The engine will otherwise be damaged. Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions ? The engine fan is faulty. X At coolant temperatures below 248 ‡ (120 †), continue driving to the next qualified specialist workshop. X Avoid subjecting the engine to heavy loads, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain, and stop-start driving. # The battery is not being charged. Possible causes are: Ra faulty alternator torn poly-V-belt Ra malfunction in the electronics X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. X Open the hood. X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn. Ra If the poly-V-belt is torn: ! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. If the poly-V-belt is OK: X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. 4 Check Engine Oil At Next RefuelingCheck Engine Oil at Next Refueling The engine oil level has dropped to a critical level. A warning tone also sounds. X Check the oil level (Y page 239). X If necessary, add the engine oil (Y page 240). X Have the engine checked for leaks if engine oil has to be added more often than usual. Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://www.mbusa.com (USA only). ! The oil level is too low. Avoid long journeys with too little engine oil. There is a risk of engine damage. The display messages and the corresponding symbol that indicate that the oil level is too low must not be ignored. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 197 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions C There is only a small amount of fuel in the fuel tank. X Refuel at the nearest gas station. 8 The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range. X Refuel at the nearest gas station. Fuel Level Low 8 Gas Cap Loose The fuel system pressure is too low. The fuel filler cap is not closed correctly or the fuel system is leaking. X Check that the fuel filler cap is correctly closed. X If the fuel filler cap is not correctly closed: close the fuel filler cap. X If the fuel filler cap is closed: visit a qualified specialist workshop. Driving systems Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions Cruise Control Inoperative Cruise control is faulty. A warning tone also sounds. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Cruise Control --- mph A condition for activating cruise control has not been met. You attempted to save a speed of less than 20 mph (30 km/h). X If the situation allows, drive faster than 20 mph (30 km/h) and save the speed. X Check the activation conditions for cruise control (Y page 156). Tires G Warning Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You may lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build-up and possibly a fire. G Warning Follow recommended tire inflation pressures. Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. Z 197 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 198 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 198 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can adversely affect handling and ride comfort, wear unevenly, increase stopping distance, and result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes etc. Display messages Check Tire Pressure Soon Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of accident The tire pressure loss warning system has detected a significant loss in pressure. A warning tone also sounds. X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so. X Check the tires and, if necessary, change the wheel (Y page 286). X Check the tire pressures and, if necessary, set to the correct tire pressure. X Restart the tire pressure loss warning system when the tire pressure is correct (Y page 275). Check Tire Pressure A display message from the tire pressure loss warning system was shown and the system has not been restarted since. Then Restart Run Flat Indicator X Set the correct tire pressure in all four tires. X Restart the tire pressure loss warning system (Y page 275). Run Flat Indicator Inoperative The tire pressure loss warning system is faulty. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Tire pressures will be displayed after driving a few minutes The tire pressure monitor is measuring the tire pressure. X Drive on. The tire pressures appear in the multifunction display after you have been driving for a few minutes. Tire Press. Monitor The TPMS is faulty. Inoperative X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Tire Pressure Monitor Inoperative No Wheel Sensors The wheels mounted do not have a suitable tire pressure sensor. The tire pressure monitor is deactivated. X Mount wheels with suitable tire pressure sensors. The TPMS is activated automatically after driving for a few minutes. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 199 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages Display messages Check Tires Caution Tire Malfunction Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of accident The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped significantly. The wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display. X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so. X Correct the tire pressure (Y page 277). X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 286). G Risk of accident The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped suddenly. The wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display. X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so. X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 286). Correct Tire Pressure The tire pressure is insufficient in at least one of the tires or the tire pressure difference between the wheels is too great. X Check the tire pressures at the next opportunity. If necessary, correct the tire pressure (Y page 277). X Restart the tire pressure monitor (Y page 279). Tire Press. Sensor(s)Missing There is no signal from the tire pressure sensor of one or several wheels. The pressure of the affected tire is not displayed in the multifunction display. X Have the faulty tire pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop. Tire Press. Monitor No signals are being received from the tire pressure sensors due to radio interference. The tire pressure monitor is temporarily Currently malfunctioning. Unavailable X Drive on. The TPMS restarts automatically as soon as the problem has been solved. h Tire Press. Warning Caution Tire Malfunction G Risk of accident The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped suddenly. X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so. X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 286). Z 199 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 200 Display messages On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Display messages h 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 200 Version: 3.0.3.6 Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of accident Check Tire Pressure The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped significantly. X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so. X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 286). X Check the tire pressure. If necessary, correct the tire pressure (Y page 277). h Correct Tire Pressure The tire pressure is insufficient in at least one of the tires or the tire pressure difference between the wheels is too great. X Check the tire pressures at the next opportunity. If necessary, correct the tire pressure (Y page 277). Vehicle Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions Shift to 'P' or 'N' You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in position R or D. to Start Engine X Shift the transmission to position P or N. P Shift to 'P' You turned off the engine with the Start/Stop button and opened the driver's door while the transmission was in position N. or You have attempted to turn off the engine with the Start/Stop button while the transmission was in position R or D. X Shift the transmission to position P. A Wagon: the tailgate is open. X Close the tailgate. N The trunk lid is open. X Close the trunk lid. M G Risk of accident The hood is open. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. X Engage the parking brake. X Close the hood. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 201 Version: 3.0.3.6 Display messages Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions C At least one door is open. X Close all doors. _ Rear Lt. Backrest Not Latched or Rear Rt. Backrest Not Latched D Power Steering Malfunction See Operator's Manual No Service ¥ Check Washer Fluid G Risk of injury The backrest in the rear is not engaged on the left-hand and/or right-hand side. X Push the backrest back until it engages. G Risk of accident The power steering assistance is faulty. You will need to use more force to steer. A warning tone also sounds. X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required. X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified specialist workshop. X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the nearest qualified specialist workshop. Your vehicle is outside the network provider transmitter/receiver range. X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol appears in the multifunction display. The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped below the minimum. X Add washer fluid (Y page 241). SmartKey Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions + You have put the wrong SmartKey in the ignition lock. X Use the correct SmartKey. Key Does Not Belong to Vehicle + Take Your Key from Ignition The SmartKey is in the ignition lock. X Remove the SmartKey. Z 201 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 202 Version: 3.0.3.6 202 Display messages On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions + The SmartKey needs to be replaced. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. Obtain a new key + Replace Key Battery + Don't Forget Your Key + Key Not Detected (red display message) The batteries of the KEYLESS-GO key are discharged. X Change the batteries (Y page 74). The display message is displayed for a maximum of 60 seconds and is just a reminder. You have opened the driver's door with the engine switched off. The KEYLESS-GO key is not in the ignition lock. X Take the KEYLESS-GO key with you when leaving the vehicle. The KEYLESS-GO key is not in the vehicle. A warning tone also sounds. If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle centrally or start the engine. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. X Engage the parking brake. X Locate the KEYLESS-GO key. The KEYLESS-GO key is not detected while the engine is running because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves. A warning tone also sounds. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. X Engage the parking brake. X Operate the vehicle with the KEYLESS-GO key in the ignition lock if necessary. + Key Not Detected (white display message) The KEYLESS-GO key cannot be detected at present. X Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions in the vehicle. If the KEYLESS-GO key is still not detected: X Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions in the vehicle. X Operate the vehicle with the KEYLESS-GO key in the ignition lock if necessary. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 203 Version: 3.0.3.6 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster Display messages Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions + The KEYLESS-GO key has been detected inside the vehicle during locking. X Remove the KEYLESS-GO key from the vehicle. Key Detected in Vehicle + Remove 'Start' Button and Insert Key + Close Doors to Lock Vehicle KEYLESS-GO is temporarily malfunctioning or is defective. A warning tone also sounds. X Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired position. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds. X Close all doors and lock the vehicle again. Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster Brakes Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions $ (USA only) You are driving with the parking brake engaged. J (Canada only) X Release the parking brake. The warning lamp goes out and the warning tone ceases. The red brake system warning lamp comes on while the vehicle is moving. A warning tone also sounds. $ (USA only) G Risk of accident J (Canada only) There is insufficient brake fluid in the fluid reservoir. The red brake system X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying warning lamp comes on attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving while the engine is under any circumstances. running. A warning tone X Engage the parking brake. also sounds. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display. Do not add brake fluid. This will not rectify the problem. Z 203 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 204 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 204 Version: 3.0.3.6 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster G Warning Driving with the brake warning lamp illuminated can result in an accident. Have your brake system checked immediately if the brake warning lamp stays on. Do not add brake fluid before checking the brake system. Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts and the brake fluid catching fire. You can be seriously burned. Seat belts Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions 7 The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger to fasten their seat belts. After starting the engine, the red seat X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50). belt warning lamp lights up for 6 seconds. 7 G Risk of injury After starting the The driver's seat belt is not fastened. engine, the red seat belt warning lamp lights X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50). The warning tone ceases. up. In addition, a warning tone sounds for up to 6 seconds. 7 G Risk of injury The red seat belt The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt. warning lamp lights up after the engine starts, X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50). The warning lamp goes out. as soon as the driver's or the front-passenger G Risk of injury door is closed. There are objects on the front-passenger seat. X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them in a secure place. The warning lamp goes out. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 205 Version: 3.0.3.6 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster Problem 7 The red seat belt warning lamp flashes and an intermittent audible warning sounds. Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of injury The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt. In addition, you are driving faster than 15 mph (25 km/h) or you have briefly driven faster than 15 mph (25 km/h). X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50). The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent audible warning ceases. G Risk of injury There are objects on the front-passenger seat. In addition, you are driving faster than 15 mph (25 km/h) or you have briefly driven faster than 15 mph (25 km/h). X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them in a secure place. The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent audible warning ceases. Z 205 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 206 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 206 Version: 3.0.3.6 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster Safety systems Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions ! G Risk of accident The yellow ABS warning ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) is deactivated due to a malfunction. lamp is lit while the Therefore, ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist), engine is running. EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution) and hill start assist are also deactivated. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other systems, such as the navigation system or the automatic transmission, will not be available. ! G Risk of accident The yellow ABS warning ABS is temporarily unavailable. ESP®, BAS and EBD, for example, lamp is lit while the are therefore not available either. engine is running. Self diagnosis is not yet complete. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. X Carefully drive a suitable distance making slight steering movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h). The functions mentioned above are available again when the warning lamp goes out. If the warning lamp is still on: X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 207 Version: 3.0.3.6 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster Problem äå! The yellow ESP® and ESP® OFF warning lamps and the yellow ABS warning lamp are lit while the engine is running. A warning tone also sounds. äå! The yellow ESP® and ESP® OFF warning lamps and the yellow ABS warning lamp are lit while the engine is running. ä The yellow ESP® warning lamp flashes while the vehicle is in motion. Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of accident EBD is faulty. Therefore, ABS, BAS and hill start assist are not available either, due to a malfunction. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. G Risk of accident ABS and ESP® are faulty. Therefore, BAS and hill start assist are not available either, due to a malfunction. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you brake hard, for example. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. G Risk of accident ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of skidding or at least one wheel has started to spin. Cruise control is deactivated. X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when pulling away. X Release the accelerator pedal while the vehicle is in motion. X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions. X Do not deactivate ESP®. Exceptions: (Y page 63). Z 207 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 208 Version: 3.0.3.6 208 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions ä ESP® The yellow warning lamp flashes while the vehicle is in motion. At least one wheel is spinning and ETS (Electronic Traction System) is deactivated to prevent the brakes on the drive wheels from overheating. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display. ETS switches back on again as soon as the brakes have cooled down. The display message disappears and the ä warning lamp goes out. å G Risk of accident The yellow ESP® OFF ESP® is deactivated. ESP® will not stabilize the vehicle if it starts warning lamp is lit while to skid or if a wheel starts to spin. the engine is running. X Reactivate ESP®. Exceptions: (Y page 63). X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions. If ESP® cannot be activated: X Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop. M (C 63 AMG only) G Risk of accident The yellow SPORT SPORT handling mode is activated. ESP® only stabilizes the vehicle handling mode warning in extreme situations. ESP® intervention may not be able to lamp is lit while the provide sufficient assistance in such situations, and the vehicle engine is running. may start to skid. X Reactivate ESP®. Exceptions: (Y page 63). If ESP® cannot be activated: X Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 209 Version: 3.0.3.6 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster Problem äå The yellow ESP® and ESP® OFF warning lamps are lit while the engine is running. 6 The red SRS warning lamp is lit while the engine is running. Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of accident ESP®, BAS and hill start assist are unavailable, due to a malfunction. ESP® will not stabilize the vehicle if it starts to skid or if a wheel starts to spin. The brake system continues to function normally, but without the functions listed above. X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. G Risk of injury The restraint systems are malfunctioning. The air bags or ETDs may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, not be triggered at all. X Drive on carefully. X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately. G Warning In the event a malfunction of the SRS is indicated as outlined above, the SRS may not be operational. For your safety, we strongly recommend that you contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately to have the system checked. Otherwise the SRS may not be activated when needed in an accident, which could result in serious or fatal injury, or it might deploy unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could also result in injury. Z 209 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 210 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 210 Version: 3.0.3.6 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster Engine Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions ; The yellow Check Engine warning lamp lights up while the engine is running. There may be a malfunction, for example: Rin the engine management the fuel injection system Rin the exhaust system Rin the ignition system Rthe fuel system The emission limit values may have been exceeded and the engine may be breaking in emergency mode. X Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop. Rin i In some states, you are required by law to visit a qualified specialist workshop as soon as the Check Engine warning lamp lights up. If necessary, check whether this is the case in the state you are in. 8 The fuel system pressure is too low. The fuel filler cap is not closed The yellow reserve fuel correctly or the fuel system is leaking. warning lamp flashes X Check that the fuel filler cap is correctly closed. while the engine is X If the fuel filler cap is not correctly closed: close the fuel filler running. cap. X If the fuel filler cap is closed: visit a qualified specialist workshop. 8 The amount of fuel in the tank has dropped into the reserve range. The yellow reserve fuel X Refuel at the nearest gas station. warning lamp lights up while the engine is running. ? The red coolant warning lamp lights up while the engine is running and the coolant temperature gauge is at the start of the scale. The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is faulty. The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a risk of engine damage if the coolant temperature is too high. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstances. X Engage the parking brake. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 211 Version: 3.0.3.6 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions ? The red coolant warning lamp comes on while the engine is running. The coolant level is too low. If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the radiator may be blocked or the electric radiator fan may be malfunctioning. The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled sufficiently. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. X Allow the engine and coolant to cool. X Check the coolant level and add the coolant (Y page 240). Observe the warning notes. X If the coolant needs adding more often than usual, have the engine coolant system checked. X Make sure that the air supply to the radiator is not blocked, e.g. by snow, slush or ice. X At coolant temperatures below 248 ‡ (120 †), continue driving to the next qualified specialist workshop. X Avoid subjecting the engine to heavy loads, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain, and stop-start driving. ? The red coolant warning lamp comes on while the engine is running. A warning tone also sounds. The coolant has exceeded a temperature of 248 ‡ (120 †). The airflow to the radiator may be blocked or the coolant level may be too low. The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged. X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. X Allow the engine and coolant to cool. G Warning Driving when your engine is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the engine compartment to catch fire. You could be seriously burned. Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns which can occur just by opening the engine hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it. Stop the vehicle in a safe location away from other traffic. Turn off the engine, get out of the vehicle and do not stand near the vehicle until the engine has cooled down. ! If the coolant temperature exceeds 248 ‡(120 †) do not continue driving. The engine will otherwise be damaged. Z 211 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe On-board computer and displays 212 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 212 Version: 3.0.3.6 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster Tires Problem Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions h G Risk of accident USA only: The tire pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at The yellow combination least one of the tires. low tire pressure X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking warning lamp/TPMS maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so. malfunction warning X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction lamp is lit. display. X Check the tire pressure. If necessary, correct the tire pressure (Y page 277). X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 286). h The tire pressure monitor is faulty. USA only: X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction display. The yellow combination low tire pressure X Visit a qualified specialist workshop. warning lamp/TPMS malfunction warning lamp flashes for sixty seconds and then remains lit. G Warning Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked every other week when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver's door B-pillar or, if available, the tire inflation pressure label on the inside of the fuel filler flap. If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard or, if available, the tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires. As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure warning lamp when one or more of your tires are significantly underinflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure warning lamp illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if underinflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure warning lamp. Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure warning lamp. When the system detects a malfunction, the warning lamp will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 213 Version: 3.0.3.6 Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indicator is lit, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of incompatible replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction warning lamp after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly. Z 213 On-board computer and displays BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 214 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 214 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 215 Version: 3.0.3.6 215 Vehicle equipment ............................ Loading guidelines ............................ Stowage compartments ................... Stowage areas .................................. Features ............................................. 216 216 216 217 220 Loading, stowing and features BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 216 Stowage compartments Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard Loading, stowing and features 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 216 Version: 3.0.3.6 and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. Loading guidelines G Warning! Always fasten items being carried as securely as possible using fastening materials appropriate for the weight and size of the load. In an accident, during hard braking or sudden maneuvers, loose items will be thrown around inside the vehicle. This can cause injury to vehicle occupants unless the items are securely fastened in the vehicle. To help avoid personal injury during a collision or sudden maneuver, exercise care when transporting cargo. Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than the seat backrests. The trunk is the preferred place to carry objects. Do not place anything on the rearwindow shelf. Never drive a vehicle with the trunk open. Deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may enter vehicle interior resulting in unconsciousness and death. The handling characteristics of a laden vehicle are dependent on the distribution of the load within the vehicle. For this reason, you should observe the following notes when transporting a load: RWhen transporting a load, never exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight or the permissible axle loads for the vehicle (including occupants). The values are stated on the vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar on the driver's side. RPosition heavy loads as far forwards as possible and as low down in the trunk as possible. RThe load must not protrude above the upper edge of the seat backrests. Ralways place the load against the rear or front seat backrests. Make sure that the seat backrests are securely locked into place. RAlways place the load behind unoccupied seats if possible. RSecure the load with sufficiently strong and wear-resistant tie down. Pad sharp edges for protection. Stowage compartments Important safety notes G Warning! To help avoid personal injury during a collision or sudden maneuver, exercise care when storing objects in the vehicle. Put luggage or cargo in the trunk if possible. Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than the seat backrests. Keep compartment lids closed. This will help to prevent stored objects from being thrown about and injuring vehicle occupants during Rbraking Rvehicle Ran maneuvers accident Stowage compartments in the front Glove box i Depending on the vehicle equipment, there is an AUX-IN connection or a Media Interface installed in the glove box. Media Interface is a universal interface for mobile audio equipment, e.g. for an iPod® or USB BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 217 Version: 3.0.3.6 Stowage areas 217 devices; see separate COMAND operating instructions. (Y page 127). X X To open: pull handle : and open glove box flap ;. X To close: fold glove box flap ; upwards until it engages. The glove box can only be locked and unlocked using the mechanical key. X To lock: insert the mechanical key into the lock and turn it 90° clockwise to position 2. X To unlock: insert the mechanical key into the lock and turn it 90° counter-clockwise to position 1. Stowage compartment under the armrest i A small and a large stowage compartment are located under the armrest. The small stowage compartment can be removed for emptying. To open: press left-hand button ; or righthand button :. The stowage compartment opens. Stowage compartments in the rear Stowage pockets G Warning! Storage bags are intended for storing lightweight items only. Heavy objects, objects with sharp edges or fragile objects may not be transported in the storage bag. In an accident, during hard braking, or sudden maneuvers, they could be thrown around inside the vehicle and cause injury to vehicle occupants. Storage bags cannot protect transported goods in the event of an accident. Storage bags are located in the rear compartment on the driver's and frontpassenger seat backrests. Stowage areas Parcel nets G Warning Parcel nets are intended for storing lightweight items only, such as road maps, mail, etc. Heavy objects, objects with sharp edges, or fragile objects may not be transported in the parcel nets. In an accident, during hard Z Loading, stowing and features i The glove box can be ventilated BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Stowage areas 218 Loading, stowing and features 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 218 Version: 3.0.3.6 braking, or sudden maneuvers, they could be thrown around inside the vehicle and cause injury to vehicle occupants. Parcel nets cannot protect transported goods in the event of an accident. Parcel nets are located in the front-passenger footwell and on the left-hand side of the trunk. X Pull right-hand or left-hand rear seat backrest release handle :. The corresponding rear seat backrest is released. X Fully insert the rear seat backrest head restraints. Rear bench seat through-loading feature Important safety notes G Warning! When expanding the cargo volume, always fold the seat backrests fully forward. Unless you are transporting cargo, the seat backrests must remain properly locked in the upright position. In an accident, during hard braking or sudden maneuvers, loose items will be thrown around inside the vehicle. This can cause injury to vehicle occupants unless the items are securely fastened in the vehicle. Always use the cargo tie-down rings. X Fold rear seat backrest ; forwards. X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat back if necessary. Folding the rear seat backrest back The left-hand and right-hand rear seat backrests can be folded down separately to increase the trunk capacity. Folding the rear seat backrest forward X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat forward if necessary. ! Make sure that the seat belt does not become trapped when folding the rear seat backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged. X X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat forward if necessary. X Open the trunk. Fold rear seat backrest : back until it engages. G Warning! Always lock the seat backrest in its upright position when the rear seat bench is 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 219 Version: 3.0.3.6 Stowage areas occupied, or the extended cargo volume is not in use. Check for secure locking by pushing and pulling on the seat backrest. In an accident, during hard braking or sudden maneuvers, loose items will be thrown around inside the vehicle. This can cause injury to vehicle occupants unless the items are securely fastened in the vehicle. To help avoid personal injury during a collision or sudden maneuver, exercise care when transporting cargo. i You should always engage the rear seat backrests if you do not need the throughloading feature. This will prevent unauthorized access to the trunk from the vehicle interior. X Adjust the head restraints if necessary (Y page 96). X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat back if necessary. Vehicles with through-loading feature on the rear bench seat : cargo tie down rings Bag hooks ! The bag hook can bear a maximum load of 6.6 lbs (3 kg). Do not use it to secure a load. Securing cargos Lashing eyelets Observe the following notes on securing loads: Rsecure the load using the cargo tie down rings. not use elastic straps or nets to secure a load, as these are only intended as an anti-slip protection for light loads. Rdo not route tie downs across sharp edges or corners. Rpad sharp edges for protection. There are four cargo tie down rings in the trunk. Rdo : Bag hook Stowage well under the trunk floor The TIREFIT kit, the vehicle tool kit, etc. are located in the stowage compartment. Z 219 Loading, stowing and features BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 220 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features 220 X To open: pull handle : upwards. Depending on the vehicle equipment, ensure that when the roof carrier is installed you can: Loading, stowing and features Rraise the tilt/sliding sunroof fully the panorama roof with power tilt/ sliding panel fully Ropen the trunk lid fully Ropen ! To avoid damaging or scratching the covers, do not use metallic or hard objects to open them. X Hook handle : into rain trough ;. Fastening the roof carrier ! Unhook the handle before again before closing the trunk lid and clip it in securely to prevent the handle flap from protruding. Otherwise, you could damage the handle. Roof carrier Important safety notes G Warning! Only use roof racks approved by MercedesBenz for your vehicle model to avoid damage to the vehicle. Follow the manufacturer's installation instructions. Otherwise, an improperly attached roof rack system or its load could become detached from the vehicle. Do not exceed the maximum roof load of 220 lb (100 kg). Take into consideration that when the roof rack is loaded, the handling characteristics are different from those when operating the vehicle without the roof rack loaded. ! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use roof carriers that have been tested and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles. This helps to prevent damage to the vehicle. Position the cargo on the roof rack in such a way that the vehicle will not sustain damage even when it is in motion. X Open covers : carefully in the direction of the arrow. X Fold covers : upwards. X Only secure the roof carrier to the anchorage points under covers :. X Observe the manufacturer's installation instructions. Features Cup holder Points to observe before use G Warning In order to help prevent spilling liquids on vehicle occupants and/or vehicle equipment, only use containers that fit into the cup holder. Use lids on open containers and do not fill containers to a height where the contents, especially hot liquids, could spill during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 221 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features accident. Liquids spilled on vehicle occupants may cause serious personal injury. Liquids spilled on vehicle equipment may cause damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. When not in use, keep the cup holder closed. An open cup holder may cause injury to you or others when contacted during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident. Keep in mind that objects placed in the cup holder may come loose during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident and be thrown around in the vehicle interior. Objects thrown around in the vehicle interior may cause an accident and/or serious personal injury. Cup holder in the center console X To open: raise the armrest cover. Press release catch :. Cup holder ; folds out forwards. X Swing the armrest cover back down, if necessary. X To close: raise the armrest cover. X Swing cup holder ; back until it engages. X Swing the armrest cover back down, if necessary. X Sun visors Overview of the sun visor G Warning Cup holder in the rear seat armrest Do not use the vanity mirror while driving. Keep the vanity mirrors in the sun visors closed while the vehicle is in motion. Reflected glare can endanger you and others. ! Do not sit or lean your bodyweight on the armrests when they are folded out as you could damage them. ! Only fold the armrests up when the cup holder is closed. The cup holder may otherwise be damaged. : Mirror light ; Bracket = Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket Z 221 Loading, stowing and features BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Features 222 ? Vanity mirror A Mirror cover Loading, stowing and features 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 222 Version: 3.0.3.6 Vanity mirror in the sun visor Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor is clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover A has been folded up. Glare from the side X Fold down the sun visor. Pull the sun visor out of retainer ;. X Swing the sun visor to the side. X ! Always guide the roller sunblind by hand. Do not let it snap back suddenly as this would damage the automatic roller mechanism. ! Do not drive the vehicle with the roller sunblind hooked in and the side windows opened simultaneously. The roller sunblind can jump out of the retainers and spring back suddenly when driving at high speeds, e.g. when driving on the freeway. This could damage the inertia reel. Therefore, either close the side window or retract the roller sunblind before driving at high speeds. Rear window roller sunblind (Sedan) To extend/retract the roller sunblind G Warning X Pull or push the sun visor in the direction of the arrow. Roller sunblinds for the rear side windows X To extend: pull the roller sunblind out by tab : and hook it onto retainers ; at the top of the window. When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. The children could: Rinjure themselves on parts of the vehicle seriously or fatally injured through excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with vehicle equipment that can be operated even if the SmartKey is removed from the ignition lock or removed from the vehicle, such as seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment, or the memory function If children open a door, they could injure other persons or get out of the vehicle and injure themselves or be injured by following traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very Rbe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 223 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features 223 hot, and the child could be burned on these parts. When operating the rear window sunshade make sure there is no danger of anyone being harmed by the extending or retracting procedure. The extending or retracting procedure can be immediately halted by briefly pressing rear window sunshade switch. To reverse direction of movement, press rear window sunshade switch again. ! Make sure that the roller sunblind can move freely. Otherwise, the roller sunblind or other objects could be damaged. X To open: slide cover : forwards until it engages. X To remove the insert: hold insert = by the ribbing at the sides and lift it up and out ;. X To refit the insert: press insert = into the holder until it engages. X To close: press cover : briefly at the front. The cover moves back. Ashtray in the rear compartment X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock. X To extend or retract: briefly press button :. The roller sunblind fully extends or fully retracts. X Ashtray Ashtray in the cockpit i There is a stowage space under the ashtray. ! The stowage space under the ashtray is To open: pull cover ; out by its top edge. To remove the insert: press release button = and lift the insert up and out. X To re-insert the insert: replace insert : from above. X Press insert : into the holder until it engages. X not heat resistant. Before placing lit cigarettes in the ashtray, make sure that the ashtray is properly engaged. Otherwise, the stowage space could be damaged. Z Loading, stowing and features G Warning! BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 224 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 224 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features Cigarette lighter Loading, stowing and features G Warning When leaving the vehicle, always remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child restraint system, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could result in an accident and/or serious personal injury. The children could: Rinjure themselves on parts of the vehicle Rbe seriously or fatally injured through excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with vehicle equipment that can be operated even if the SmartKey is removed from the ignition lock or removed from the vehicle, such as seat adjustment, steering wheel adjustment, or the memory function If children open a door, they could injure other persons or get out of the vehicle and injure themselves or be injured by following traffic. Do not expose the child restraint system to direct sunlight. The child restraint system's metal parts, for example, could become very hot, and the child could be burned on these parts. G Warning Never touch the heating element or sides of the lighter; they are extremely hot. Hold the knob only. Make sure any children traveling with you do not injure themselves or start a fire with the hot cigarette lighter. Center console, front X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Slide cover : forwards until it engages. X Press in cigarette lighter ;. Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot. 12 V sockets Points to observe before use ! If you are using all sockets in the vehicle, make sure that you do not exceed the maximum current draw of 55 A. Otherwise, you will overload the fuses. The socket can be used for accessories with a maximum power consumption of 180 W, e.g. lamps or chargers for mobile phones. If you use the socket for long periods when the engine is switched off, the battery may discharge. Dashboard socket The socket is installed in vehicles with audio equipment or COMAND. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 225 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features X Open the glove box (Y page 216). X Lift up the cover of socket :. An additional socket is installed in the center console on vehicles without an ashtray with cigarette lighter. X X Pull cover ; out by its top edge. Lift up the cover of socket :. 115 V socket G Warning! X To open: slide cover : forwards until it engages. X Lift up the cover of socket ;. X To close: press cover : briefly at the front. The cover moves back. Socket in the rear compartment A socket is installed in the center console in the rear compartment in vehicles with an ashtray and a cigarette lighter. The 115V AC socket operates at high voltage. Use the 115V AC socket in the vehicle with the same caution and prudence that you exercise when using power outlets at home. Keep any fluids away from the 115V AC socket. Do not clean the socket with fluids or tapered objects. Keep the 115V AC socket cover in the closed position, when not in use. Otherwise, you could suffer an electric shock and be seriously or even fatally injured. G Warning! A device that you connect must have a suitable plug that complies with U.S. standards. Never pull on the cable to unplug a plug from the 115V AC socket. Do not use a damaged connection cable. The 115V AC socket may not be connected to another 115V AC power source. Do not use converters to a grounding plug with the 115V AC socket. This could cause serious personal injury to you and/or others. G Warning! If the 115V AC socket is damaged or torn out of the trim, do not use or touch the 115V AC socket. Using a 115V AC socket that is damaged or torn out of the trim could cause serious personal injury to you and/or others. Z 225 Loading, stowing and features BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 226 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 226 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features Possible causes of malfunction: Loading, stowing and features Rthe The 115 V AC power socket : provides an alternating voltage of 115 V, so that small electronic devices can be connected. These devices, such as games consoles, chargers and laptops, should not consume more than a maximum of 150 W altogether. Requirements for operation of these devices: R12 V power sockets in the footwell of the second row of seats and in the stowage compartment must be functioning correctly (Y page 224). Rthe plug of the electronic device is plugged into the 115 V power socket :. Rthe on-board voltage is within a permissible voltage range. Rthe maximum wattage of the device to be connected must not exceed 150 W. X Open flap =. X Insert the plug of the electrical device into the 115 V power socket :. Indicator lamp ; lights up. If indicator lamp ; does not light up, please read the chapter on malfunctions. X To turn off: disconnect the plug from the 115 V power socket :. Ensure that you do not pull on the cord. X Close flap =. on-board voltage of the vehicle is not within the permissible voltage range. Rthe temperature of the DC/AC converter is momentarily too high. Rsome small electronic devices have a constant nominal power of less than 150 W, but a very high inrush current. These devices will not work. If you connect such a device, the 115 V power socket : will not supply it with power. If indicator lamp ; still does not light up, consult a specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. mbrace25 Important safety notes ! A license agreement must exist in order to activate the mbrace service. Make sure that your system is activated and ready for use, and press the ï MB info call button to register. If you cannot carry out any of the steps mentioned, the system may not be activated. If you have any questions concerning activation, please contact one of the following service hotlines: RUSA: Response Center under 866-990-9007 RCanada: Customer Service under 1-888-923-8367 Shortly after successfully registering with the mbrace service, a user ID and password will be sent to you by post. You can use this password to log in to the mbrace section under "Owners Online" at http:// www.mbusa.com26. The mbrace system is available if: Rit has been activated and is operational. Activation requires an available cellular 25 The system is called TELEAID in Canada. only. 26 USA 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 227 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features phone network, a valid SIM card and a service subscription to a surveillance service provider. Rthe battery is sufficiently charged. Rthe corresponding cellular phone network is available for transmitting data to the customer center. i Determining the location of the vehicle on a map is only possible if there is sufficient GPS reception and the vehicle position can be forwarded to the customer center. The mbrace system The mbrace system provides three different services: Rautomatic and manual emergency call Assistance call RMB info call To control the volume during an mbrace call, proceed as follows: RRoadside X Press the W or X button on the multifunction steering wheel. or X Use the volume controller of the audio system. You can find information and a description of all available features under "Owners Online" at http://www.mbusa.com27 System self-test After you have switched on the ignition, the system carries out a self-diagnosis. G Warning A malfunction in the system has been detected if any or all of the following conditions occur: RThe indicator lamp in the SOS button does not come on during the system self-test. RThe indicator lamp in Roadside Assistance button F does not come on during the system self-test. RThe indicator lamp in Information button ï does not come on during the system self-test. RThe indicator lamp in the SOS button, Roadside Assistance button F, or Information button ï remains illuminated constantly in red after the system self-test. RThe message Tele Aid Inoperative or Tele Aid Not Activated appears in the multifunction display after the system selftest. If a malfunction is indicated as outlined above, the system may not operate as expected. In case of an emergency, help will have to be summoned by other means. Have the system checked at the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or contact the following service hotlines: RUSA: Response Center under the number 866-990-9007 RCanada: Customer Service under 1-888-923-8367. Emergency call Important safety notes ! A license agreement must exist in order to activate the mbrace service. Make sure that your system is activated and ready for use, and press the ï MB info call button to register. If you cannot carry out any of the steps mentioned, the system may not be activated. 27 USA 227 only. Z Loading, stowing and features BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 228 Features If you have any questions concerning activation, please contact one of the following service hotlines: RUSA: Loading, stowing and features 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 228 Version: 3.0.3.6 Response Center under 866-990-9007 RCanada: Customer Service under 1-888-923-8367 An emergency call is dialed automatically if an air bag or Emergency Tensioning Device is triggered. established, then the mbrace system could not initiate an emergency call (e.g. the relevant cellular phone network is not available). The message Call Failed appears in the multifunction display for approximately 10 seconds. Should this occur, assistance must be summoned by other means. Making an emergency call i An automatically dialed mbrace emergency call cannot be canceled. An emergency call can also be dialed manually. Once the emergency call is in progress, the indicator lamp in the SOS button flashes. The Connecting Call message appears in the multifunction display. COMAND is muted. Once a connection has been established, the Call Connected message appears in the multifunction display. All important information on the emergency is compiled, for example: Rcurrent location of the vehicle (as determined by the GPS system) Rvehicle model Rvehicle color Rvehicle identification number A voice connection between the Response Center and the occupants of the vehicle will be established automatically soon after the emergency call has been initiated. If the vehicle occupants are responsive, the Response Center attempts to get more information on the emergency. i If no vehicle occupant answers, an ambulance is immediately sent to the vehicle. G Warning If the indicator lamp in the SOS button is flashing continuously and there was no voice connection to the Response Center X To initiate an emergency call manually: press cover : briefly to open. X Press SOS button ; briefly. The indicator lamp in SOS button ; flashes until the emergency call is ended. X Wait for the voice connection with the Response Center. X After the emergency call is ended, close cover :. G Warning If you feel at any way in jeopardy when in the vehicle (e.g. smoke or fire in the vehicle, vehicle in a dangerous road location), please do not wait for voice contact after you have pressed the SOS button. Carefully leave the vehicle and move to a safe location. The Response Center will automatically contact local emergency officials with the vehicle's approximate location if they receive an automatic SOS signal and cannot make voice contact with the vehicle occupants. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 229 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features Roadside Assistance call button Mercedes-Benz technician or organizes for your vehicle to be transported to the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. You may be charged for services such as repair work and/or towing. Further details are available in your mbrace manual. i If the indicator lamp in MB info call X Press and hold Roadside Assistance button : for more than two seconds. A call to a Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Representative is initiated. The indicator lamp in Roadside Assistance button : flashes while the call is active. The Connecting Call message appears in the multifunction display and the audio system or COMAND is muted. If a connection can be established, the Call Connected message appears in the multifunction display. If a mobile phone network is available and there is sufficient GPS reception, the mbrace system transmits data to the Response Center, for example: Rcurrent location of the vehicle Rvehicle identification number Rvehicle model Rvehicle color button : flashes continuously and it was not possible to establish a voice connection to the Response Center, then the mbrace system has failed to initiate a Roadside Assistance call (e.g. the corresponding cellular phone network is not available). The Call Failed message appears in the multifunction display. X To end a call: press the ~ button on the multifunction steering wheel. or X Press the corresponding button for ending a phone call on the audio system or on COMAND. i Sign and Drive services28: you are not charged for services such as jump-starting, providing a few gallons of fuel for a fuel tank that has been run dry or changing a flat tire with the vehicle's own spare tire. MB Info call button i The audio system or COMAND display shows that an mbrace call is active. You can switch to the navigation menu by pressing the NAVI button on COMAND during the call. Spoken commands are not available. A voice connection is established between the Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Representative and the vehicle occupants. X Describe the type of assistance needed. The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Representative either sends a qualified 28 USA only. Z 229 Loading, stowing and features BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Features 230 X Loading, stowing and features 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 230 Version: 3.0.3.6 Press and hold MB info call button : for more than two seconds. A call to the Response Center is initiated. MB info call button indicator lamp : flashes while the connection is being established. The Connecting Call message appears in the multifunction display and COMAND is muted. If a connection can be established, the Call Connected message appears in the multifunction display. If a mobile phone network is available and there is sufficient GPS reception, the mbrace system transmits data to the Response Center, for example: Rcurrent location of the vehicle identification number Rvehicle model Rvehicle color Rvehicle i The audio system or COMAND display shows that an mbrace call is active. You can switch to the navigation menu by pressing the NAVI button on COMAND during the call. Spoken commands are not available. A voice connection between the Response Center and the vehicle occupants is established. You can obtain information on how to operate your vehicle's systems, on the location of the nearest authorized MercedesBenz Center, and on further products and services offered by Mercedes-Benz USA. Further details on the mbrace system can be found under http://www.mbusa.com29. Log in under "Owners Online". i If the indicator lamp in MB info call button : flashes continuously and no voice connection to the Response Center has been established, then the mbrace system has failed to initiate an MB info call (e.g. the corresponding mobile phone network is not available). The Call Failed message appears in the multifunction display. 29 USA only. X To end a call: press the ~ button on the multifunction steering wheel. or X Press the corresponding button for ending a phone call on the audio system or on COMAND. Call priority An emergency call can still be initiated even if a service call is currently active, e.g. a Roadside Assistance call or an MB info call. In this case, an emergency call will take priority and override all other active calls. The indicator lamp of the respective button flashes until the call is ended. An emergency call can only be terminated by the Response Center. All other calls can be ended by pressing the ~ button on the multifunction steering wheel or the corresponding button for ending a telephone call on the audio system or on COMAND. i When an mbrace call has been initiated, the audio system or COMAND is muted. The mobile phone is no longer connected to COMAND. If you must use your mobile phone, we recommend that you do this only when the vehicle is stationary and in a safe location. Downloading destinations in COMAND Destination Download gives you access to a database with over 10 million points of interest (POIs) which can be downloaded to the navigation system of your vehicle. If you know the destination, you can download the address or obtain the location of points of interest (POIs) or important destinations in the surrounding area. You are prompted to confirm route guidance to the entered address. The system calculates the route and subsequently starts the route guidance with the address entered. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 231 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features command for vehicle remote unlocking has been received. If you pull the trunk handle for more than 20 seconds before receiving authorization for remote unlocking, you must wait 15 minutes before you can pull on the handle of the trunk lid again. i If you select No, the address can be stored in the address book. i The Destination Download function is available if the corresponding cellular phone network is available and data transfer is possible. Search & Send "Search & Send" is a destination entry service. You can find further information on "Search & Send" in the separate COMAND operating instructions. Vehicle remote opening If you have unintentionally locked your vehicle (e.g. the SmartKey is inside the vehicle) and a replacement key is not available: X Contact the following service hotlines: RUSA: Response Center under the number 866-990-9007 RCanada: Customer Service under 1-888-923-8367 You will be asked for your password. X Return to your vehicle at the time arranged with the Response Center. X Pull the trunk handle for at least 20 seconds until the indicator lamp in the SOS button (Y page 227) flashes. The Connecting Call message appears in the multifunction display. Alternatively, the vehicle can also be opened via the Internet in the "Owners Online" section using your ID number and password30. i Vehicle remote unlocking is only possible if the corresponding cellular phone network is accessible. The SOS button flashes and the Connecting Call message appears in the multifunction display to confirm that the 30 USA Remote vehicle locking in an emergency If you forget to lock your vehicle but are no longer in the vicinity of the vehicle, it can be locked for you by the Response Center. The vehicle can be locked remotely up to four days after the ignition was last switched off. X Contact the following service hotlines: RUSA: Response Center under 866-990-9007 RCanada: Customer Service under 1-888-923-8367 You will be asked for your PIN. The next time you are in your vehicle and switch on the ignition, the Tele Aid Doors locked by remote control message appears in the multifunction display. i The vehicle remote locking feature is available when the relevant mobile phone network is available and data connection is possible. Stolen Vehicle Recovery Services If your vehicle has been stolen: X Contact the police. The police will issue an incident report. This report has a number. X This number will be forwarded to the Response Center together with your PIN. The Response Center will then attempt to covertly contact the mbrace system. The Response Center contacts you and the local law enforcement authority if the vehicle is located. However, only the law only. Z 231 Loading, stowing and features BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 232 Features enforcement authority is informed of the location of the vehicle. i If the anti-theft alarm system remains Loading, stowing and features 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 232 Version: 3.0.3.6 activated for longer than thirty seconds, mbrace is automatically connected to the Customer Assistance Center. Garage door opener Important safety notes Up to three different door and gate systems can be operated using the remote control integrated in the overhead control panel. i Certain garage door openers are not compatible with the integrated remote control. If you experience difficulties with the programming of the integrated remote control, contact an authorized MercedesBenz Center or call the following telephone assistance service: RUSA: Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center on 1-800-FOR-MERCedes RCanada: Customer Service on1-800-387-0100 G Warning Before programming the integrated remote control to a garage door opener or gate operator, make sure people and objects are out of the way of the device to prevent potential harm or damage. When programming a garage door opener, the door moves up or down. When programming a gate operator, the gate opens or closes. Do not use the integrated remote control with any garage door opener that lacks safety stop and reverse features as required by U.S. federal safety standards (this includes any garage door opener model manufactured before April 1, 1982). A garage door that cannot detect an object - signaling the door to stop and reverse - does not meet current U.S. federal safety standards. When programming a garage door opener, park vehicle outside the garage. Do not run the engine while programming the integrated remote control. Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your health. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and possible death. All exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness and possible death. i USA only: This device complies with part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. The device must not cause harmful interference. 2. The device must withstand any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Unauthorized modification of this device could void the device's operating permit. i Canada only: This device complies with the RSS-210 requirements of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. The device must not cause harmful interference. 2. The device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Unauthorized modification of this device could void the user's authority to legally operate the device. Programming the remote control Programming G Warning! Only press the transmitter button on the integrated remote control if there are no persons or objects present within the sweep BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 233 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features i The distance between garage door remote control A and the integrated garage door opener depends on the system of the garage door drive. You might require several attempts. You should test every position for at least 20 seconds before trying another position. X Remote control in the rear-view mirror Garage door remote control A is not part of the garage door opener. i To achieve the best result, insert new batteries in garage door remote control A of your garage door drive before programming. X Erase the memory of the integrated remote control (Y page 235) before programming it for the first time. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Press and hold one of transmitter buttons ; to ? on the integrated remote control. After a short time, indicator lamp : will start flashing. It flashes about once per second. i Indicator lamp : flashes immediately the first time that the transmitter button is programmed. If this transmitter button has already been programmed, indicator lamp : will only start flashing at a rate of once per second after 20 seconds have elapsed. X X Keep the transmitter button depressed. Point transmitter button B of garage door remote control A towards the transmitter buttons on the rear-view mirror from a distance of 2 to 12 inches (5 to 20 cm). Keep transmitter button B on garage door remote control A pressed until indicator lamp : starts to flash rapidly. The programming has been successful if indicator lamp : flashes rapidly. X Release transmitter buttons ;, = or ? on the integrated remote control or transmitter button on the garage door remote control B. If indicator lamp : goes out after approximately 20 seconds and has not flashed rapidly: X Release transmitter buttons ;, = or ? on the integrated remote control or transmitter button on the garage door remote control B. X Repeat the procedure for the other transmitter buttons. When doing so, vary the distance between the garage door's remote control and the transmitter buttons in the rear-view mirror. i If the garage door system works with a rolling code, you must synchronize the remote control integrated into the rearview mirror with the garage door system receiver after programming. You will find further information in the garage door opening system's operating instructions, e.g. the sections on "Synchronizing the transmitter" or "Registering a new transmitter". You can also call the hotline mentioned above. Notes on programming the remote control Canadian radio frequency laws require transmitter signals to "time-out" (or quit) after several seconds of transmission. This may Z Loading, stowing and features of the garage door. People could otherwise be injured by the movement of the door. 233 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Loading, stowing and features 234 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 234 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features not be long enough for the integrated signal transmitter to pick up the signal during programming. Similar to this Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are designed to "time-out" in the same manner. If you live in Canada or have difficulties programming the garage door opener (regardless of where you live) when using the programming steps (see above), proceed as follows: X Press transmitter button (;, = or ?) and hold it down during the following steps until the setup has been completed successfully. X At the same time, press transmitter button B of the garage door remote control for two seconds, then release it for two seconds, then press it again for two seconds. X Repeat this sequence on transmitter button B of the garage door remote control until the frequency signal has been learned. X If the setup procedure is successful, indicator lamp : flashes once slowly and goes out after a few seconds. X Continue with the other programming steps (see above). Problems when programming If you have problems when programming the integrated remote control, please note the following: Rcheck the transmitter frequency of garage door remote control A (which can usually be found on the rear of the remote control). The integrated remote control is compatible with equipment that operates in the frequency range 280 to 390 MHz. Rreplace the batteries in garage door remote control A. This increases the likelihood of garage door remote control A sending a strong and precise signal to the integrated remote control on the rear-view mirror. RWhen aiming the garage door remote control at the transmitter buttons on the rear-view mirror, hold garage door remote control A at differing distances and angles from the transmitter button that you are programming. Try different angles from a distance of 2 to 12 inches (5 to 30 cm) or the same angle from differing distances. RIf there is another garage door remote control for the same device, perform the programming steps again using the remote control. Before performing these steps, make sure that new batteries have been installed in the garage door remote control. RAlign the antenna cable of the garage door opener unit. This can improve signal reception/transmission. Opening or closing the garage door Once programmed, the integrated remote control will assume the function of the garage door system's remote control. Please also read the operating instructions for the garage door system. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Press transmitter button ;, = or ? in the overhead control panel that you have programmed to operate the garage door. Garage door system with fixed code: indicator lamp : lights up continuously. Garage door system with rolling code: indicator lamp : flashes briefly and then lights up for approximately two seconds. This is repeated for up to 20 seconds. i The transmitter will transmit a signal for as long as the transmitter button is being pressed. The transmission will be halted after a maximum of 20 seconds and indicator lamp : will flash. Press the transmitter button again, if necessary. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 235 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features 235 Clearing the remote control memory X Loading, stowing and features Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Press and hold transmitter buttons ; and ? for approximately 20 seconds until indicator lamp : flashes rapidly. The memory is cleared. i You should clear the remote control memory before selling the vehicle. Compass Zone map for North America To obtain correct direction display in rearview mirror :, the compass must be calibrated and the magnetic field zone set. X To call up the compass: briefly press button =. The compass indicates the direction in which the vehicle is currently driving: N, NE, E, SE, S, SW, W or NW. X To calibrate the compass: determine your position using the following the zone maps. Zone map for South America X Press and hold button = for approximately three seconds. The currently selected zone appears in compass display ;. X To select the zone: press button = repeatedly until the desired zone is selected. The zone has been selected when compass display ; shows the point of the compass. This takes a few seconds. X To calibrate the compass: make sure that there is sufficient space for you to drive in Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 236 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 236 Version: 3.0.3.6 Features Loading, stowing and features a circle without impeding the remaining traffic. In order to calibrate the compass correctly, observe the following points: Rcalibrate the compass in the open and not in the vicinity of steel structures or highvoltage power lines Rswitch off electrical consumers such as climate control, the windscreen wipers or the rear window heating Rclose all doors and the trunk lid X Switch on the ignition. X Press and hold button = for approximately six seconds until the C symbol appears in compass display ;. X Drive a full circle at approximately 3 mph (5 km/h) to 6 mph (10 km/h). Once the calibration has been successfully completed, the current heading appears in compass display ;. Floormat on the driver's side G Warning! Whenever you are using a floormat, make sure there is enough clearance and that the floormat is securely fastened. The floormat should always be securely fastened using the fastening equipment. Before driving off, check that the floormat is securely in place and adjust it if necessary. A loose floormat could slip and hinder proper functioning of the pedals. Do not place several floormats on top of each other as this may impair pedal movement. X Slide seat backwards. To install: place the floormat in position. X Press floormat eyelets : onto retainer pins ;. X X To remove: pull the floormats off retainers ;. X Remove the floormat. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 237 Version: 3.0.3.6 237 Vehicle equipment ............................ Engine compartment ........................ Maintenance ...................................... Care .................................................... 238 238 242 243 Maintenance and care BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 238 Engine compartment Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. Maintenance and care 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 238 Version: 3.0.3.6 Engine compartment Hood Opening the hood G Warning Do not pull the release lever while the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, the hood could be forced open by passing air flow. This could cause the hood to come loose and injure you and/or others. G Warning Do not open the hood when the engine is overheated. You could be seriously injured. Observe the coolant temperature gauge to determine whether the engine may be overheated. If you see flames or smoke coming from the engine compartment, move away from the vehicle. Wait until the engine has cooled. If necessary, call the fire department. G Warning There is a risk of injury if the hood is open, even if the engine is not running. Some engine components can become very hot. To avoid the risk of burns, only touch those components described in the Operator's Manual and observe the relevant safety notes. G Warning To help prevent personal injury, stay clear of moving parts when the hood is open and the engine is running. The radiator fan may continue to run for approximately 30 seconds or may even restart after the engine has been turned off. Stay clear of fan blades. G Warning The engine is equipped with a transistorized ignition system. Because of the high voltage, it is dangerous to touch any components (ignition coils, spark plug sockets, diagnostic socket) of the ignition system: Rwith the engine running starting the engine Rwhen the ignition is switched on and the engine is turned manually Rwhile X Make sure that the windshield wipers are switched off. G Warning The windshield wipers and wiper linkage could be set in motion. When the hood is open, you or others could be injured by the wiper linkage. Make sure that the windshield wipers are switched off. Remove the SmartKey or make sure that no ignition position has been selected with KEYLESS-GO. All indicator lamps must be off in the instrument cluster. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 239 Version: 3.0.3.6 Engine compartment Pull release lever : on the hood. The hood is released. ! Make sure that the windshield wipers are not folded away from the windshield. You could otherwise damage the windshield wipers or the hood. Engine oil Notes on the oil level Depending on the driving style, the vehicle consumes up to 0.9 US qt (0.8 l) of oil over a distance of 600 miles (1000 km). The oil consumption may be higher than this when the vehicle is new or if you frequently drive at high engine speeds. When checking the oil level: Rpark the vehicle on a level surface. engine should be switched off for at least five minutes if the engine is at normal operating temperature. Rthe engine should be switched off for at least 30 minutes if it is not at normal operating temperature (i.e. if you only start the engine briefly). Rthe X Reach into the gap, pull hood catch handle ; up and lift the hood. Closing the hood Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick G Warning When closing the hood, use extreme caution not to catch hands or fingers. Be careful that you do not close the hood on anyone. Make sure the hood is securely engaged before driving off. Do not continue driving if the hood can no longer engage after an accident, for example. The hood could otherwise come loose while the vehicle is in motion and injure you and/or others. X Lower the hood and let it fall from a height of approximately 8 inches (20 cm). X Check that the hood has engaged properly. If the hood can be raised slightly, it is not properly engaged. Open it again and close it with a little more force. X Pull oil dipstick : out of the dipstick guide tube. X Wipe off oil dipstick :. X Slowly insert oil dipstick : into the dipstick guide tube to the stop, and take it out again. The oil level is correct if the level is between MIN mark = and MAX mark ;. X Add oil if necessary. Z Maintenance and care X 239 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 240 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 240 Version: 3.0.3.6 Engine compartment Adding engine oil H Environmental note When adding oil, take care not to spill any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is harmful to the environment. Maintenance and care ! Only use engine oils and oil filters which have been approved for vehicles with a service system. A list of the engine oils and oil filters that have been tested and approved according to the Mercedes-Benz specifications for service products can be found on the Internet at http:// www.mbusa.com (USA only). Further information on tested and approved engine oils and oil filters can be obtained from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The following causes engine failure or damage to the exhaust system: Rusing engine oils and oil filters that are not specifically approved for the service system Rreplacing the engine oil and oil filter later than the specified replacement interval required by the service system Rusing engine oil additives Engine oil cap (AMG vehicles) X Turn cap : counter-clockwise and remove it. X Add the amount of oil required. Fill carefully to the maximum mark on the oil dipstick. i The difference in quantity between the MIN mark and the MAX mark on the dipstick is (depending on the engine) approximately 1.6 to 2.1 US qt. (1.5 to 2 l). ! Do not add too much oil. If the oil level is above the MAX mark on the dipstick, too much oil has been added. This can lead to damage to the engine or the catalytic converter. Have excess oil siphoned off. Further information on engine oil (Y page 308). X Replace cap : on the filler neck and tighten clockwise. Ensure that the cap locks into place securely. Checking and adding other service products Example: engine oil cap Checking the coolant level Only check the coolant level when the vehicle is on a level surface and the engine has cooled down. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2(Y page 131) in the ignition lock. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 241 Version: 3.0.3.6 Engine compartment G Warning In order to avoid any potentially serious burns: Ruse extreme caution when opening the hood if there are any signs of steam or coolant leaking from the cooling system, or if the coolant temperature display indicates that the coolant is overheated. Rdo not remove the pressure cap on the coolant reservoir if the coolant temperature is above 158 ‡ (70 †). Allow the engine to cool down before removing the cap. The coolant reservoir contains hot fluid and is under pressure. Rusing a rag, slowly turn the cap approximately 1/2 turn to relieve excess pressure. If opened immediately, scalding hot fluid and steam will be blown out under pressure. Rdo not spill antifreeze on hot engine parts. Antifreeze contains ethylene glycol which may burn if it comes into contact with hot engine parts. X Slowly turn cap : half a turn counterclockwise and allow excess pressure to escape. X Turn cap : further counter-clockwise and remove it. If the coolant is at the level of marker bar = in the filler neck when cold, there is enough coolant in coolant expansion tank ;. If the coolant is approximately 0.6 in (1.5 cm) higher when warm, there is enough coolant in coolant expansion tank ;. X If necessary, add coolant which has been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. X Replace cap : and turn it clockwise as far as it will go. For further information on coolant, see (Y page 310). Windshield washer system/headlamp cleaning system The washer fluid reservoir is used for both the windshield washer system and the headlamp cleaning system. G Warning Washer solvent/antifreeze is highly flammable. Do not spill washer solvent/ antifreeze on hot engine parts, because it may ignite and burn. You could be seriously burned. ! At temperatures below freezing, always fill the washer fluid container with a mix of windshield washer concentrate and antifreeze additive. There is otherwise a risk of damaging the windshield washer system/headlamp cleaning system. ! Only use washer fluid concentrate which is suitable for plastic lenses. Unsuitable washer fluid concentrate could damage the plastic lenses of the headlamps. ! Do not add distilled or de-ionized water to the washer fluid container. Otherwise, the Z Maintenance and care On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the Start/Stop button twice (Y page 132). X Check the coolant temperature display in the instrument cluster. The coolant temperature must be below 158 ‡ (70 †). 241 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Maintenance 242 fluid level measuring gauge could be damaged. i Add windshield washer concentrate, e.g. MB SummerFit, to the washer fluid all year round. Maintenance and care 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 242 Version: 3.0.3.6 Example: washer fluid reservoir X Mix the windshield washer fluid in a container beforehand. X At temperatures above freezing: fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mix of water and windshield washer concentrate (e.g. MB SummerFit). X At temperatures below freezing: fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mix of water and MB SummerFit windshield washer concentrate. For information on the mixing ratio, see (Y page 310) or use the premixed windshield washer solution with antifreeze available in specialist stores. X To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab. Add the premixed washer fluid. X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck until it engages. X Brake fluid level ! If you discover that the brake fluid level in the brake fluid reservoir has fallen to the MIN mark or below, check the brake system for leaks immediately. Also check the brake lining thickness. Contact a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately. Do not top up the brake fluid. This will not rectify the malfunction. Only check the brake fluid level when the vehicle is stationary and on a level surface. The brake fluid level is correct if it is between MIN marking ; and MAX marking : on the brake fluid reservoir. Maintenance Service interval display Service messages Information about the type of service and service intervals (see separate Service Booklet) You can obtain more information at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or at www.mbusa.com (USA only). The service interval display informs you of the next service due date. If a service is overdue, you will also hear a warning tone. The multifunction display shows a service message for a few seconds, e.g. Next Service A in .. mls Service A due Service A Exceeded By .. mls The letter indicates which service is due. A stands for a minor service and B for a major service. A number or another letter may be displayed after the letter. This figure indicates any necessary additional maintenance work to be performed. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 243 Version: 3.0.3.6 Care You can obtain further information at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The service interval display does not take into account any periods of time during which the battery is disconnected. Maintaining the time-dependent service schedule: X Before disconnecting the battery, call up the service due date in the multifunction display and note it down. or X Subtract the battery disconnection periods from the service date shown on the display after reconnecting the battery. Hiding the service message X Press % or a on the steering wheel. Displaying the service message X Switch on the ignition. Press = or ; to select the Service menu on the steering wheel. X Press 9 or : to select the ASSYST PLUS submenu and press a to confirm. The service due date appears in the multifunction display. X Points to remember A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, will reset the service interval display after the necessary service work has been carried out. You can obtain more information, e.g. on maintenance work, at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or directly at Mercedes-Benz. ! If the service interval indicator has been inadvertently reset, this setting can be corrected at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Have the service work carried out as described in the Service Booklet. There may otherwise be increased wear, resulting 243 in damage to the vehicle or to the major assemblies. Care Notes on care Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for retaining the quality in the long term. Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by MercedesBenz. G Warning Many cleaning products can be hazardous. Some are poisonous, others are flammable. Always follow the instructions on the particular container. Always open your vehicle's doors or windows when cleaning the inside. Never use fluids or solvents that are not designed for cleaning your vehicle. Always lock away cleaning products and keep them out of reach of children. ! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any of the following: Rdry, rough or hard cloths cleaning agents Rsolvents Rcleaning agents containing solvents Do not scrub. Do not touch the surfaces or protective films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice scraper. You could otherwise scratch or damage the surfaces and protective film. Rabrasive H Environmental note Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning cloths in an environmentally responsible manner. ! Do not park the vehicle for an extended period right after cleaning it, particularly after having cleaned the wheels with wheel cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause increased corrosion of the brake discs and Z Maintenance and care BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 244 Care brake pads/linings. Generally, park the vehicle at operating temperature after cleaning. Exterior care Automatic car wash G Warning! Maintenance and care 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 244 Version: 3.0.3.6 Braking efficiency is reduced after washing the vehicle. This could cause an accident. For this reason, you must drive particularly carefully after washing the vehicle until the brakes have dried. You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car wash from the very start. ! Never clean your vehicle in a Touchless Automatic Car Wash as these use special cleaning agents. These cleaning agents can damage the paintwork or plastic parts. If the vehicle is very dirty, pre-wash it before cleaning it in an automatic car wash. ! In car washes with a towing mechanism, make sure that the automatic transmission is in transmission position N, otherwise the vehicle could be damaged. ! Make sure that the side windows are completely closed, that the ventilation/ heating is switched off and that the windshield wiper switch is set to 0. Otherwise, the rain/light sensor could be activated, triggering unintended wiper movements. This can cause damage to the vehicle. Also, clean the insides of the wheels when washing the underbody of the vehicle. X Do not use hot water and do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight. X Use a soft car sponge for cleaning. X Use a gentle cleaning agent, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz approved car shampoo. X Wash down the vehicle with a gentle water jet. X Do not point the water jet directly at the air inlets. X Use plenty of water and rinse the sponge frequently. X Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry it thoroughly with a chamois. X Do not allow the cleaning agent to dry on the paintwork. Power washers G Warning! Do not use power washers with circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) to clean your vehicle, in particular the tires. You could otherwise damage the tires and cause an accident. ! Keep the distance between the vehicle and the nozzle of the power washer at 11.8 in (30 cm). Information about the correct distance is available from the equipment manufacturer. Move the power washer nozzle around when cleaning your vehicle. Do not aim directly at any of the following: Rtires After using an automatic car wash, wipe off wax from the windshield and the wiper blades. This will prevent smears and reduce wiping noises caused by residue on the windshield. Rdoor joint Washing by hand Rseals Carefully remove all deposits of road salt as soon as possible when driving in winter. Rventilation Relectrical components Rbattery Rconnectors Rlights Rtrim elements slots 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 245 Version: 3.0.3.6 Care Damaged seals or electrical components can lead to leaks or failures. Cleaning the wheels ! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products to remove brake dust. This could damage wheel bolts and brake components. ! Do not park the vehicle for an extended period right after cleaning it, particularly after having cleaned the wheels with wheel cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause increased corrosion of the brake discs and brake pads/linings. For this reason, you should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and brake pads, thus drying them. The vehicle can then be parked up. Cleaning the paintwork Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected by corrosion and damage caused by inadequate care cannot always be completely repaired. In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. X Remove impurities immediately, where possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard. X Soak insect remains with insect remover and rinse off the treated areas afterwards. X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse off the treated areas afterwards. X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resin, oils, fuels and greases by rubbing gently with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or lighter fluid. X Use tar remover to remove tar stains. X Use silicone remover to remove wax. ! Do not affix: Rstickers If water no longer forms "beads" on the painted surface, paint care products should be used that have been approved and recommended by Mercedes-Benz. This is the case approximately every three to five months, depending on climatic conditions and the care product used. If dirt has entered the paint surface or the paintwork has become dull, a paint cleaner should be used that has been approved and recommended by Mercedes-Benz. Never use such care products in direct sunlight or on a hot hood. X Use a suitable touch-up stick, e.g. MB Touch Up stick, for quick, temporary repair of damaged paintwork. Matte finish care If your vehicle has a clear matte finish, observe the following instructions in order to avoid damage to the paintwork due to incorrect care. ! Never polish the vehicle. Polishing causes the finish to shine. ! Do not use paintwork cleaner, grinding or polishing products or gloss preservers such as wax. These products are only suitable for high-gloss surfaces. Using them on vehicles with matte paintwork can cause severe damage to the surface (shiny, mottled patches). Always have paintwork repairs performed at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. ! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax treatment under any circumstances. i Use only insect remover and car shampoo from the range of recommended and approved Mercedes-Benz care products. Rfilms Rmagnetic plates or similar items to painted surfaces. You could otherwise damage the paintwork. Z 245 Maintenance and care BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 246 Version: 3.0.3.6 Care 246 Cleaning the windows ! Only fold the windshield wipers away from the windshield when vertical. Otherwise, you will damage the hood. G Warning Maintenance and care Switch off the windshield wipers and remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock before cleaning the windshield or the wiper blades. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the Start/Stop button repeatedly until all indicator lamps in the instrument cluster have gone off. The windshield wipers could otherwise move and injure you. ! Only fold the windshield wipers away from the windshield when vertical. Otherwise, you will damage the hood. X Clean the inside and outside of the windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning agent that is recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz. ! Do not pull the wiper blade. Otherwise, the wiper blade could be damaged. ! Do not clean wiper blades too often and do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the graphite coating could be damaged. This could cause wiper noise. X Fold the wiper arms away from the windshield. X Carefully clean the wiper blades with a damp cloth. X Fold the windshield wipers back again before switching on the ignition. ! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding back. The windshield could be damaged if the wiper arm smacks against it suddenly. ! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products, solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows. Do not use hard objects to clean the insides of the windows, e.g. an ice scraper or ring. There is otherwise a risk of damaging the windows. ! Clean the water drainage channels of the windshield and the rear window at regular intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This can lead to corrosion damage and damage to electronic components. Cleaning the wiper blades G Warning Switch off the windshield wipers and remove the SmartKey from the ignition lock before cleaning the windshield or the wiper blades. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the Start/Stop button repeatedly until all indicator lamps in the instrument cluster have gone off. The windshield wipers could otherwise move and injure you. Cleans the headlamps X Clean the plastic lamp lenses on the headlamps using a wet sponge and a mild cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or cleaning cloths. ! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning cloths which are suitable for plastic headlamp lenses. Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning cloths could scratch or damage the plastic headlamp lenses. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 247 Version: 3.0.3.6 Care Cleaning the sensors 247 Cleaning the exhaust tail pipes Impurities combined with the effects of road grit and corrosive environmental factors may cause flash rust to form on the surface. You can restore the original shine of the exhaust tail pipe by cleaning it regularly, especially in winter and after washing. ! Do not clean the exhaust tail pipes with X X Clean the exhaust tail pipes with a chrome care product tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Interior care Clean sensors : of the driving systems with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth. ! When cleaning the sensors with a power washer, maintain a distance between the vehicle and the nozzle of the power washer of at least 11.8 in (30 cm). Information about the correct distance is available from the equipment manufacturer. Cleaning the rear view camera Cleaning the display X Before cleaning the display, make sure that it is switched off and has cooled down. X Clean the display surface using a commercially-available microfiber cloth and TFT/LCD display cleaner. X Dry the display surface using a dry microfiber cloth. ! For cleaning, do not use any of the following: Ralcohol-based thinner or gasoline cleaning agents Rcommercially-available household cleaning agents These may damage the display surface. Do not put pressure on the display surface when cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display. Rabrasive X Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean camera lens :. ! Do not clean the camera lens and the area around the rear view camera with a power washer. Cleaning the plastic trim G Warning! When cleaning the steering wheel boss and dashboard, do not use cockpit sprays or cleaning agents containing solvents. Cleaning agents containing solvents cause the surface to become porous, and as a result, plastic Z Maintenance and care alkaline-based cleaning agents, such as wheel cleaner. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Care 248 parts may break away and be thrown around the interior when an air bag is deployed, which may result in severe injuries. ! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces: Rstickers Rfilms Rscented oil bottles or similar items You can otherwise damage the plastic. Maintenance and care 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 248 Version: 3.0.3.6 ! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent or sunscreen to come into contact with the plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality look of the surfaces. X Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfiber cloth. X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning products recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz. The surface may change color temporarily. Wait until the surface is dry again. Cleaning the steering wheel and gear or selector lever X Wash thoroughly with a damp cloth or use a leather care agent that has been recommended and approved by MercedesBenz. Cleaning real wood and trim strips X Wipe the wooden trim and trim strips with a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfiber cloth. X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning products recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz. ! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of damaging the surface. ! Do not use chrome polish for trim strips. The trim strips have a chrome look but are mostly made of anodized aluminum and can lose their shine if chrome polish is used. Use a damp, lint-free cloth instead when cleaning the trim strips. Chrome polish can be used to remove very heavy soiling from trim strips which you are sure are made of chrome. If you are unsure as to whether a trim strip is chrome-plated or not, consult an authorized MercedesBenz Center. Cleaning the seat covers ! Do not use microfiber cloths to clean genuine leather, artificial leather or Alcantara® covers. If used often, these can damage the cover. ! Observe the following when cleaning: Rclean genuine leather covers carefully with a damp cloth and then wipe the covers down with a dry cloth. Make sure that the leather does not become soaked. It may otherwise become rough and cracked. Only use leather care agents that have been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. You can obtain these from a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized MercedesBenz Center. Rclean artificial leather covers with a cloth moistened with a solution containing 1% detergent (e.g. dish washing liquid). Rclean cloth covers with a microfiber cloth moistened with a solution containing 1% detergent (e.g. dish washing liquid). Rub carefully and always wipe entire seat sections to avoid leaving visible lines. Leave the seat to dry afterwards. Cleaning results depend on the type of dirt and how long it has been there. Rclean Alcantara® covers with a damp cloth. Make sure you wipe entire seat sections to avoid leaving visible lines. i Note that regular care is essential to ensure that the appearance and comfort of the covers is retained over time. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 249 Version: 3.0.3.6 Care 249 Cleaning the seat belts X Use clean, luke-warm water and soap solution. ! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts by warming them above 176 ‡ (80 †) or placing them in direct sunlight. G Warning Maintenance and care Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may severely weaken them. In a crash, they may not be able to provide adequate protection. Cleaning the roof lining and carpets X Roof lining: use soft brushes or dry shampoo if it is particularly dirty. X Carpets: use carpet and textile cleaners that have been approved and recommended by Mercedes-Benz. Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 250 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 250 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 251 Version: 3.0.3.6 251 Vehicle equipment ............................ After an accident .............................. Where will I find...? ........................... Flat tire .............................................. Battery ............................................... Jump-starting .................................... Towing and tow-starting .................. Fuses .................................................. 252 253 253 254 259 262 264 266 Breakdown assistance BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 252 Vehicle equipment Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard Breakdown assistance and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 252 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 253 Version: 3.0.3.6 Where will I find...? 253 After an accident Fuel is leaking from the vehicle. Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions G Risk of explosion or fire The fuel line or the fuel tank is faulty. X Immediately turn the key to position 0(Y page 131)in the ignition lock and remove it. X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. You are unable to determine the extent of the damage. X Consult a qualified specialist workshop. You cannot detect any damage. X Start the engine as normal. The NECK-PRO head restraints on the driver's and frontpassenger seats have been triggered. Your vehicle has been involved in a rear-end collision. X Reset the triggered NECK-PRO head restraints (Y page 50). Where will I find...? First-aid kit Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the first-aid kit is in an open stowage compartment or behind the side paneling. X Open the trunk lid. Breakdown assistance Problem X To open the stowage well: turn rotary knob : in the direction of the arrow and fold down cover ;. X Remove the first-aid kit. i Check the expiration date on the first-aid kit at least once a year. Replace the contents if necessary, and replace missing contents. Vehicle tool kit The vehicle tool kit can be found in the stowage well under the trunk floor. i Vehicles without a spare wheel are not equipped with the tools needed to change a wheel when they leave the factory, e.g. jack or lug wrench. Some tools for changing a wheel are specific to the vehicle. To obtain tools approved for your vehicle, visit Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 254 Version: 3.0.3.6 Flat tire 254 a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. X Lift the trunk floor upwards (Y page 219). X Turn stowage well ; counter-clockwise and remove it. X Remove "Minispare" emergency spare wheel :. For further information on changing a wheel and mounting the spare wheel, see (Y page 255). Flat tire Breakdown assistance Preparing the vehicle : Vehicle tool kit tray ; Stowage well = Spare wheel/"Minispare" emergency Your vehicle could be equipped with a "Minispare" emergency spare wheel or the MOExtended run-flat system(Y page 259). i Vehicle preparation is not necessary on vehicles with the MOExtended run-flat system. spare wheel The vehicle tool kit contains: RFoldable wheel chock RFuse allocation chart RJack ROne pair of gloves RLug wrench RTowing eye "Minispare" emergency spare wheel The "Minispare" emergency spare wheel can be found in the stowage well under the trunk floor. X Lift the trunk floor upwards (Y page 219). X Stop the vehicle as far away as possible from traffic on solid, non-slippery and level ground. X Switch on the hazard warning lamps. X Firmly depress the parking brake. X Bring the front wheels into the straightahead position. X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first or reverse gear. X Vehicles with automatic transmission: move the selector lever to P. X X Switch off the engine. Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove the key from the ignition lock. X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's door. The on-board electronics have status 0, which is the same as the key having been removed. X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the Start/Stop button from the ignition lock (Y page 132). BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 255 Version: 3.0.3.6 Flat tire All occupants must get out of the vehicle. Make sure that they are not endangered as they get out of the vehicle. X Make sure that no one is near the danger area whilst a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting in the wheel change should, for example, stand behind the barrier. X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic conditions when doing so. X Close the driver's door. Changing a wheel and mounting the spare wheel Preparing the vehicle G Warning! The wheel and tire size of the emergency spare wheel/spare wheel may differ to that of the damaged wheel. When using an emergency spare wheel/spare wheel the handling characteristics of the vehicle may change. Adapt your style of driving accordingly. Never operate the vehicle with more than one emergency spare wheel/spare wheel that differs in size. Only use an emergency spare wheel/spare wheel of a differing size briefly and do not switch off ESP®. When using an emergency spare wheel, you must not exceed a maximum speed of 50 mph (80 km/h). G Warning! Have the emergency spare wheel/spare wheel replaced with a new wheel as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry out the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. i Vehicles without an emergency spare wheel/spare wheel are not equipped with wheel-changing tools at the factory. For more information on which tools are required to perform a wheel change on your vehicle, e.g. wheel chock, alignment bolt or lug wrench, consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. X Prepare the vehicle as described (Y page 254). X Remove the following items from the stowage well under the trunk/cargo compartment floor: Rthe emergency spare wheel Rthe vehicle tool kit Rthe folding wheel chock Rthe jack X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away. Securing the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away G Warning Only jack up the vehicle on level ground or on slight inclines/declines. The vehicle could otherwise fall off the jack and injure you or others. If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock, it can be found in the vehicle tool kit (Y page 253). The folding wheel chock is an additional securing measure to prevent the vehicle from rolling away, for example when changing a wheel. Z Breakdown assistance X 255 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 256 Version: 3.0.3.6 Flat tire 256 Raising the vehicle G Warning X Fold both plates upwards :. Fold out lower plate ;. X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into openings in base plate =. Breakdown assistance X Securing the vehicle on level ground X On level ground: place chocks or other suitable items under the front and rear of the wheel that is diagonally opposite the wheel you wish to change. Securing the vehicle on slight downhill gradients X On downhill gradients: place chocks or other suitable items in front of the wheels of the front and rear axle. When jacking up the vehicle, only use the jack which has been specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle. The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up the vehicle at the jacking points built into both sides of the vehicle. The jack saddle must be placed centrally under the jacking point. The jack must always be vertical when in use, especially on inclines or declines. The jack is intended only for lifting the vehicle briefly for wheel changes. It is not suited for performing maintenance work under the vehicle. To help avoid personal injury, use the jack only to lift the vehicle during a wheel change. Never get beneath the vehicle while it is supported by the jack. Keep hands and feet away from the area under the lifted vehicle. Always lower the vehicle onto sufficient capacity jackstands before working under the vehicle. Always firmly engage the parking brake and block the wheels with wheel chocks or other sizable objects before raising the vehicle with the jack. Do not disengage the parking brake while the vehicle is raised. Make sure that the ground on which the vehicle is standing and where you place the jack is solid, level and not slippery. If necessary, use a large underlay. On slippery surfaces, such as tiled floors, you should use a non-slip underlay, for example a rubber mat. Do not use wooden blocks or similar objects as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the jack may not be able to achieve its load-bearing capacity if it is not at its full height. Never start the engine when the vehicle is raised. Also observe the notes on the jack. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 257 Version: 3.0.3.6 Flat tire X Using lug wrench :, loosen the bolts on the wheel you wish to change by about one full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely. X Position jack = at jacking point ;. The jacking points for the jack are located behind the wheel housings of the front wheels and in front of the wheel housings of the rear wheels (arrows). X G Warning The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up the vehicle at the jacking points. The jack saddle must be placed centrally under the jacking point. If you do not position the jack correctly in the jacking point, the vehicle can fall off the jack and seriously or fatally injure you or others. ! The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up the vehicle at the jacking points. Otherwise, your vehicle could be damaged. Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned directly under the jacking point. X Turn crank ? clockwise until jack = sits completely on jacking point ; and the base of the jack lies evenly on the ground. X Turn crank ? until the tire is raised a maximum of 1.2 inches (3 cm) off the ground. Removing a wheel X Unscrew the wheel bolts. ! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or on a dirty surface. The bolt and wheel hub threads could otherwise be damaged when you screw them in. X 257 Remove the wheel. Z Breakdown assistance BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 258 Version: 3.0.3.6 Flat tire 258 Mounting a new wheel X Breakdown assistance G Warning! Always replace wheel bolts that are damaged or rusted. Never apply oil or grease to wheel bolts. Damaged wheel hub threads should be repaired immediately. Do not continue to drive under these circumstances! Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call Roadside Assistance. Incorrect wheel bolts or improperly tightened wheel bolts can cause the wheel to come off. This could cause an accident. Make sure to use the correct wheel bolts. Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight. Lowering the vehicle X Turn the crank of the jack counterclockwise until the vehicle is once again standing firmly on the ground. X Place the jack to one side. G Warning Only use genuine Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts. Other wheel bolts may come loose. Do not tighten the wheel bolts when the vehicle is raised. Otherwise, the vehicle could fall off the jack. G Warning Make sure to use the original length wheel bolts when remounting the original wheel after it has been repaired. X Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact surfaces. ! To prevent damage to the paintwork, hold X Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated (: to A). The tightening torque must be 96 lb-ft (130 Nm). G Risk of accident Have the tightening torque checked immediately after a wheel is changed. The wheels could come loose if they are not tightened to a torque of 96 lb-ft (130 Nm). X Turn the jack back to its initial position and store it together with the rest of the vehicle tool kit in the trunk/cargo compartment. X Transport the faulty wheel in the trunk/ cargo compartment. the wheel securely against the wheel hub while screwing in the first wheel bolt. or X X Place the emergency spare wheel on the wheel hub and push it on. Depending on the size of the wheel, you may also be able to secure the faulty wheel in the spare wheel well. In this case, you will have to remove the stowage well casing from the spare wheel well and stow it securely in the trunk/cargo compartment. i When you are driving with the collapsible spare wheel mounted, the tire pressure loss warning system or the tire pressure 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 259 Version: 3.0.3.6 Battery monitor cannot function reliably. Only restart the tire pressure loss warning system/tire pressure monitor when the defective wheel has been replaced with a new wheel. Vehicles with tire pressure monitor: all mounted wheels must be equipped with functioning sensors and the defective wheel should no longer be in the vehicle. MOExtended run-flat system The MOExtended run-flat system allows you to drive on even if there is a complete loss of pressure in one or more tires. The MOExtended run-flat system may only be used in conjunction with the activated tire pressure loss warning system or with the activated tire pressure monitor. The maximum permissible distance which can be driven in run-flat mode depends on the cargo in the vehicle. You can drive 50 miles (80 km) if the vehicle is partially laden and 18 miles (30 km) if it is fully laden. The maximum permissible distance which can be driven in run-flat mode is counted from the moment the tire pressure loss warning appears in the multifunction display. You must not exceed a maximum speed of 50 mph(80 km/h). G Warning! The handling characteristics of your vehicle deteriorate in run-flat mode, for example: Rwhen cornering Rwhen braking Rwhen accelerating rapidly Adapt your driving style accordingly and avoid sudden changes in direction and sudden acceleration, as well as driving over obstacles (i.e. curbs, potholes), and driving off-road. This is particularly the case when the vehicle is heavily laden. The maximum permissible distance that can be driven in run-flat mode depends to a large 259 extent on the loads placed on the vehicle. It can be shorter due to high speeds, a heavy cargo, sudden changes in direction, the road surface condition, outside temperature, etc., or further if you drive carefully and conservatively. Do not continue to drive in run-flat mode if: Ryou hear banging noises. vehicle starts to shake. Ryou see smoke and smell rubber. Rthe RESP® is intervening constantly. are tears in the sidewalls of the tire. After driving in run-flat mode, you must have the wheel(s) checked for damage at a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry out the work required. The faulty tire must be replaced in every case. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. Rthere i When replacing one or all tires, make sure that you only use tires marked MOExtended and of the specified size for the vehicle. Battery Important safety notes In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be sufficiently charged. ! Have the battery checked regularly at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Observe the service intervals in the Service Booklet or for further information consult a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for Z Breakdown assistance BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 260 Battery short trips or if you leave it standing idle for a lengthy period. To prevent damage from corrosion, only replace the battery with one that has a central ventilation cover. Only replace a battery with a battery that has been recommended by Mercedes-Benz. Consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center if you wish to leave your vehicle parked up for a long period of time. G Warning Breakdown assistance 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 260 Version: 3.0.3.6 Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries. Risk of explosion Fire, naked flames and smoking are prohibited when handling the battery. Avoid creating sparks. Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Wear suitable protective clothing, in particular gloves, an apron and a face mask. Immediately rinse acid splashes off with clean water. Consult a doctor if necessary. Wear eye protection. Keep children away. Observe this Operator's Manual. H Environmental note Do not dispose of batteries in the household rubbish. Dispose of defective batteries in an environmentally responsible manner. Take them to an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or to a special collection point for old batteries. G Warning Failure to follow these instructions can result in severe injury or death. Never lean over batteries while connecting. You might get injured. Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not allow this fluid to come in contact with eyes, skin or clothing. In case it does, immediately flush affected area with water and seek medical help if necessary. A battery will also produce hydrogen gas, which is flammable and explosive. Keep flames or sparks away from battery, avoid improper connection of jumper cables, smoking etc. G Warning Do not place any metal objects on the battery as this could result in a short circuit. Use leak-proof batteries only to avoid the risk of acid burns in the event of an accident. Take care that you do not become statically charged, e.g. by wearing synthetic clothing or rubbing against textiles. For this reason, you also should not pull or push the battery over carpets or other synthetic materials. Never touch the battery first. First, touch the outside body of the vehicle in order to release any possible electrostatic charges. Do not rub the battery with rags or cloths. The battery could explode if touched due to electrostatic charge or due to spark formation. ! Switch off the engine and remove the key before disconnecting the terminal clamps from the battery. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, make sure that the ignition is 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 261 Version: 3.0.3.6 Battery switched off. Check that all the indicator lamps in the instrument cluster are off. You may otherwise destroy electronic components, such as the alternator. ! Like other batteries, the vehicle battery may discharge over time if you do not use the vehicle. In this case, have the battery disconnected at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized MercedesBenz Center. You can also charge the battery with a charger recommended by Mercedes-Benz. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for further information. The battery, breather hose and cover of the positive terminal clamp must be installed securely during operation. i Remove the key if you park the vehicle and do not require any electrical consumers. The vehicle will then use very little energy, thus conserving battery power. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you do not carry out work on batteries yourself, e.g. removing, charging or replacing. Always have this work performed at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. i If the power supply has been interrupted, e.g. if the battery has been reconnected, you must carry out the following tasks: the clock (Y page 179). Rreset the function for automatically folding the exterior mirrors in/out by folding the mirrors out once (Y page 100). Rset Charging the battery G Warning Never charge a battery while still installed in the vehicle unless the accessory battery charge unit approved by Mercedes-Benz is being used. Gases may escape during 261 charging and cause explosions that may result in paint damage, corrosion or personal injury. An accessory battery charge unit specially adapted for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz is available. It permits the charging of the battery in its installed position. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for information and availability. Charge the battery in accordance with the separate instructions for the accessory battery charger. G Warning! There is a risk of acid burns during the charging process due to the gases which escape from the battery. Do not lean over the battery during the charging process. G Warning! Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. ! Only charge the installed battery with a battery charger which has been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. These battery chargers allow the battery to be charged while still installed. ! Only use battery chargers with a maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V. ! Only charge the battery using the jumpstarting connection point. The jump-starting connection point is in the engine compartment (Y page 262). X Open the hood (Y page 238). X Connect the battery charger to the positive terminal and earth point in the same order as when connecting the donor battery in the jump-starting procedure (Y page 262). Z Breakdown assistance BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 262 Version: 3.0.3.6 Jump-starting 262 Jump-starting Breakdown assistance G Warning Failure to follow these directions will cause damage to the electronic components, and can lead to a battery explosion and severe injury or death. Never lean over batteries while connecting or jump starting. You might get injured. Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not allow this fluid to come in contact with eyes, skin or clothing. In case it does, immediately flush affected area with water, and seek medical help if necessary. A battery will also produce hydrogen gas, which is flammable and explosive. Keep flames or sparks away from battery, avoid improper connection of jumper cables, smoking, etc. Attempting to jump start a frozen battery can result in it exploding, causing personal injury. Read all instructions before proceeding. ! Avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may damage the catalytic converter31 and create a risk of fire. Do not use a rapid-charging device to start the engine. Make sure the jumper cables are not damaged. Make sure the jumper cables are not touching any other metal objects when they are connected to the battery. If your vehicle's battery is discharged, the engine can be jump-started from another vehicle or from a second battery using jumper cables. Observe the following points: X The battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible, jump-start the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device. X Only jump-start the vehicle when the engine is cold and the catalytic converter system has cooled down32 . X Do not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first. X Jump-starting may only be performed from batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V. If you jump-start using a battery with higher voltage, it may damage the electrical systems of the vehicle. X Only use jumper cables which have a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps. X Make sure that the jumper cables cannot come into contact with parts, such as the pulley or the fan. These parts move when the engine is started and while it is running. X If the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected for a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the battery a little. i Jumper cables and further information about jump-starting can be obtained from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. X X Make sure that the two vehicles do not touch. Apply the parking brake firmly. 31 Only 32 Only vehicles with a gasoline engine. vehicles with a gasoline engine. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 263 Version: 3.0.3.6 Jump-starting 263 X Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jumpstarting device. ! Never swap the terminal connections. X Slide cover : of positive terminal ; in the direction of the arrow. Connect positive terminal ; on your vehicle to positive terminal = of donor battery B using the jumper cable, beginning with your own battery. X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed. X Connect negative terminal ? of donor battery B to earth point A of your vehicle using the jumper cable, connecting the jumper cable to donor battery B first. X Start the engine. X First remove the jumper cable from earth point A and negative terminal ?, then from positive terminal ; and positive terminal =, each time disconnecting from the battery on your own vehicle first. X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized MercedesBenz Center. X Z Breakdown assistance Manual transmission: engage neutral. X Automatic transmission: move the selector lever to P. X Switch off all electrical consumers (e.g. radio, blower etc.). X Open the hood (Y page 238). BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 264 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 264 Version: 3.0.3.6 Towing and tow-starting Towing and tow-starting ! On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use the SmartKey instead of the Start/Stop button. Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock and shift the automatic transmission to N. Then, turn the SmartKey back to 0 and leave it in the ignition lock. Important safety notes Breakdown assistance G Warning If you tow the vehicle, you must use a rigid towing bar if: Rthe engine will not run. Rthere is a malfunction in the brake system. Rthere is a malfunction in the power supply or the vehicle's electrical system. With the engine not running, there is no power assistance for the brake and steering systems. You will then need considerably more force to steer and to brake and the brake pedal travel will be longer. If necessary, depress the brake pedal with maximum force. Before towing away, make sure that the steering can be moved and is not locked. If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its weight must not exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of your vehicle. It is better to have the vehicle transported than to have it towed. ! Vehicles with automatic transmission must not be started by tow-starting. This could otherwise damage the transmission. ! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed with the front or rear axle raised. This could otherwise damage the transmission. The automatic transmission must be in position N while the vehicle is being towed. The battery must be connected and charged. Otherwise: Ryou will not be able to turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. will not be able to shift the automatic transmission to position N. Vehicles with automatic transmission: manually release the selector lever lock in position P(Y page 144). Ryou i Switch the automatic lock (Y page 181) off before towing. Otherwise, you could lock yourself out of the vehicle when pushing or towing the vehicle. ! You may only tow the vehicle a maximum distance of 30 miles (50 km). A towing speed of 30 mph (50 km/h) must not be exceeded. For towing distances over 30 miles (50 km), the vehicle must loaded onto a transporter. ! Only secure the tow rope or tow bar at the towing eyes. Otherwise, the vehicle could be damaged. ! Do not use the towing eye for recovery, as this could damage the vehicle. If in doubt, recover the vehicle with a crane. ! Drive slowly and smoothly when towing. Excessive tractive power could otherwise damage the vehicles. ! Do not tow with sling-type equipment. This could damage the vehicle. Installing/removing the towing eye Installing the towing eye X Remove the towing eye from the vehicle tool kit (Y page 253). G Warning The exhaust tail pipe may be hot. You could burn yourself if you touch the tail pipe. Be particularly careful when removing the rear cover. The mountings for the removable towing eyes are located in the bumpers. They are at the front and at the rear, behind the covers. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 265 Version: 3.0.3.6 Towing and tow-starting 265 X Switch on the hazard warning flashers (Y page 109). X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock and remove the SmartKey. X When leaving the vehicle, take the SmartKey or the KEYLESS-GO key with you. Towing vehicles with both axles on the ground G Warning X Press the mark on cover : inwards, in the direction of the arrow. X Take cover : off the opening. Screw in and tighten the towing eye clockwise to the stop. X Removing the towing eye X Unscrew and remove the towing eye. X Attach cover : to the bumper and press until it engages. X Place the towing eye in the vehicle tool kit. Towing the vehicle with the rear axle raised Only possible for vehicles without 4MATIC. When having your vehicle towed with the rear axle raised, observe the important safety notes (Y page 264). ! The ignition must be switched off if you are towing the vehicle with the rear axle raised. Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system. With the engine not running, there is no power assistance for the brake and steering systems. In this case, it is important to keep in mind that a considerably higher degree of effort is necessary to brake and steer the vehicle. Adapt your driving accordingly. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the brake pedal and hold it down. X Vehicles with manual transmission: depress the clutch pedal. X Shift to neutral. or X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the automatic transmission to position N. X Release the brake pedal. X Release the parking brake. X Switch on the hazard warning flashers (Y page 109). i When towing with the hazard warning flashers switched on, use the combination switch as usual to signal in which direction you are changing. In this case, only the indicator lamps for the direction of travel flash. When you reset the combination switch, the hazard warning flashers start flashing again. Z Breakdown assistance When having your vehicle towed, observe the important safety notes (Y page 264). BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Fuses 266 Transporting the vehicle The towing eye can be used to pull the vehicle onto a trailer or transporter for transporting purposes. X Vehicles with manual transmission: shift to neutral. X Vehicles with automatic transmission: turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Shift the selector lever to N. As soon as the vehicle has been loaded: Breakdown assistance 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 266 Version: 3.0.3.6 X Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking brake. X Vehicles with manual transmission: shift to first gear or reverse gear. X Vehicles with automatic transmission: move the selector lever to P. X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock and remove the SmartKey. X Secure the vehicle. ! Only lash the vehicle down by the wheels or wheel rims, not by parts of the vehicle such as axle or steering components. Otherwise, the vehicle could be damaged. Tow-starting (emergency engine starting) When tow-starting, observe the important safety notes (Y page 264). ! Vehicles with an automatic transmission must not be tow-started. You could otherwise damage the automatic transmission. Before tow-starting: Rthe battery must be connected engine must be cold Rthe catalytic converter must be cold X Switch on the hazard warning lamps(Y page 109). X Install the towing eye (Y page 264). Rthe X Depress and hold the brake pedal. X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock. X Depress and hold the clutch pedal. X Shift to neutral. X Release the brake pedal. X Shift to second gear. X Tow-start the vehicle. X Release the clutch pedal slowly and do not depress the accelerator pedal when doing so. The engine is started. X Depress the clutch pedal and shift to neutral. X Engage the parking brake. X Stop the vehicle in a suitable location to remove the tow bar or the tow rope. X Remove the towing eye (Y page 265). X Switch off the hazard warning lamps. Fuses Important safety notes The fuses in your vehicle serve to close down faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on the circuit and their functions will fail. G Warning Only use fuses approved by Mercedes-Benz with the specified amperage for the system in question and do not attempt to repair or bridge a blown fuse. Using other than approved fuses or using repaired or bridged fuses may cause an overload leading to a fire, and/or cause damage to electrical components and/or systems. Have the cause determined and remedied by an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of the same rating, which you can recognize by the color and value. The fuse ratings are listed in the fuse allocation chart. An authorized BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 267 Version: 3.0.3.6 Fuses 267 Mercedes-Benz Center will be happy to advise you. i If a fuse has blown, visit a breakdown service or an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which have the correct fuse rating for the system concerned. Otherwise, components or systems could be damaged. X To open: pull out cover : slightly at the bottom in the direction of arrow =. X Pull cover : outwards in the direction of arrow ; and remove it. X Before changing a fuse X Park the vehicle and apply the parking brake. X Switch off all electrical consumers. X Remove the key from the ignition lock. The fuses are located in various fuse boxes: Rfuse box on the driver's side of the dashboard Rfuse box in the engine compartment on the left-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed in the direction of travel Rfuse box in the trunk on the right when viewed in the direction of travel The fuse allocation chart is located in the vehicle tool kit (Y page 253) in the stowage compartment under the trunk floor. To close: clip in cover : on the front of the dashboard. X Fold cover : inwards until it engages. Fuse box in the engine compartment X Make sure that the windshield wipers are turned off. G Risk of injury Make sure that the windshield wipers are turned off and the key is pulled out of the ignition lock before you open the cover of the fuse box. Otherwise, the windshield wipers and the wiper rods above the cover could be set in motion. This could lead to you or others being injured by the wiper rods. X Open the hood (Y page 238). Fuse box in the dashboard ! Do not use a pointed object such as a screwdriver to open the cover in the dashboard. You could damage the dashboard or the cover. Z Breakdown assistance ! Only use fuses that have been approved BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Fuses 268 X Remove any existing moisture from the fuse box using a dry cloth. X Take lines ; from the guides. X To open: open clamps :. X Remove the fuse box cover forwards. X Breakdown assistance To close: check whether the rubber seal is lying correctly in the cover. X Insert the cover at the rear of the fuse box into the retainer. X Fold down the cover and close clamps :. X Secure lines ; in the guides. ! The cover must be seated properly, otherwise moisture or dirt could impair the function of the fuses. X Close the hood (Y page 239). Fuse box in the trunk X X Open the trunk lid. To open: turn rotary catch : clockwise. X Open cover ; downwards in the direction of the arrow. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 268 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 269 Version: 3.0.3.6 269 Vehicle equipment ............................ Important safety notes .................... Directives to be observed ................ Maintenance and care of wheels and tires ............................................. Tire pressures ................................... Loading the vehicle .......................... Maximum tire load ............................ Direction of rotation ......................... Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards .......................................... Interchanging the wheels ................ Tire labeling ....................................... Definitions for tires and loading ...... Wheel/tire combinations ................. 270 270 271 271 272 280 284 284 284 286 286 290 293 Tires and wheels BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 270 Important safety notes Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. Important safety notes Tires and wheels 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 270 Version: 3.0.3.6 Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center if you require information on tested and recommended tires and wheels for summer and winter driving. Advice on purchasing and caring for tires is also available there. G Warning Replace rims or tires with the same designation, manufacturer and type as shown on the original part. For further information contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. If incorrectly sized rims and tires are mounted, the wheel brakes or suspension components can be damaged. Also, the operating clearance of the wheels and the tires may no longer be correct. G Warning Worn, old tires can cause accidents. If the tire tread is worn to minimum tread depth, or if the tires have sustained damage, replace them. When replacing rims, only use genuine Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts specified for the particular rim type. Failure to do so can result in the bolts loosening and possibly an accident. Retreaded tires are not tested or recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since previous damage cannot always be recognized on retreads. The operating safety of the vehicle cannot be assured when such tires are used. G Warning If you feel a sudden significant vibration or ride disturbance, or you suspect that possible damage to your vehicle has occurred, you should turn on the hazard warning flashers, carefully slow down, and drive with caution to an area which is a safe distance from the road. Inspect the tires and the vehicle underbody for possible damage. If the vehicle appears unsafe, have the vehicle towed to the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or tire dealer for repairs. G Warning Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You might lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire or driving at high speed with a flat tire will cause excessive heat buildup and possibly a fire. ! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use tires, wheels and accessories which have been approved by Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle. These tires have been specially adapted for use with the control systems, such as ABS or ESP®, and are marked as follows: RMO = Mercedes-Benz Original RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended (tires with run-flat characteristics) RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (AMG) Only use Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tires on wheels that have been specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz. If you use other tires, wheels and accessories, Mercedes-Benz cannot accept any responsibility for damage that may result from this. Further information about tires, wheels and approved combinations can be obtained from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. i Further information about tires and wheels can be obtained from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 271 Version: 3.0.3.6 Maintenance and care of wheels and tires Directives to be observed ROnly mount tires and wheels of the same type and make. ROnly mount tires of the correct size onto the wheels. RAfter mounting new tires, run them in at moderate speeds for the first 60 miles (100 km) as they only reach their full performance after this distance. RDo not use tires until they are excessively worn as the tire traction on wet road surfaces decreases significantly when the tread depth is less than 1/8 in (3 mm). RIf the vehicle is heavily laden, check the tire pressure and adjust it if necessary. parking your vehicle, make sure that the tires do not get deformed by the curb or other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive over curbs, speed humps or similar elevations, try to do so slowly and at an obtuse angle. Otherwise, the tires, particularly the sidewalls, can get damaged. RWhen Damaged wheels can cause a loss of tire pressure. RRegularly check the tire tread depth and the condition of the tread across the whole width of the tire (Y page 271). If necessary, turn the front wheels to full lock in order to inspect the inner side of the tire surface. RAll wheels must have a valve cap to protect the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not install anything on the valve (such as tire pressure monitoring systems) other than the standard valve cap or other valve caps approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle. RRegularly check the pressure of all the tires including the emergency spare wheel or the spare wheel, particularly prior to long trips, and correct the pressure as necessary (Y page 272). Service life of tires The service life of tires depends on the following factors amongst other things: Rdriving Maintenance and care of wheels and tires Checking wheels and tires G Warning Regularly check the tires for damage. Damaged tires can cause tire inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of your vehicle. Worn, old tires can cause accidents. If the tire tread is worn to minimum tread depth, or if the tires have sustained damage, replace them. RRegularly check the wheels and tires of your vehicle for damage (e.g. cuts, punctures, tears, bulges on tires and deformation or cracks or severe corrosion on wheels), at least once a month, as well as after driving off-road or on rough roads. style pressure Rmileage Replace the tires after six years at the latest, regardless of wear. This also applies to the emergency spare wheel/spare wheel. Rtire Tire tread G Warning Although the applicable federal motor vehicle safety laws consider a tire to be worn when the tread wear indicators (TWI) become visible at approximately 1/16 in (1.6 mm), we recommend that you do not allow your tires to wear down to that level. As tread depth approaches 1/8 in (3 mm), the adhesion properties on a wet road are sharply reduced. Z 271 Tires and wheels BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 272 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 272 Version: 3.0.3.6 Tire pressures Depending upon the weather and/or road surface (conditions), the tire traction varies widely. Do not use tires until they are excessively worn as the tire traction on wet road surfaces decreases significantly when the tread depth is less than 1/8 in (3 mm). Tires and wheels Tread wear indicators (TWI) are required by law. Six indicators are positioned over the tire tread. They are visible as soon as a tread depth of approximately 1/16 in (1.6 mm) is reached. If this is the case, the tire is so worn that it must be replaced. The recommended tread depth for summer tires is at least 1/8 in (3 mm). The recommended tread depth for winter tires is at least 1/6 in (4 mm). Bar marking : for tread wear is integrated into the tire tread. Storing tires Store tires that are not being used in a cool, dry and preferably dark place. Protect the tires from contact with oil, grease and fuel. Cleaning tires G Warning Do not use power washers with circular jet nozzles (concentrated-power jets) to clean your vehicle, especially for cleaning tires. You could otherwise damage the tires and cause an accident. Tire pressures Recommended tire pressures G Warning Follow recommended tire inflation pressures. Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can adversely affect handling and ride comfort, wear unevenly, increase stopping distance, and result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes etc. Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit as indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver's door B-pillar. Overloading the tires can overheat them, possibly causing a blowout. Overloading the tires can also result in handling or steering problems, or brake failure. You will find a table of recommended tire pressures on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side (Y page 280). You will find a table of tire pressures for various operating conditions on the inside of your vehicle's fuel filler flap. Use a suitable pressure gauge. The outer appearance of a tire does not permit any reliable conclusion about the tire pressure. On vehicles equipped with the electronic tire pressure monitor, the tire pressure can be checked using the on-board computer. G Warning Should the tire pressure drop repeatedly: BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 273 Version: 3.0.3.6 Tire pressures Rcheck 273 the tire for foreign bodies. Rcheck whether the wheel is losing air or the valve is leaking. sure that only a valve cap approved by Mercedes-Benz is installed on the tire valve. Tire pressures that are too low have a negative effect on vehicle safety, which could lead you to cause an accident. Rmake i The specifications given on the following Tire and Loading Information placard are examples. Tire pressure specifications are vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data shown here. The tire pressure specifications for your vehicle can be found on the Tire and Loading Information placard of your vehicle. You will find recommended tire pressure specifications : for cold tires and for a fully loaded vehicle on the Tire and Loading Information placard. The tire pressure specifications apply to tires which are installed at the factory. Important notes on tire pressures G Warning If the tire pressure drops repeatedly, check the tires for punctures from foreign objects and/or whether air is leaking from the valves or from around the rim. The temperature and pressure of the tires increase when the vehicle is in motion. This is dependent on the driving speed and the load. If you wish to drive at high speeds of 100 mph (160 km/h) or higher when this is allowed, use the tire pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler flap to set the correct tire pressures when the wheels are cold. If the tire pressure is not set correctly, this can lead to an excessive build up of heat and a sudden loss of pressure. For more information, contact a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. i Ride comfort may be affected if the tire pressure is adjusted to the recommended value for speeds of over 100 mph(160 km/h). Z Tires and wheels Only correct tire pressures when the tires are cold. The tires are cold when the vehicle has been parked for at least three hours or driven for less than 1 mile (1.6 km). The tire temperature changes depending on the outside temperature, the vehicle speed and the tire load. If the tire temperature changes by 18 ‡ (10 †), the tire pressure changes by approximately 10 kPa (0.1 bar/1.5 psi). Take this into account when checking the pressure of warm tires and only correct the tire pressure if it is too low for the current operating conditions. If you check the tire pressure when the tires are warm, the reading will be higher than if the tires were cold. This is normal. Do not reduce the tire pressure to the value specified for cold tires. The tire pressure would otherwise be too low. Observe the recommended tire pressure specifications for cold tires on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 274 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 274 Version: 3.0.3.6 Tire pressures Make sure that the tire pressure for normal speeds is adopted again. Additional specifications of tire pressure values for loads can also be found on the tire pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler flap. The tire pressure for emergency spare wheels can be found: the yellow label on the wheel rim of the emergency spare wheel Rin the "Wheel and tire combinations" section (Y page 293) of this Operator's Manual Ron the Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side luggage in the table. The actual number of seats may differ from this. Ron Tires and wheels i The specifications shown in the examples in the tire pressure tables are only examples. Tire pressure specifications are vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data shown here. The tire pressure specifications that are valid for your vehicle can be found on your vehicle's tire pressure table. Tire pressure table with tire sizes (example) Some tire pressure tables only show the rim diameter instead of the complete tire size, e.g. R18. The rim diameter is a component of the tire size and can be read from the tire sidewall (Y page 287). The tire pressures in the tire pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler flap are valid for all approved tires installed at the factory, unless stated otherwise. Tire pressure too low or too high Underinflated tires G Warning Tire pressure table for all approved tires installed at the factory (example) If the tire pressure precedes a tire size, the tire pressure specification is only valid for this tire size. The vehicle loading conditions "partially laden" or "fully laden" are specified using a differing number of persons and Follow recommended tire inflation pressures. Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. Underinflated tires can: Rwear excessively and/or unevenly affect fuel economy Radversely BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 275 Version: 3.0.3.6 Tire pressures from being overheated affect handling Radversely Overinflated tires can: G Warning Follow recommended tire inflation pressures. Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can adversely affect handling and ride comfort, wear unevenly, increase stopping distance, and result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes etc. Overinflated tires can: Radversely affect handling excessively and/or unevenly Rbe more likely to become damaged Radversely affect ride comfort Rincrease stopping distance Rwear Checking tire pressures Important safety notes G Warning Follow recommended tire inflation pressures. Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can adversely affect handling and ride comfort, wear unevenly, increase stopping distance, and result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes etc. Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit as indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver's door B-pillar. Overloading the tires can overheat them, possibly causing a blowout. Overloading the tires can also result in handling or steering problems, or brake failure. Check the tire pressure at least once a month. Only check and correct tire pressures when the tires are cold (Y page 272). Checking the tire pressures manually In order to determine and adjust the tire pressures, proceed as follows: X Remove the valve cap of the tire you wish to check. X Press the tire pressure gauge securely onto the valve. X Read the tire pressure and compare it with the recommended value on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side of your vehicle. X If necessary, increase the tire pressure to the recommended value (Y page 272). X If the tire pressure is too high, release air by pressing down the metal pin in the valve using the tip of a pen, for example. Then, check the tire pressure again using the tire pressure gauge. X Screw the valve cap onto the valve. X Repeat the steps for the other tires. Tire pressure loss warning system (Canada only) Important safety notes While the vehicle is in motion, the tire pressure loss warning system monitors the set tire pressure using the rotational speed of the wheels. This enables the system to detect significant pressure loss in a tire. If the speed of rotation of a wheel changes as a result of a loss of pressure, a corresponding warning message will appear in the multifunction display. Z Tires and wheels Rfail 275 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 276 Tire pressures G Warning If the Check Tire Pressure Soon message appears in the multifunction display, one or more tires are significantly underinflated. Stop the vehicle as soon as possible and inflate the tires to the pressure specified on the vehicle's Tire and Loading Information placard or (where available) in the tire pressure table. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability. Check all tires when cold, including the spare tire, at least once a month. The tires should be inflated to the recommended pressure. This information can be found: Tires and wheels 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 276 Version: 3.0.3.6 Ron the Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side or Rin the table for the tire pressure on the inside of the fuel filler flap G Warning! The tire pressure loss warning system does not provide a warning for wrongly selected tire inflation pressures. Always adjust tire inflation pressure according to the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver's door B-pillar or on the tire inflation pressure label located on the inside of the fuel filler flap. The tire pressure loss warning system does not replace regular checks of the tire inflation pressures since a gradual pressure loss in more than one tire cannot be detected by the tire pressure loss warning system. The tire pressure loss warning system is not able to issue a warning due to a sudden dramatic loss of tire inflation pressure (e.g. tire blowout caused by a foreign object). In this case bring the vehicle to a halt by carefully applying the brakes and avoiding abrupt steering maneuvers. The function of the tire pressure loss warning system is limited or delayed if: Rsnow chains are mounted on your vehicle. conditions are wintry. Ryou are driving on sand or gravel. Ryou adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high rates of acceleration). Ryou are driving with a heavy cargo (in the vehicle or on the roof). Rroad Restarting the tire pressure loss warning system Restart the tire pressure loss warning system if you have: Rchanged the tire pressure Rchanged the wheels or tires Rmounted new wheels or tires X Before restarting, refer to the Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side or the tire pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler flap to ensure the tire pressure in all four tires is set correctly for the current operating conditions. X Observe the notes in the section on tire pressures (Y page 272). G Warning The tire pressure loss warning system can only give reliable warnings if you have set the correct tire pressure. If an incorrect tire pressure is set, these incorrect values will be monitored. A tire with insufficient pressure results in vehicle instability when driving, thus increasing the risk of an accident. X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2 (Y page 131) in the ignition lock. X Press the = or ; button to select the Service menu. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 277 Version: 3.0.3.6 Tire pressures Press the 9 or : button to select Tire Pressure. X Press the a button. The Run Flat Indicator Active Press 'OK' to Restart message appears in the multifunction display. If you wish to confirm the restart: X Press the a button. The Tire Pressure Now OK? message appears in the multifunction display. X Press 9 or : to select Yes. X Press the a button. The Run Flat Indicator Restarted message appears in the multifunction display. After a teach-in period, the tire pressure loss warning system will monitor the set tire pressures of all four tires. If you wish to cancel the restart: X Press the % button. or X If the message: Tire Pressure now OK? appears, use 9 or : to select Cancel. X Press the a button. The tire pressure values stored at the last restart will continue to be monitored. Tire pressure monitoring system (USA only) Important safety notes If a tire pressure monitor is installed, the vehicle's wheels have sensors installed that monitor the tire pressures in all four tires. The tire pressure monitor warns you when the pressure drops in one or more of the tires. The tire pressure monitor only functions if the correct wheel electronics units are installed in all wheels. The tire pressure monitor has a yellow warning lamp in the instrument cluster for indicating a pressure loss or malfunction. Depending on how the warning lamp flashes or lights up, a tire pressure that is too low or a malfunction in the tire pressure monitor is displayed: Rif the warning lamp is lit continuously, the tire pressure on one or more tires is significantly too low. The tire pressure monitor is not malfunctioning. Rif the warning lamp flashes for 60 seconds and then remains lit constantly, the tire pressure monitor is malfunctioning. G Warning! Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked at least once a month when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the tire and loading information table on the driver's door B-pillar or the tire inflation pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler flap. If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the tire and loading information table or the tire inflation pressure table, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires. As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitor (TPMS). An indicator lamp lights up if one or more of your tires are significantly underinflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure indicator lamp lights up, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if underinflation has not Z Tires and wheels X 277 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Tires and wheels 278 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 278 Version: 3.0.3.6 Tire pressures reached the level at which the low tire pressure indicator lamp of the TPMS lights up. Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure indicator lamp. When the system detects a malfunction, the indicator lamp will flash for approximately 1 minute and then remain illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indicator is lit, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of incompatible replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction indicator after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly. i If the tire pressure monitor is malfunctioning, it may take more than 10 minutes for the tire pressure warning lamp to inform you of the malfunction by flashing for 60 seconds and then remaining lit. When the malfunction has been rectified, the tire pressure warning lamp goes out after driving for a few minutes. Information on tire pressures is displayed in the multifunction display. After a few minutes of driving, the current tire pressure of each tire is shown in the multifunction display. i The tire pressure values indicated by the on-board computer may differ from those measured at a gas station with a pressure gauge. The tire pressures shown by the onboard computer refer to those measured at sea level. At high altitudes, the tire pressure values indicated by a pressure gauge are higher than those shown by the on-board computer. In this case, do not reduce the tire pressures. i The operation of the tire pressure monitor can be affected by interference from radio transmitting equipment (e.g. radio headphones, two-way radios) that may be operated in or near the vehicle. i This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: 1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and 2. This device must withstand any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Unauthorized modifications to the device could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. Checking tire pressure electronically X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2 (Y page 131) in the ignition lock. X Press the = or ; button to select the Service menu. X Press the 9 or : button to select Tire Pressure. X Press the a button. The current tire pressure for each wheel will be displayed in the multifunction display. If the vehicle has been parked for longer than 20 minutes, the Tire pressures will be displayed after driving a few minutes message appears in the display. After a teach-in period, the tire pressure monitor automatically recognizes new wheels or new sensors. As long as a clear allocation of the tire pressure values to the individual wheels is not possible, the Tire Pressure Monitor Active message is shown instead of the tire pressure display. The tire pressures are already being monitored. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 279 Version: 3.0.3.6 Tire pressures i If a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel is mounted, the system may continue to show the tire pressure of the wheel that has been removed for a few minutes. If this occurs, note that the value displayed for the position where the spare wheel is mounted is not the same as the spare wheel/emergency spare wheel's current tire pressure. TPMS warning messages If the tire pressure monitor detects a significant pressure loss on one or more tires, a warning message is shown in the multifunction display. A warning tone also sounds and the tire pressure warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster. Each tire that is affected by a significant loss of pressure is highlighted by a red rectangle. If the Correct Tire Pressure message appears in the multifunction display: X Check the tire pressure on all four wheels and correct it if necessary. i If the wheel positions on the vehicle are interchanged, the tire pressures may be displayed for the wrong positions for a short time. This is rectified after a few minutes of driving, and the tire pressures are displayed for the correct positions. Restarting the tire pressure monitor G Warning It is the driver's responsibility to set the tire inflation pressure to the recommended cold tire inflation pressure. Underinflated tires affect the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You might lose control over the vehicle. When you restart the tire pressure monitor, all existing warning messages are deleted and the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses the currently set tire pressures as the reference values for monitoring. The TPMS must be restarted when you set the tire pressure to a new value (as a result of changed handling or load characteristics, for example). The TPMS then monitors the new tire pressure values. Restart the tire pressure monitor after you have set the tire pressure to the value recommended for the desired driving situation (Y page 272). Only correct tire pressures on cold tires. Comply with the recommended tire pressures on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side Additional tire pressure values for driving at high speeds or with heavy loads can be found in the Tire Pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler flap. X Make sure that the tire pressure is correct on all four wheels. X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position 2 in the ignition lock. X Press the = or ; button to select the Service menu. X Press the 9 or : button to select Tire Pressure. X Press the a button. The current tire pressure of each wheel or the Tire pressures will be displayed after driving a few minutes message is shown in the multifunction display. X Press the : button. The Use Current Pressures as New Reference Values message appears in the multifunction display. If you wish to confirm the restart: X Press the a button. The Tire Press. Monitor Restarted message appears in the multifunction display. After driving for a few minutes, the system checks whether the current tire pressures are within the specified range. The new tire pressures are then accepted as reference values and monitored. Z 279 Tires and wheels BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe Loading the vehicle 280 If you wish to cancel the restart: X Press the % button. The tire pressure values stored at the last restart will continue to be monitored. Maximum tire pressures G Warning Tires and wheels 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 280 Version: 3.0.3.6 Never exceed the maximum tire inflation pressure. Follow recommended tire inflation pressures. Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated. Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can adversely affect handling and ride comfort, wear unevenly, increase stopping distance, and result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes etc. : Maximum permitted tire pressure (example) i The actual values for tires are specific to each vehicle and may deviate from the values in the illustration. When adjusting the tire pressures always observe the recommended tire pressure for your vehicle (Y page 272). Loading the vehicle Instruction labels for tires and loads G Warning Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit as indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver's door B-pillar. Overloading the tires can overheat them, possibly causing a blowout. Overloading the tires can also result in handling or steering problems, or brake failure. Two instruction labels on your vehicle show the maximum possible load. (1) The Tire and Loading Information placard is on the B-pillar on the driver's side. The Tire and Loading Information placard shows the permissible number of occupants and the maximum permissible vehicle load. It also contains details of the tire sizes and corresponding pressures for tires mounted at the factory. (2) The vehicle identification plate is on the B-pillar on the driver's side. The vehicle identification plate informs you of the gross vehicle weight rating. It is made up of the vehicle weight, all vehicle occupants, the fuel and the cargo. You can also find information about the maximum gross axle weight rating on the front and rear axle. The maximum gross axle weight rating is the maximum weight that can be carried by one axle (front or rear axle). Never exceed the maximum load or the maximum gross axle weight rating for the front or rear axle. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 281 Version: 3.0.3.6 Loading the vehicle 281 Number of seats i The data in the illustration of the Tire and Loading Information placard is an example. The number of seats is vehicle-specific and can differ from the details shown. The number of seats in your vehicle can be found on the Tire and Loading Information placard. : B-pillar, driver's side Maximum permissible gross vehicle weight rating Loading Information placard is an example. The maximum permissible gross vehicle weight rating is vehicle-specific and may differ from that which is illustrated. You can find the valid maximum permissible gross vehicle weight rating for your vehicle on the Tire and Loading Information placard. X Maximum number of seats : determines the maximum number of occupants allowed to travel in the vehicle. This information can be found on the Tire and Loading Information placard. The Tire and Loading Information placard gives you details on maximum permissible gross vehicle weight rating :: "The gross weight of occupants and luggage must never exceed XXX kilograms or XXX pounds." The gross weight of all vehicle occupants, cargo, luggage and trailer load/noseweight (if applicable) must not exceed the specified value. Z Tires and wheels i The data in the illustration of the Tire and BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 282 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 282 Version: 3.0.3.6 Loading the vehicle Tires and wheels Determining the maximum load The following steps have been developed as required of all manufacturers under Title 49, Code of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the "National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of 1966". X Step 1: Locate the statement "The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs." on your vehicle's Tire and Loading Information placard. X Step 2: Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be traveling in your vehicle. X Step 3: Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kilograms or XXX lbs. X Step 4: The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the "XXX" amount equals 1400 lbs and there will be five 150 lbs passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs (1400 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs). X Step 5: Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. For reasons of safety, that weight must not exceed the available cargo and luggage cargo capacity calculated in step 4. X Step 6 (if applicable): If you intend to tow a trailer behind your vehicle, the load on the trailer is transferred to your vehicle. Consult this Operator's Manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle (Y page 284). The following table shows examples of how to calculate total and cargo load capacities with varying seating configurations and number and size of occupants. The following examples use a cargo limit of 1500 lbs (680 kg). This is for illustration purposes only. Make sure you always use the actual load limit for your vehicle stated on the vehicle's Tire and Loading Information placard (Y page 281). Step 1 Step 2 Example 1 Example 2 Example 3 1500 lbs (680 kg) 1500 lbs (680 kg) 1500 lbs (680 kg) Example 1 Example 2 Example 3 Number of people in the vehicle (driver and occupants) 5 3 1 Distribution of the occupants Front: 2 Rear: 3 Front: 1 Rear: 2 Front: 1 Combined maximum weight of occupants and cargo (data from the Tire and Loading Information placard) 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 283 Version: 3.0.3.6 Loading the vehicle Step 3 Example 1 Example 2 Example 3 Weight of the occupants Occupant 1: 150 lbs (68 kg) Occupant 2: 180 lbs (82 kg) Occupant 3: 160 lbs (73 kg) Occupant 4: 140 lbs (63 kg) Occupant 5: 120 lbs (54 kg) Occupant 1: 200 lbs (91 kg) Occupant 2: 190 lbs (86 kg) Occupant 3: 150 lbs (68 kg) Occupant 1: 150 lbs (68 kg) Gross weight of all occupants 750 lbs (340 kg) 540 lbs (245 kg) 150 lbs (68 kg) Permissible cargo and trailer load/ noseweight (maximum gross vehicle weight rating from the Tire and Loading Information placard minus the gross weight of all occupants) Example 1 Example 2 Example 3 1500 lbs (680 kg) 750 lbs (340 kg) = 750 lbs (340 kg) 1500 lbs (680 kg) 540 lbs (245 kg) = 960 lbs (435 kg) 1500 lbs (680 kg) 150 lbs (68 kg) = 1350 lbs (612 kg) The greater the combined weight of the occupants, the lower the maximum luggage load. Further information can be found under "Towing a trailer" (Y page 284). Vehicle identification plate Even if you have calculated the total cargo carefully, you should still make sure that the gross vehicle weight rating and the gross axle weight rating are not exceeded. Details can be found on the vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar on the driver's side (Y page 280). Gross vehicle weight: the gross weight of the vehicle, all passengers, cargo and trailer load/noseweight (if applicable) must not exceed the permissible gross vehicle weight. Gross axle weight rating: the maximum permissible load that can be carried by one axle (front or rear axle). To ensure that your vehicle does not exceed the maximum permissible values (gross vehicle weight and maximum gross axle weight rating), have your loaded vehicle (including driver, occupants, cargo, and full trailer load if applicable) weighed on a suitable vehicle weighbridge. Z 283 Tires and wheels BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 284 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 284 Version: 3.0.3.6 Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards Trailer load/noseweight The trailer load/noseweight affects the gross weight of the vehicle. If a trailer is attached, the trailer load/noseweight is included in the load along with occupants and luggage. The trailer load/noseweight is usually approximately 10% of the gross weight of the trailer and its cargo. Your Mercedes-Benz is designed for transporting persons and their luggage. Mercedes-Benz does not recommend towing a trailer with your vehicle. Direction of rotation Tires with a specified direction of rotation have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk of hydroplaning. You will only gain these benefits if the correct direction of rotation is observed. An arrow on the sidewall of the tire indicates its correct direction of rotation. You may mount an emergency spare wheel/ spare wheel against the direction of rotation. Observe the time restriction on use as well as the speed limitation specified on the emergency spare wheel/spare wheel. Maximum tire load Tires and wheels G Warning Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit as indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver's door B-pillar. Overloading the tires can overheat them, possibly causing a blowout. Overloading the tires can also result in handling or steering problems, or brake failure. i The actual values for tires are specific to each vehicle and may deviate from the values in the illustration. Maximum tire load : is the maximum permitted weight for which the tire is approved. Further information on tire loads (Y page 286). Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards Overview of tire quality standards The Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards are U.S. government specifications. Their purpose is to provide drivers with uniform reliable information on tire performance data. Tire manufacturers have to grade tires using three performance factors: : tread wear, ; tire traction, and = heat resistance. All tires sold in North America are provided with the corresponding quality class mark on the sidewall of the tire, even though these regulations do not apply to Canada. i The actual values for tires are specific to each vehicle and may deviate from the values in the illustration. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 285 Version: 3.0.3.6 Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards Where applicable, the tire grading information can be found on the tire sidewall between the tread shoulder and maximum tire width. For example: Tread wear Traction Temperature 200 A AA All passenger car tires must conform to the statutory safety requirements in addition to these grades. Tread wear The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified U.S. government test track. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half times as well on the government test track as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate conditions. Traction G Warning The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics. The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. These grades represent the tire's ability to stop on a wet surface as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance. 285 G Warning If ice has formed on the road, tire traction will be substantially reduced. Under such weather conditions, drive, steer and brake with extreme caution. The safe speed on a wet, snow covered or icy road is always lower than on dry road surfaces. You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around the freezing point. Mercedes-Benz recommends a minimum tire tread depth of 1/6 in (4 mm) for all four winter tires (Y page 154) to maintain normal driving characteristics in winter. Winter tires can reduce the braking distance on snow covered surfaces in comparison to summer tires. The braking distance is still much further than on surfaces that are not icy or covered with snow. Take appropriate care when driving. ! Avoid wheelspin. This can lead to damage to the drive train. Temperature G Warning The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause excessive heat build-up and possible tire failure. The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C. These represent the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life. Furthermore, excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. Grade C corresponds to a level of performance that all passenger Z Tires and wheels BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 286 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 286 Version: 3.0.3.6 Tire labeling car tires must meet under Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law. Tire labeling Overview of tire labeling The following markings are on the tire in addition to the tire name (sales designation) and the manufacturer's name: Interchanging the wheels G Warning Rotate front and rear wheels only if the tires are of the same dimension. If your vehicle is equipped with mixed-size tires (different tire dimensions front vs. rear), tire rotation is not possible. Tires and wheels G Warning! Have the tightening torque checked after changing a wheel. Wheels could become loose if not tightened with a torque of 96 lb-ft (130 Nm). Only use genuine Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts specified for your vehicle's rims. The wear patterns on the front and rear tires differ, depending on the operating conditions. Rotate the wheels before a clear wear pattern has formed on the tires. Front tires typically wear more on the shoulders and the rear tires in the center. If your vehicle's tire configuration allows, you can rotate the wheels according to the intervals in the tire manufacturer's warranty book in your vehicle documents. If no warranty book is available, the tires should be rotated every 3000 to 6000 miles (5000 to 10000 km), or earlier if tire wear requires. Do not change the direction of wheel rotation. Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel is rotated. Check the tire pressures. Information on changing a wheel and mounting the spare wheel (Y page 255). : Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standard (Y page 290) ; DOT, Tire Identification Number (Y page 289) = Maximum tire load (Y page 284) ? Maximum tire pressure (Y page 280) A Manufacturer B Tire material (Y page 290) C Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity and speed index (Y page 287) D Load index (Y page 289) E Tire name i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 287 Version: 3.0.3.6 Tire labeling Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity and speed index : Tire width ; Nominal aspect ration in % = Tire code ? Rim diameter A Load bearing index B Speed index i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example. General: depending on the manufacturer's standards, the size imprinted in the tire wall may not contain any letters or may contain one letter that precedes the size description. If there is no letter preceding the size description (as shown above): these are passenger vehicle tires according to European manufacturing standards. If "P" precedes the size description: these are passenger vehicle tires according to U.S. manufacturing standards. If "LT" precedes the size description: these are light truck tires according to U.S. manufacturing standards. If "T" precedes the size description: these are compact emergency spare wheels at high tire pressure, to be used only temporarily in an emergency. Tire width: tire width : shows the nominal tire width in millimeters. Nominal aspect ration: aspect ratio ; is the size ratio between the tire height and the tire width and is shown in percent. The aspect 287 ratio is calculated by dividing the tire width by the tire height. Tire code: tire code = specifies the tire type. "R" represents radial tires. "D" represents diagonal tires, "B" represents diagonal radial tires. Optionally, tires with a maximum speed of over 149 mph (240 km/h) may have "ZR" in the size description depending on the manufacturer (e.g. 245/40 ZR 18). Rim diameter: rim diameter ? is the diameter of the bead seat, not the diameter of the rim flange. The rim diameter is specified in inches (in). Load bearing index: load bearing index A is a numerical code which specifies the maximum load-bearing capacity of a tire. G Warning The tire load rating must always be at least half of the GAWR of your vehicle. Otherwise, sudden tire failure may be the result which could cause an accident and/or serious injury to you or others. Always replace rims and tires with rims and tires having the same specifications (designation, manufacturer and type) as shown on the original part. G Warning Do not overload the tires by exceeding the specified load limit as indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the driver's door B-pillar. Overloading the tires can overheat them, possibly causing a blowout. Overloading the tires can also result in handling or steering problems, or brake failure. Example: The load bearing index 91 is equivalent to a maximum load of 1356 lbs (615 kg) that the tire can carry. For further information on the maximum tire load in kilograms and pounds, see (Y page 284). Z Tires and wheels BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 288 Tire labeling For further information on the load bearing index, see load index (Y page 289). Speed index: speed index B specifies the approved maximum speed of the tire. G Warning Even when permitted by law, never operate a vehicle at speeds greater than the maximum speed rating of the tires. Exceeding the maximum speed for which tires are rated can lead to sudden tire failure, causing loss of vehicle control and possibly resulting in an accident and/or serious personal injury and possible death, for you and for others. Regardless of the speed index always observe the speed limits. Drive carefully and adapt your driving style to the traffic conditions. Tires and wheels 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 288 Version: 3.0.3.6 Summer tires The service specifications consists of load bearing index A and speed index B. RIf the size description of your tire includes "ZR" and there are no service specifications, ask the tire manufacturer in order to find out the maximum speed. If a service specification is available, the maximum speed is limited according to the speed index in the service specification. Example: 245/40 ZR18 97 Y. In this example, "97 Y" is the service specification. The letter "Y" represents the speed index and the maximum speed of the tire is limited to 186 mph (300 km/h). REvery tire that has a maximum speed above 186 mph (300 km/h) must have "ZR" in the size description and the service specification must be given in brackets. Example: 275/40 ZR 18 (99 Y). The speed index "(Y)" shows that the maximum speed of the tire is above 186 mph (300 km/h). Ask the tire manufacturer to find out the maximum speed. Index Speed rating Q up to 100 mph (160 km/h) R up to 106 mph (170 km/h) All-weather tires and winter tires S up to 112 mph (180 km/h) Index T up to 118 mph (190 km/h) Q M+S33 up to 100 mph (160 km/h) H up to 130 mph (210 km/h) T M+S33 V up to 149 mph (240 km/h) H M+S33 up to 130 mph (210 km/h) W up to 168 mph (270 km/h) V M+S33 Y up to 186 mph (300 km/h) ZR...Y up to 186 mph (300 km/h) ZR...(..Y) above 186 mph (300 km/h) ZR above 149 mph (240 km/h) ROptionally, tires with a maximum speed of over 149 mph (240 km/h) may have "ZR" in the size description depending on the manufacturer (e.g. 245/40 ZR 18). 33 or M+Si for winter tires. Speed rating up to 118 mph (190 km/h) up to 149 mph (240 km/h) i Not all tires that have the M+S identification offer the driving characteristics of winter tires. Winter tires have, in addition to the M+S identification, the i snow flake symbol on the tire sidewall. Tires with this identification fulfill the requirements of the Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA) and the Rubber Association of Canada (RAC) regarding the tire traction on snow and BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 289 Version: 3.0.3.6 Tire labeling An electronic speed limiter prevents your vehicle from exceeding the following speeds: RAll vehicles (except AMG vehicles): 130 mph (210 km/h) RAMG vehicles: 155 mph (250 km/h) RAMG vehicles with raised maximum speed: 174 mph (280 km/h) The speed index of tires installed at the factory may be higher than the maximum speed that the electronic speed limiter permits. Make sure that your tires have the required speed index as specified in the "Tires" section (Y page 293) for your vehicle, e.g. when buying new tires. More information on reading the tire data can be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop, e.g. at an authorized MercedesBenz Center. RIf no specification is given: no text (as in the example above), represents a standard load (SL) tire RXL or Extra Load: represents a reinforced tire RLight load: represents a light load tire RC, D, E: represents a load range that depends on the maximum load that the tire can carry at a certain pressure DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN) U.S. tire regulations prescribe that every new tire manufacturer or retreader has to imprint a TIN in or on the sidewall of each tire produced. Tires and wheels have been especially developed for driving on snow. Load index The TIN is a unique identification number. The TIN enables the tire manufacturers to inform purchasers of recalls and other safetyrelevant matters. It makes it possible for the purchaser to easily identify the affected tires. The TIN is made up of manufacturer identification code ;, tire size =, tire type code ? and date of manufacture A. i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example. In addition to the load bearing index, load index : may be imprinted after the letters that identify speed index B (Y page 287) on the sidewall of the tire. 289 i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example. DOT (Department of Transportation): tire symbol : marks that the tire complies with the requirements of the U.S. Department of Transportation. Manufacturer identification code: manufacturer identification code ; provides details on the tire manufacturer. New tires Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 290 Definitions for tires and loading have a code with two symbols. Retreaded tires have a code with four symbols. Further information about retreaded tires (Y page 270). Tire size: identifier = describes the tire size. Tire type code: tire type code ? can be used by the manufacturer as a code to describe specific characteristics of the tire. Date of manufacture: date of manufacture A provides information about the age of a tire. The first and second positions represent the week of manufacture, starting with "01" for the first calendar week. Positions three and four represent the year of manufacture. For example, a tire that is marked with "3208", was manufactured in week 32 in 2008. Tires and wheels 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 290 Version: 3.0.3.6 Tire ply material Bar Metric unit for tire pressure. 14.5038 pounds per square inch (psi) and 100 kilopascals (kPa) are the equivalent of 1 bar. DOT (Department of Transportation) DOT marked tires fulfill the requirements of the United States Department of Transportation. Average weight of the vehicle occupants The number of occupants for which the vehicle is designed multiplied by 68 kilograms (150 lb). Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards This is a uniform standard to grade the quality of tires with regards to tread quality, tire traction and temperature characteristics. The quality grading assessment is made by the manufacturer following specifications from the U.S. government. The quality grade of a tire is imprinted on the sidewall of the tire. i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example. This information describes the tire cord and the number of layers in sidewall : and under the tread ;. Definitions for tires and loading Tire ply composition and material used Describes the number of layers or the number of rubber-coated belts in the tire tread and the tire wall. These are made of steel, nylon, polyester and other materials. Recommended tire pressure This is the recommended tire pressure for your vehicle under normal driving conditions. You will find the recommendation on the Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on the driver's side of your vehicle. The recommended tire pressure provides the best balance between handling characteristics, ride comfort and wear. Additional information on particular driving conditions is located on the tire pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler flap. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 291 Version: 3.0.3.6 Definitions for tires and loading Increased vehicle weight due to optional equipment This is the combined weight of all standard and optional equipment available for the vehicle, regardless of whether it is actually installed on the vehicle or not. Wheel rim This is the part of the wheel on which the tire is mounted. GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) The GAWR is the maximum gross axle weight rating. The actual load on an axle must never exceed the gross axle weight rating. The gross axle weight rating can be found on the vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar on the driver's side. noseweight if applicable). The gross vehicle weight rating is specified on the vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar on the driver's side. Maximum loaded vehicle weight The maximum weight is the sum of the unladen weight of the vehicle, the weight of the accessories, the maximum load and the weight of the optional equipment installed at the factory. Kilopascal (kPa) Metric unit for tire pressure. 6.9 kPa is the equivalent of 1 psi. Another unit for tire pressure is bar. 100 kilopascal (kPa) is the equivalent of 1 bar. Load index Speed index The speed index is part of the tire identification. It specifies the speed range for which the tire is approved. Specifies the speed range for which the tire is approved. In addition to the load bearing index, the load index may also be imprinted on the sidewall of the tire. This specifies the load bearing capacity more precisely. Unladen weight GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) The gross vehicle weight includes the weight of the vehicle including fuel, tools, the spare wheel, accessories installed, occupants, luggage and the drawbar noseweight if applicable. The gross vehicle weight must not exceed the gross vehicle weight rating GVWR as specified on the vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar on the driver's side. GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) 291 The weight of a vehicle with standard equipment including the maximum capacity of fuel, oil and coolant. It also includes the airconditioning system and optional equipment if these are installed on the vehicle, but does not include passengers or luggage. Maximum tire load The maximum tire load in kilograms or pounds is the maximum weight for which a tire is approved. The GVWR is the maximum permissible gross weight of a fully loaded vehicle (the weight of the vehicle including all accessories, occupants, fuel, luggage and the drawbar Z Tires and wheels BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 292 Definitions for tires and loading Maximum permissible tire pressure Maximum permissible tire pressure for one tire. Maximum load on one tire Maximum load on one tire. This is calculated by dividing the maximum axle load of one axle by two. PSI (pounds per square inch) Standard unit of measurement for tire pressure. Aspect ratio Tires and wheels 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 292 Version: 3.0.3.6 Relationship between tire height and tire width in percent. Tire pressure Pressure inside the tire applying an outward force to every square inch of the tire's surface. The tire pressure is specified in pounds per square inch (psi), in kilopascal (kPa) or in bar. The tire pressure should only be corrected when the tires are cold. For this, the vehicle must have been stationary for at least three hours or not have traveled more than 1.6 km (1 mile) in this time. Tire tread The part of the tire that comes into contact with the road. Tire bead The tire bead ensures that the tire sits securely on the wheel. There are several steel wires in the bead to prevent the tire from coming loose from the wheel rim. Sidewall The part of the tire between the tread and the tire bead. Weight of optional extras The combined weight of those optional extras that weigh more than the replaced standard part and more than 2.3 kilograms (5 lbs). These optional extras, such as highperformance brakes, level control, a roof rack or a high-performance battery, are not included in the unladen weight and the weight of the accessories. TIN (Tire Identification Number) A unique identification number which can be used by a tire manufacturer to identify tires, for example for a product recall, and thus identify the purchasers. The TIN is made up of the manufacturer's identity code, tire size, tire type code and the manufacturing date. Load bearing index The load bearing index (also load index) is a code that contains the maximum load bearing capacity of a tire. Traction Traction is the result of friction between the tires and the road surface. Wear indicator This is indicated by narrow bars (tread wear bars) that are distributed over the tire tread. If the tire tread is level with the bars, the wear limit of 1/16 in (1.6 mm) has been reached. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 293 Version: 3.0.3.6 Wheel/tire combinations Distribution of the vehicle occupants This is the distribution of vehicle occupants over designated seat positions in a vehicle. Maximum permissible payload weight Nominal load and luggage load plus 68 kilograms (150 lb) multiplied by the number of seats in the vehicle. Wheel/tire combinations Points to remember G Warning Observe the "Important safety notes" (Y page 270). ! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use tires, wheels and accessories which have been approved by Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle. These tires have been specially adapted for use with the control systems, such as ABS or ESP®, and are marked as follows: RMO = Mercedes-Benz Original RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended (tires with run-flat characteristics) RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only certain AMG tires) Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tires may only be used on wheels that have been specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz. Only use tires, wheels or accessories tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle noise emissions or fuel consumption, may otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when driving with a load, tire dimension variations could cause the tires to come into contact with the bodywork and axle components. This could result in damage to the tires or the vehicle. 293 Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for damage resulting from the use of tires, wheels or accessories other than those tested and approved. Further information about tires, wheels and approved combinations can be obtained from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. i The Tire and Loading Information placard with the recommended tire pressures is attached to the B-pillar on the driver's side. Further information about driving at high speeds or driving with vehicle loads that are lighter than the maximum vehicle load can be found in the tire pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler flap. Check tire pressures regularly, and only when the tires are cold. Follow the tire manufacturer's maintenance recommendations in the vehicle document wallet. Further information on recommended tire pressures including tire pressures for specific driving situations, see (Y page 272). i Notes on the vehicle equipment – always equip the vehicle: Rwith tires of the same size on a given axle (left/right) Rwith the same type of tires at a given time (summer tires, winter tires, MOExtended tires) i The following pages contain information on approved wheel rims and tire sizes for equipping your vehicle with winter tires. Winter tires are not available at the factory as standard equipment or optional extras. If you wish to fit approved winter tires to your vehicle, rims of appropriate size are also required, as the sizes of the approved winter tires can differ from those of the original tires. This is dependent on the model and the equipment installed at the factory. Tires and wheel rims as well as additional information are available from a qualified Z Tires and wheels BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 294 Wheel/tire combinations Tires and wheels specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 294 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 295 Version: 3.0.3.6 Wheel/tire combinations 295 Tires of the same dimensions i BA: both axles R16 BA R17 BA Alloy wheels Offset 7 J x 16 H2 1.69 in (43 mm) All-weather tires 205/55 R16 91 H M+S Winter tires 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si C 300 C 300 4MATIC C 35035 C 350 4MATIC35 Alloy wheels Offset 7.5 J x 17 H2 1.85 in (47 mm) 7.5 J x 17 H2 1.85 in (47 mm) Summer tires36 225/45 R17 91 W MOExtended — All-weather tires 225/45 R17 91 H M+S — Winter tires 225/45 R17 91 H M+Si 225/45 R17 91 H M+Si Winter tires36 225/45 R17 91 H M+SiMOExtended — Tires and wheels C 25034, 35 C 250 4MATIC35 C 63 AMG R18 BA AMG alloy wheels Offset 8 J x 18 H2 1.77 in (45 mm) Winter tires 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si Winter tires37 235/40 R18 95 V XL M+Si Mixed size tires i FA: front axle, RA: rear axle 34 Not in combination with the Sports package. only. 36 Tires with run-flat characteristics and only in combination with an activated tire pressure loss warning system or tire pressure monitor. 37 Use of snow chains not permitted. 35 Canada Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 296 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 296 Version: 3.0.3.6 Wheel/tire combinations C 25038 C 250 4MATIC38 C 300 C 300 4MATIC C 350 C 350 4MATIC38 17" FA Tires and wheels RA Alloy wheels Offset 7.5 J x 17 H2 1.85 in (47 mm) Summer tires39 225/45 R17 91 W MOExtended All-weather tires 225/45 R17 91 H M+S Alloy wheels Offset 8.5 J x 17 H2 2.28 in (58 mm) Summer tires39 245/40 R17 91 W MOExtended All-weather tires40 245/40 R17 91 H M+S C 30038 C 300 4MATIC38 C 350 4MATIC38 17" FA RA 38 Canada AMG alloy wheels Offset 7.5 J x 17 H2 1.85 in (47 mm) All-weather tires 225/45 R17 91 H M+S AMG alloy wheels Offset 8.5 J x 17 H2 2.28 in (58 mm) All-weather tires40 245/40 R17 91 H M+S only. 39 Tires with run-flat characteristics and only in combination with an activated tire pressure loss warning system or tire pressure monitor. of snow chains not permitted. 40 Use BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 297 Version: 3.0.3.6 Wheel/tire combinations 297 18" FA RA Alloy wheels Offset 7.5 J x 18 H2 1.85 in (47 mm) Summer tires 225/40 R18 92 Y XL All-weather tires 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+S Alloy wheels Offset 8.5 J x 18 H2 2.13 in (54 mm) Summer tires40 255/35 R18 94 Y XL All-weather tires40 255/35 R18 94 H XL M+S Tires and wheels C 25038 C 250 4MATIC38 C 300 C 300 4MATIC C 350 C 350 4MATIC38 C 25038 C 250 4MATIC38 C 300 C 300 4MATIC38 C 350 C 350 4MATIC38 18" FA RA AMG alloy wheels Offset 8 J x 18 H2 1.97 in (50 mm) Summer tires 225/40 R18 92 Y XL All-weather tires 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+S AMG alloy wheels Offset 8.5 J x 18 H2 2.13 in (54 mm) Summer tires40 255/35 R18 94 Y XL All-weather tires40 255/35 R18 94 H XL M+S 38 Canada 40 Use only. of snow chains not permitted. Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 298 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 298 Version: 3.0.3.6 Wheel/tire combinations C 63 AMG 18" FA RA AMG alloy wheels Offset 8 J x 18 H2 1.77 in (45 mm) Summer tires 235/40 ZR18 95 Y XL Winter tires 235/40 ZR18 95 V XL M+Si AMG alloy wheels Offset 9 J x 18 H2 2.13 in (54 mm) Summer tires40 255/35 ZR18 94 Y XL Winter tires40 255/35 ZR18 94 V XL M+Si Spare wheel Tires and wheels i Please note that the tire pressure of the spare wheel differs from the tire pressure of the other wheels. i The specified tire pressure is printed in yellow on the emergency spare wheel. "Minispare" emergency spare wheel41 C 250 (all models)42, 43 C 300 C 300 4MATIC R16 Wheels Offset 40 Use 3.5 B x 16 H2 0.79 in (20 mm) Tires T 125/90 R16 98 M Tire pressure 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi) of snow chains not permitted. of snow chains not permitted. 42 Canada only. 43 Not in combination with the Sports package. 41 Use BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 299 Version: 3.0.3.6 Wheel/tire combinations 299 "Minispare" emergency spare wheel41 C 25042, 44 C 30044 C 300 4MATIC44 C 350 (all models) R17 Wheels Offset 3.5 B x 17 H2 0.79 in (20 mm) Tires T 125/80 R17 99 M Tire pressure 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi) "Minispare" emergency spare wheel41 C 63 AMG 3.5 B x 18 0.79 in (20 mm) Tires T 125/70 R18 99 M Tire pressure 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi) Tires and wheels R18 Wheels Offset 41 Use of snow chains not permitted. only. 44 Only in combination with the Sports package. 42 Canada Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 300 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 300 Version: 3.0.3.6 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 301 Version: 3.0.3.6 301 Vehicle equipment ............................ Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts ......... Warranty ............................................ Vehicle identification plates ............ Service products and capacities ..... Vehicle data ...................................... 302 302 302 303 304 311 Technical data BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 302 Warranty Vehicle equipment i This manual describes all the standard and optional equipment of your vehicle which was available at the time of purchase. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also refers to safety-related systems and functions. Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts Technical data 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 302 Version: 3.0.3.6 All Mercedes-Benz Centers maintain a supply of genuine Mercedes-Benz parts for necessary service and repair work. In addition, strategically located parts delivery centers provide for quick and reliable parts service. More than 300,000 different genuine Mercedes-Benz parts are available for Mercedes-Benz models. Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts are subjected to stringent quality inspections. Every part has been specifically developed, manufactured or selected for and adapted to Mercedes-Benz vehicles. Only genuine Mercedes-Benz parts should therefore be used. ! The use of non-approved parts could impair the vehicle's safety. For this reason, Mercedes-Benz recommends genuine Mercedes-Benz parts and approved conversion parts and accessories for your vehicle model. H Environmental note Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned major assemblies and parts which are of the same quality as new parts. They are covered by the same Limited Warranty entitlements as new parts. Always specify the vehicle identification number and engine number when ordering genuine Mercedes-Benz parts. You will find these numbers on your vehicle's identification plates, for example (Y page 303). Warranty Your vehicle is covered under the terms of the warranties printed in the Service and Warranty Information booklet. Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will exchange or repair any defective parts originally installed in the vehicle in accordance with the terms of the following warranties: RNew Vehicle Limited Warranty System Warranty REmission Performance Warranty RCalifornia, Connecticut, Maine, Massachusetts, New York, Pennsylvania, Rhode Island and Vermont Emission Control Systems Warranty RState Warranty Enforcement Laws (Lemon Laws) Replacement parts and accessories are subject to the Mercedes-Benz Replacement Part and Accessory Warranties. You can obtain these at any Mercedes-Benz Center. REmission i Should you lose your Service and Warranty Information booklet, have an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center arrange for a replacement. It will be mailed to you. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 303 Version: 3.0.3.6 Vehicle identification plates Vehicle identification plates 303 i The data on the type plate is only an example. This data is vehicle-specific and can differ from the data given here. The data that applies to your vehicle can be found on your vehicle's type plate. Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN) and paint code number Vehicle identification number (VIN) The vehicle identification number (VIN) can be found in the following locations: X Open the driver's door. You see vehicle identification plate :. the vehicle identification plate (Y page 303) Rat the lower edge of the windshield (Y page 304) In addition to being stamped on the vehicle identification plate, the vehicle identification number (VIN) is also stamped onto the vehicle body. It is located on the floor in front of the frontpassenger seat. Technical data Ron Example: vehicle identification plate (USA only) ; VIN = Paint code number X Slide the right-hand front seat to its rearmost position. X Fold floor covering : upwards. You will see vehicle identification number (VIN) ;. Example: vehicle identification plate (Canada only) ; VIN = Paint code number Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 304 Service products and capacities Engine number : Emissions control information label, including the certification of both federal and Californian emissions reference values ; Engine number (stamped into the crankcase) = VIN (on the lower edge of the windshield) Service products and capacities Technical data 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 304 Version: 3.0.3.6 Important safety notes Service products include the following: Rfuels (e.g. gasoline, diesel) Rlubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil) Rcoolant Rbrake fluid Rwindshield washer fluid Vehicle components and their respective lubricants must match. You should therefore only use products that have been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Information on tested and approved products can be obtained at an authorized MercedesBenz Center or on the Internet at http:// www.mbusa.com (USA only). G Warning Comply with all valid regulations with respect to handling, storing and disposing of service fluids. Otherwise, you could endanger persons or the environment. Keep service fluids out of the reach of children. For health reasons, you should prevent service fluids from coming into direct contact with your skin or clothing. If a service fluid is swallowed, contact a physician immediately. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 305 Version: 3.0.3.6 Service products and capacities 305 Vehicle model Capacity Fuel, coolant, lubricants etc. C 25045 C 300 C 350 8.5 US qt (8.0 l) Approved engine oils C 250 4MATIC45 C 300 4MATIC C 350 4MATIC45 7.4 US qt (7.0 l) C 63 AMG46 9.0 US qt (8.5 l) Power steering All models Approximately 0.9 US qt (0.8 l) MB power steering fluid or approved Dexron III ATF Cooling system All models except AMG vehicles Approximately 8.9 US qt (8.4 l) C 63 AMG Approximately 12.4 US qt (11.7 l) MB 325.0 corrosion inhibitor/antifreeze agent Tank capacity All models 17.4 US gal. (66.0 l) Reserve All models except AMG vehicles Engine oil and filter C 63 AMG Airconditioning system 45 Canada All models Premium-grade unleaded gasoline Approximately 2.1 US gal. (at least 91 octane, (8.0 l) average value Approximately 3.7 US gal. between 96 RON/ 86 MON) (14.0 l) — Refrigerant R134a and special PAG lubricant (never R 12) only. external oil cooler. 46 Including Z Technical data Capacities BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 306 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 306 Version: 3.0.3.6 Service products and capacities Windshield/ headlamp cleaning system Vehicle model Capacity Fuel, coolant, lubricants etc. C 25045 C 250 4MATIC45 C 300 4MATIC C 350 4MATIC45 C 63 AMG 6.3 US qt (6.0 l) C 300 C 350 3.7 US qt (3.5 l) MB windshield washer concentrate47 (Y page 310) Mixing ratio for washer fluid (Y page 310) Ravoid Fuel Important safety notes Technical data G Warning Gasoline is highly flammable and poisonous. It burns violently and can cause serious personal injury. Never allow sparks, flames or smoking materials near gasoline. Turn off the engine before refueling. Whenever you are around gasoline, avoid inhaling fumes and any skin or clothing contact. Direct skin contact with fuels and the inhalation of fuel vapors are damaging to your health. Premium-grade unleaded gasoline ! To ensure the longevity and full performance of the engine, only premiumgrade unleaded gasoline must be used. If premium-grade unleaded gasoline is unavailable and regular gasoline is used, observe the following precautions: Ronly fill the fuel tank to half full with regular unleaded gasoline and add the rest as soon as possible with premiumgrade unleaded gasoline. Rdo not drive at the maximum speed. 45 Canada 47 Mixed sudden acceleration. Rwhen the vehicle is carrying a light cargo, e.g. two passengers without luggage, do not allow the engine to rev above 3000 rpm. Rwhen the vehicle is fully loaded or being operated in mountainous terrain, do not depress the accelerator pedal further than 2/3 of the pedal travel. Flexible fuel vehicles Important safety notes All C 300 models with automatic transmission are flexible fuel vehicles. Flexible fuel vehicles are identified by a label reading Premium gasoline or E85 only on the inside of the fuel filler flap. Flexible fuel vehicles are designed to operate on premium unleaded gasoline and ethanol fuel (E85) or a mixture of these two. Ethanol fuel (E85) is a mixture of approximately 85% ethanol and 15% unleaded gasoline. G Warning Ethanol fuel (E85) and its vapors are highly flammable, poisonous and highly combustible. Ethanol fuel causes serious injury if it ignites, if it comes into contact with your skin or if you inhale the vapors. Avoid inhaling ethanol vapors and ethanol coming only. with water or premixed washer fluid with antifreeze protection. 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 307 Version: 3.0.3.6 Service products and capacities into contact with your skin. Before refueling, extinguish all naked flames. Never allow sparks or smoking materials near ethanol. Changing the fuel type For best performance and driveability, it is recommended that you use either one or the other fuel. Avoid alternating regularly between the two different types of fuel. When changing the fuel type, make sure: Rthe fuel level is below half full. Rthe fuel level is above the reserve level. This is identifiable by the fuel tank reserve warning lamp not being lit. Ryou add more than 5 gallons (20 liters) of fuel. Rbefore refueling, you switch off the engine. Rthe engine is started and operated for at least five minutes immediately after refueling. These precautions and recommendations should prevent any difficulties when starting and operating the engine which otherwise may be experienced before the engine has fully adapted to the different fuel. If, in spite of these recommendations, the engine does not perform properly, add at least 3 gallons (12 liters) of gasoline. This may improve the running of the engine. Fuel consumption Ethanol fuel (E85) contains less energy per gallon than gasoline. To ensure that the engine performance with ethanol fuel (E85) is similar to that when using gasoline, the engine must burn more ethanol fuel. As a result, it is to be expected that the fuel consumption will increase when using ethanol fuel (E85), compared to gasoline. Maintenance When you bring your vehicle for maintenance or repairs, please inform your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center if you use or have used ethanol fuel (E85). 307 Low outside temperatures It is possible that the time required for the starting procedure will significantly increase at outside temperatures below 32 ‡ (0 †). At low outside temperatures, Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of an auxiliary heater. For further information, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Rough idling may also be experienced at low outside temperatures until the engine is fully warmed up. Ethanol fuel (E85) is unsuitable for use when outside temperatures fall below 14 ‡ (-10 †). High outside temperatures At outside temperatures above 95 ‡ (35 †), the time required for the starting procedure may increase and be accompanied by rough idling following the start. Fuel requirements Use only premium-grade unleaded gasoline. The octane number should be at least 91. Details can be found on the gas pump. The octane number is the average value of the Research Octane Number (RON) and Motor Octane Number (MON): (RON + MON) / 2, also known as knock resistance. Reformulated Gasoline (RFG) and/or unleaded gasoline with additives can be used if the concentration of the additives in the fuel does not exceed 10%, e.g.: REthanol RTAME RETBE RIPA RTBA For MTBE, the concentration should not exceed 15%. The concentration of methanol in gasoline including other additives must not exceed 3%. Using mixtures of methanol and ethanol is not permitted. Gasohol, a mixture of 10% ethanol and 90% unleaded gasoline can be used. Z Technical data BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 308 Service products and capacities All of these mix fuels must fulfill the fuel requirements, e.g.: Damage or malfunctions can result that are not covered: Rknock Rby Rboiling Rby resistance point Rvapor pressure Additives in gasoline One of the major problems in engine design is the creation of carbon deposits during the process of burning fuel. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use fuel brands that have the additives which prevent the build up of carbon deposits. If you use fuels without these additives for a longer period of time, there may be a build up of carbon deposits, especially on the inlet valves and in the combustion chamber. This could lead to engine running problems, e.g.: Rwarm-up Technical data 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 308 Version: 3.0.3.6 hesitation Runstable idle Rknocking/pinging Rmisfire Rpower loss In areas where carbon deposits may be encountered due to lack of availability of gasoline which contains these additives, Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of additives approved for use in Mercedes-Benz vehicles. Consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or visit http://www.mbusa.com (USA only) to view a list of approved products. Observe the instructions for use on the product label. Do not mix other fuel additives with fuel. This causes unnecessary costs and could damage the engine. ! Do not refuel with low-grade fuel and do not use fuel additives that are not tested and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles. 48 Canada only. the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty an existing Limited Warranty Rby an extended Limited Warranty Engine oil Points to remember The engine oils are matched to the performance of Mercedes-Benz engines and service intervals. For this reason, only use engine oils and oil filters that are approved for vehicles with a service system. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or visit http://www.mbusa.com (USA only) for a list of approved engine oils and oil filters. ! Never use engine oil or an oil filter of a specification other than is necessary to fulfill the prescribed service intervals. Do not change the engine oil or oil filter in order to achieve longer replacement intervals than those prescribed. Otherwise, you may cause damage to the engine or exhaust gas aftertreatment; this is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Follow the instructions in the service interval display regarding the oil change. Otherwise, you may damage the engine and the exhaust gas aftertreatment. Mercedes-Benz recommends MOBIL OIL. The table shows which engines oil have been approved for your vehicle. Model Engine model MB Approval C 25048 272 229.5 C 250 4MATIC48 272 229.5 C 300 272 229.5 C 300 4MATIC 272 229.5 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 309 Version: 3.0.3.6 Service products and capacities Model C 350 C 350 4MATIC48 C 63 AMG Engine model MB Approval 272 229.5 272 229.5 156 229.549 309 i MB Approval is stated on the containers. Lubricant additives the engine oil. This could damage the engine. Damage resulting from the use of such lubricant additives in the engine oil is not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. Engine oil viscosity Viscosity describes the flow characteristics of a fluid. If an engine oil has a high viscosity, this means that it is thick; a low viscosity means that it is thin. Using the table below, make sure that the SAE classification (viscosity) is sufficient for the temperatures at which the vehicle is operated. The low temperature characteristics of engine oils can deteriorate significantly, e.g. by aging, soot and fuel deposits. It is therefore recommended that you carry out oil changes regularly using an approved engine oil with the appropriate SAE classification. Refrigerant of the air-conditioning system The air-conditioning system is filled with R134a refrigerant and a special PAG lubricant. ! Never use refrigerant R 12 (CFC) or mineral lubricants. Otherwise, you could damage the air-conditioning system. Brake fluid G Warning! The brake fluid constantly absorbs moisture from the air; this lowers its boiling point. If the boiling point of the brake fluid is too low, vapor pockets may form in the brake system when the brakes are applied hard (e.g. when driving downhill). This would impair braking efficiency. You should have the brake fluid renewed at regular intervals. The brake fluid change intervals can be found in the Service Booklet. Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz. Information about approved brake fluids can be obtained from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. 48 Canada only. only SAE 0W-40 or SAE 5W-40 engine oils may be used. 49 Restriction: Z Technical data ! Do not mix any lubricant additives with BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 310 Service products and capacities Coolant Important safety notes The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It performs the following tasks: Ranti-corrosion protection protection Rraising the boiling point The cooling system is filled with coolant at the factory which contains antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor that ensures protection down to approximately -35 ‡ (-37 †). Rantifreeze ! Only add coolant that has been premixed Technical data 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 310 Version: 3.0.3.6 with the desired antifreeze protection. You could otherwise damage the engine. Further information on coolants and on filling can be found in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service Products, MB Approval 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com. You can also consult an authorized MercedesBenz Center. ! Always use a suitable coolant mixture, even in countries where high temperatures prevail. Otherwise, the cooling system will not be sufficiently protected from corrosion, and the boiling point will be too low. If the coolant has antifreeze protection down to -35 ‡ (-37 †), the boiling point of the coolant in the pressurized system is approximately 266 ‡ (130 †). Your vehicle has a range of aluminum components. Use of aluminum components in the engine make it necessary to specifically match the antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor in these systems in order to protect the aluminum parts. Using other antifreeze/ corrosion inhibitors without these characteristics affects the service life. The coolant must be used throughout the year in order to maintain the necessary corrosion protection and provide protection from overheating. In the Service Booklet, you can find information on the intervals for renewal. The renewal interval is determined by the coolant type and the cooling system design. The renewal interval in the Service Booklet is only valid if the coolant is added or renewed with Mercedes-Benz approved products. Therefore, only use MB 326.0 antifreeze/ corrosion inhibitor or another Mercedes-Benz approved product of the same specification. Information on other Mercedes-Benz approved products of the same specification can be obtained at any authorized MercedesBenz Center or on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com. The coolant is checked at every service date at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the cooling system should: Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the cooling system against freezing down to around -35 ‡ (-37 †). Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection down to -49 ‡ (-45 †); otherwise, heat will not be dissipated as effectively. If the coolant level is too low, MB 326.0 antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor should be added. Have the cooling system checked for leaks. Windshield and headlamp cleaning system G Warning Washer solvent/antifreeze is highly flammable. Do not spill washer solvent/ antifreeze on hot engine parts, because it may ignite and burn. You could be seriously burned. X Use MB Windshield Washer Concentrate MB SummerFit. X At temperatures above freezing: add 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts water, e.g. BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 311 Version: 3.0.3.6 Vehicle data 1.34 fl oz (40 ml) MB SummerFit to 1 gal (4.0 l) of water. X At temperatures below freezing: add 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts washer fluid, e.g. 1.34 fl oz (40 ml) MB SummerFit to 1 gal (4.0 l) of water. i This vehicle is only available in Canada. Vehicle dimensions, C 250 4MATIC Vehicle length 182.8 in (4630 mm) Vehicle width including exterior mirrors 79.1 in (2008 mm) Vehicle data Vehicle height 56.9 in (1444 mm) Vehicle data, C 250 Wheel base 108.7 in (2760 mm) Front track 60.7 in (1541 mm) Rear track 60.8 in (1544 mm) Turning circle 35.6 ft (10.9 m) The data quoted here refers specifically to a vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the data for all vehicle variants and trim levels. 311 i This vehicle is only available in Canada. Vehicle length 182.3 in (4630 mm) Vehicle width including exterior mirrors 79.1 in (2008 mm) Vehicle height 56.9 in (1444 mm) Wheel base 108.7 in (2760 mm) Front track 60.7 in (1541 mm) Rear track 60.8 in (1544 mm) Turning circle 35.6 ft (10.9 m) Vehicle weight, C 250 4MATIC Maximum roof load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Maximum trunk load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Vehicle data, C 300 The data quoted here refers specifically to a vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the data for all vehicle variants and trim levels. Vehicle dimensions, C 300 Vehicle weight, C 250 Maximum roof load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Maximum trunk load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Vehicle data, C 250 4MATIC The data quoted here refers specifically to a vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the data for all vehicle variants and trim levels. Vehicle length 182.8 in (4630 mm) Vehicle width including exterior mirrors 79.1 in (2012 mm) Vehicle height 56.9 in (1444 mm) Wheel base 108.7 in (2760 mm) Front track 60.7 in (1541 mm) Rear track 60.8 in (1544 mm) Turning circle 35.6 ft (10.9 m) Z Technical data Vehicle dimensions, C 250 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 312 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 312 Version: 3.0.3.6 Vehicle data Vehicle weight, C 300 Maximum roof load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Maximum trunk load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Vehicle data, C 300 4MATIC The data quoted here refers specifically to a vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the data for all vehicle variants and trim levels. Vehicle dimensions, C 350 Vehicle length 182.3 in (4630 mm) Vehicle width including exterior mirrors 79.1 in (2008 mm) Vehicle height 56.9 in (1444 mm) Wheel base 108.7 in (2760 mm) Front track 60.4 in (1533 mm) Rear track 60.5 in (1536 mm) Turning circle 35.6 ft (10.9 m) Technical data Vehicle dimensions, C 300 4MATIC Vehicle length 182.3 in (4630 mm) Vehicle width including exterior mirrors 79.1 in (2008 mm) Vehicle height 56.9 in (1444 mm) Wheelbase 108.7 in (2760 mm) Front track 60.7 in (1541 mm) Rear track 60.8 in (1544 mm) Turning circle 35.6 ft (10.9 m) Vehicle weight, C 300 4MATIC Maximum roof load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Maximum trunk load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Vehicle data, C 350 The data quoted here refers specifically to a vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the data for all vehicle variants and trim levels. Vehicle weight, C 350 Maximum roof load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Maximum trunk load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Vehicle data, C 350 4MATIC The data quoted here refers specifically to a vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the data for all vehicle variants and trim levels. i This vehicle is only available in Canada. Vehicle dimensions, C 350 4MATIC Vehicle length 182.3 in (4630 mm) Vehicle width including exterior mirrors 79.1 in (2008 mm) Vehicle height 56.9 in (1444 mm) Wheel base 108.7 in (2760 mm) Front track 60.4 in (1533 mm) Rear track 60.5 in (1536 mm) Turning circle 35.6 ft (10.9 m) BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 313 Version: 3.0.3.6 Vehicle data 313 Vehicle weight, C 350 4MATIC Maximum roof load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Maximum trunk load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Vehicle data, C 63 AMG The data quoted here refers specifically to a vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the data for all vehicle variants and trim levels. Vehicle length 186.1 in (4726 mm) Vehicle width including exterior mirrors 79.2 in (2012 mm) Vehicle height 56.6 in (1438 mm) Wheel base 108.9 in (2765 mm) Front track 61.8 in (1569 mm) Rear track 60.0 in (1525 mm) Technical data Vehicle dimensions, C 63 AMG Vehicle weight, C 63 AMG Maximum roof load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Maximum trunk load Maximum 220 lb (100 kg) Z BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 314 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 314 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 315 Version: 3.0.3.6 315 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 316 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 316 Version: 3.0.3.6 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 317 Version: 3.0.3.6 Publication details Internet Further information about Mercedes-Benz vehicles and about Daimler AG can be found on the following websites: http://www.mbusa.com (USA only) http://www.mercedes-benz.ca (Canada only) Editorial office Not to be reprinted, translated or otherwise reproduced, in whole or in part, without the written permission of Daimler AG. As at 26.02.2010 BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US hereepe 2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 318 Version: 3.0.3.6 É2045848981XËÍ 2045848981 Order no. 6515 0722 13 Part no. 204 584 89 81 Edition A 2011